Support wire-format spoolfiles
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.89"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2017
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 .endtable
441
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449 .cindex "web site"
450 .cindex "FTP site"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
452 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
453 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
454 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
455 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
456 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
457
458 .cindex "wiki"
459 .cindex "FAQ"
460 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
461 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
462 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
463 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
464 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
465
466 .cindex Bugzilla
467 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
468 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
469 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
470
471
472
473 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
474 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
475 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
476
477 .table2 140pt
478 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
479 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
480 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
481 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
482 .endtable
483
484 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
485 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
486 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
487 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
488 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
489 via this web page:
490 .display
491 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 .endd
493 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
494 lists.
495
496 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
497 .cindex "bug reports"
498 .cindex "reporting bugs"
499 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
500 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
501 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
502 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503
504
505
506 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507 .cindex "FTP site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
510 .display
511 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
512 .endd
513 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
514 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
515 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
516
517 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
518 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
519 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
520 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
521 .display
522 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
523 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
524 .endd
525 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
526 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
527 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
528
529 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
530 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
531 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
532 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
533 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
534 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
535 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
536 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
537 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
538 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
539 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
540
541 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
542 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
543 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
544 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
545
546 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
547 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
548 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
549
550 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
551 .display
552 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
554 .endd
555 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
556 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
557 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
558
559 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
560 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
561 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
562 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
563 .display
564 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
565 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
566 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 .endd
569 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
570 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
571
572
573 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
574 .ilist
575 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
576 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
577 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
578 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
579 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
580 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
581 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
582 .next
583 .cindex "domainless addresses"
584 .cindex "address" "without domain"
585 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
586 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
587 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
588 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
589 arrival.
590 .next
591 .cindex "transport" "external"
592 .cindex "external transports"
593 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
594 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
595 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
596 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
597 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
598 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
599 .next
600 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
601 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
602 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
603 other means.
604 .next
605 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
606 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
607 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
608 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
609 a number of common scanners are provided.
610 .endlist
611
612
613 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
614 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
615 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
616 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
617 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
618 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
619
620
621 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
622 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
623 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
624 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
625 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
626 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
627 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
628 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
629 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
630 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
631 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
632 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
633
634 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
635 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
636 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
637 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
638
639
640
641 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
642 .cindex "terminology definitions"
643 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
644 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
645 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
646 below) by a blank line.
647
648 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
649 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
650 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
651 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
652 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
653 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
654 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
655 rise to further bounce messages.
656
657 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
658 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
659 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
660 otherwise.
661
662 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
663 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
664 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
665 until a later time.
666
667 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
668 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
669 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
670
671 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
672 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
673 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
674 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
675 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
676 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
677 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
678 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
679
680 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
681 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
682 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
683 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
684 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
685 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
686 line.
687
688 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
689 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
690 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
691 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
692 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
693
694 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
695 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
696 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
697 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
698 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
699 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
700
701 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
702 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
703 message's envelope.
704
705 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
706 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
707 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
708 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
709 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
710
711 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
712 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
713 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
714 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
715 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
716
717 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
718 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
719 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
720 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
721 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
722 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
723
724
725
726
727
728
729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
731
732 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
733 .cindex "incorporated code"
734 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
735 .cindex "PCRE"
736 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
737 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
738
739 .ilist
740 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
741 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
742 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
743 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
744 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
745 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
746 .next
747 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
748 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
749 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
750 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
751 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
752 following statements:
753
754 .blockquote
755 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
756
757 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
758 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
759 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
760 version.
761 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
762 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
763 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
764 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
765 restrictions applied to it).
766 .endblockquote
767 .next
768 .cindex "SPA authentication"
769 .cindex "Samba project"
770 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
771 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
772 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
773 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
774 under the Gnu GPL.
775 .next
776 .cindex "Cyrus"
777 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
778 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
779 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
780 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
781 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
782 conditions expressed therein.
783
784 .blockquote
785 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
786
787 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
788 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
789 are met:
790
791 .olist
792 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
793 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
794 .next
795 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
796 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
797 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
798 distribution.
799 .next
800 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
801 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
802 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
803 details, please contact
804 .display
805 Office of Technology Transfer
806 Carnegie Mellon University
807 5000 Forbes Avenue
808 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
809 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
810 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
811 .endd
812 .next
813 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
814 acknowledgment:
815
816 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
817 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
818
819 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
820 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
821 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
822 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
823 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
824 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
825 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
826 .endlist
827 .endblockquote
828
829 .next
830 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
831 .cindex "X-windows"
832 .cindex "Athena"
833 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
834 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
835 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
836 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
837
838 .blockquote
839 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
840 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
841
842 All Rights Reserved
843
844 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
845 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
846 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
847 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
848 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
849 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
850 software without specific, written prior permission.
851
852 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
853 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
854 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
855 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
856 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
857 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
858 SOFTWARE.
859 .endblockquote
860
861 .next
862 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
863 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
864 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
865 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
866 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
867 source code.
868
869 .next
870 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
871 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
872 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
873 .endlist
874
875
876
877
878
879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
881
882 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
883 "Receiving and delivering mail"
884
885
886 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
887 .cindex "design philosophy"
888 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
889 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
890 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
891 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
892 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
893 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
894
895
896 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
897 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
898 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
899 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
900 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
901 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
902 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
903
904 .ilist
905 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
906 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
907 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
908 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
909 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
910 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
911 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
912 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
913 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
914 error code.
915 .next
916 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
917 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
918 .next
919 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
920 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
921 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
922 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
923 .next
924 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
925 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
926 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
927 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
928 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
929 .next
930 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
931 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
932 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
933 .next
934 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
935 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
936 runs at the start of every delivery process.
937 .endlist
938
939
940
941 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
942 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
943 .cindex "Sieve filter"
944 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
945 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
946 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
947 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
948 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
949 of filtering are available:
950
951 .ilist
952 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
953 by RFC 3028.
954 .next
955 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
956 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
957 .endlist
958
959 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
960
961
962
963 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
964 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
965 .cindex "format" "of message id"
966 .cindex "id of message"
967 .cindex "base62"
968 .cindex "base36"
969 .cindex "Darwin"
970 .cindex "Cygwin"
971 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
972 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
973 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
974 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
975 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
976 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
977 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
978 not always case-sensitive.
979
980 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
981 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
982 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
983 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
984 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
985 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
986 somewhat eccentric:
987
988 .ilist
989 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
990 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
991 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
992 way of representing the date and time of day).
993 .next
994 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
995 received the message.
996 .next
997 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
998 .olist
999 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1000 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1001 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1002 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1003 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1004 .next
1005 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1006 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1007 (1/100) of a second.
1008 .endlist
1009 .endlist
1010
1011 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1012 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1013 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1014 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1015 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1016
1017
1018 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1019 .cindex "receiving mail"
1020 .cindex "message" "reception"
1021 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1022 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1023 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1024 there are several possibilities:
1025
1026 .ilist
1027 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1028 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1029 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1030 .next
1031 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1032 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1033 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1034 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1035 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1036 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1037 .next
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1039 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1040 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1041 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1042 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1043 .next
1044 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1045 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1046 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1047 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1048 .endlist
1049
1050
1051 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1052 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1053 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1054 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1055 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1056 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1057 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1058 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1059 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1060 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1061 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1062 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1063 users to change sender addresses.
1064
1065 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1066 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1067 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1068 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1069 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1070 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1071 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1072
1073 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1074 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1075 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1076 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1077 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1078 message is received.
1079
1080
1081
1082
1083
1084 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1085 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1086 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1087 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1088 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1089 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1090 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1091 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1092
1093 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1094 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1095 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1096 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1097 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1098 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1099 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1100 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1101 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1102 affect file system performance.
1103
1104 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1105 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1106 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1107 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1108 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1109
1110 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1111 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1112 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1113 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1114 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1115 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1116 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1117 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1118 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1119 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1120 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1121 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1122
1123
1124
1125 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1126 .cindex "message" "life of"
1127 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1128 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1129 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1130 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1131 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1132 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1133 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1134
1135 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1136 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1137 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1138 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1139 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1140 to be sent.
1141
1142 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1143 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1144 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1145 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1146 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1147
1148 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1149 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1150 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1151 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1152 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1153 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1154 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1155 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1156 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1157 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1158 systems.
1159
1160 .cindex "journal file"
1161 .cindex "file" "journal"
1162 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1163 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1164 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1165 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1166 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1167 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1168 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1169 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1170
1171 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1172 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1173 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1174 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1175 deliveries caused by crashes.
1176
1177
1178
1179 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1180 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1181 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1182 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1183 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1184 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1185 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1186 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1187 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1188
1189 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1190 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1191 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1192 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1193 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1194 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1195 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1196 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1197 the driver's features in general.
1198
1199 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1200 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1201 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1202 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1203 to be bounced.
1204
1205 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1206 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1207 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1208 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1209 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1210 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1211
1212 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1213 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1214 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1215 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1216 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1217 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1218
1219 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1220 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1221 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1222 configuration.
1223
1224 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1225 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1226 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1227 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1228 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1229 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1230 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1231 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1232 configured to fail the address.
1233
1234 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1235 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1236 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1237 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1238 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1239 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1240
1241 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1242 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1243 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1244 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1245 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1246 the address is bounced.
1247
1248
1249
1250 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1251 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1252 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1253 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1254 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1255 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1256 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1257 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1258
1259 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1260 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1261 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1262 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1263 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1264 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1265 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1266 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1267
1268
1269
1270
1271 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1272 .cindex "router" "running details"
1273 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1274 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1275 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1276 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1277 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1278 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1279 the following:
1280
1281 .ilist
1282 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1283 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1284 original address ceases,
1285 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1286 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1287 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1288 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1289 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1290 end of routing.
1291
1292 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1293 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1294 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1295 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1296 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1297 .next
1298 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1299 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1300 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1301 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1302 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1303 .next
1304 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1305 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1306 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1307 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1308 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1309 .next
1310 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1311 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1312 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1313 .next
1314 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1315 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1316 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1317 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1318 .next
1319 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1320 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1321 .endlist
1322
1323 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1324 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1325 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1326 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1327 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1328
1329 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1330 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1331 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1332 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1333 facility for this purpose.
1334
1335
1336 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1337 .cindex "case of local parts"
1338 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1339 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1340 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1341 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1342 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1343 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1344 routed addresses are shown.
1345
1346
1347
1348 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1349 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1350 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1351 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1352 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1353 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1354
1355 .ilist
1356 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1357 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1358 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1359 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1360 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1361 of any other conditions.
1362 .next
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1364 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1365 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1366 address.
1367 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1368 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1369 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1370 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1371 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1372 .next
1373 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1374 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1375 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1376 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1377 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1378 .next
1379 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1380 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1381 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1382 .next
1383 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1384 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1385 .next
1386 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1387 of domains that it defines.
1388 .next
1389 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1391 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1392 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1393 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1394 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1395 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1396 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1397 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1398 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1399 .next
1400 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1402 .vindex "&$home$&"
1403 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1404 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1405 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1406 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1407 remaining preconditions.
1408 .next
1409 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1410 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1411 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1412 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1413 could lead to confusion.
1414 .next
1415 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1416 set of addresses that it defines.
1417 .next
1418 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1419 specified files is tested.
1420 .next
1421 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1422 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1423 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1424 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1425 .endlist
1426
1427
1428 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1429 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1430 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1431 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1432 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1433 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1434 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1435
1436
1437
1438 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1439 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1440 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1441
1442 .ilist
1443 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1444 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1445 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1446 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1447 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1448 filtering'&.
1449 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1450 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1451
1452 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1453 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1454 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1455 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1456 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1457 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1458 filter.
1459 .next
1460 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1461 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1462 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1463 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1464 processed entirely independently of each other.
1465 .next
1466 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1467 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1468 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1469 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1470 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1471 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1472 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1473 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1474 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1475 .next
1476 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1477 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1478 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1479 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1480 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1481 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1482 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1483 addresses to the same domain.
1484 .next
1485 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1486 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1487 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1488 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1489 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1490 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1491 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1492 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1493 .next
1494 .cindex "queue runner"
1495 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1496 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1497 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1498 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1499 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1500 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1501 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1502 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1503 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1504 .next
1505 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1506 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1507 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1508 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1509 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1510 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1511 .next
1512 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1513 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1514 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1515 messages to other addresses.
1516 .next
1517 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1518 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1519 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1520 &'deferred'&.
1521 .next
1522 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1523 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1524 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1525 .endlist
1526
1527
1528
1529
1530 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1531 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1532 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1533 .cindex "queue runner"
1534 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1535 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1536 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1537 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1538 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1539 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1540 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1541 passed its retry time.
1542 You can run several queue runners at once.
1543
1544 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1545 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1546 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1547 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1548 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1549 as permanent.
1550
1551
1552
1553 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1554 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1555 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1556 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1557 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1558 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1559 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1560 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1561 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1562 also apply.
1563
1564 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1565 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1566 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1567 deferred,
1568 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1569 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1570 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1571 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1572 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1573 one connection.
1574
1575
1576
1577 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1578 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1579 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1580 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1581 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1582 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1583 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1584 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1585 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1586 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1587 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1588
1589 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1590 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1591 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1592 automatically.
1593
1594 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1595 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1596 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1597 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1598 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1599 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1600 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1601 of the list.
1602
1603
1604
1605 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1606 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1607 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1608 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1609 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1610 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1611 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1612 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1613
1614
1615
1616
1617
1618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1620
1621 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1622 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1623
1624 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1625 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1626 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1627 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1628
1629 .table2 140pt
1630 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1631 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1632 documented"
1633 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1634 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1635 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1636 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1637 instructions"
1638 .endtable
1639
1640 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1641 following subdirectories are created:
1642
1643 .table2 140pt
1644 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1645 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1646 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1647 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1648 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1649 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1650 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1651 .endtable
1652
1653 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1654 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1655 that may be useful to some sites.
1656
1657
1658 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1659 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1660 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1661 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1662 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1663 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1664 system.
1665 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1666 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1667 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1668 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1669 overridden if necessary.
1670
1671
1672 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1673 .cindex "PCRE library"
1674 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1675 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1676 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1677 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1678 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1679 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1680 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1681 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1682 If your operating system has no
1683 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1684 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1685 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1686
1687 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1688 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1689 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1690 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1691 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1692 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1693 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1694
1695 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1696 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1697 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1698 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1699 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1700 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1701 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1702 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1703
1704 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1705 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1706 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1707 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1708 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1709 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1710 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1711 Berkeley DB library.
1712
1713 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1714 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1715 possibilities:
1716
1717 .olist
1718 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1719 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1720 .next
1721 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1722 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1723 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1724 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1725 file name is used unmodified.
1726 .next
1727 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1728 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1729 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1730 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1731 .next
1732 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1733 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1734 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1735 .next
1736 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1737 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1738 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1739 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1740 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1741 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1742 .next
1743 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1744 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1745 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1746 operates on a single file.
1747 .endlist
1748
1749 .cindex "USE_DB"
1750 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1751 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1752 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1753 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1754 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1755 .code
1756 USE_DB=yes
1757 .endd
1758 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1759 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1760
1761 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1762 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1763 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1764 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1765 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1766 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1767
1768 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1769 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1770 in one of these lines:
1771 .code
1772 DBMLIB = -ldb
1773 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1774 .endd
1775 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1776 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1777 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1778 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1779 this example:
1780 .code
1781 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1782 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1783 .endd
1784 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1785 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1786
1787
1788
1789 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1790 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1791 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1792 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1793 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1794 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1795 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1796 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1797 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1798 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1799 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1800 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1801
1802 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1803 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1804 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1805 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1806 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1807 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1808
1809 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1810 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1811 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1812 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1813 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1814 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1815 be logged.
1816
1817 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1818 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1819 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1820 facilities, you need to set
1821 .code
1822 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1823 .endd
1824 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1825 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1826
1827
1828 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1829 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1830 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1831 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1832 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1833 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1834 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1835
1836 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1837 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1838 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1839 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1840 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1841 do this.
1842
1843
1844
1845 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1846 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1847 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1848 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1849 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1850 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1851 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1852 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1853 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1854 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1855
1856 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1857 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1858 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1859 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1860 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1861 .code
1862 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1863 .endd
1864 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1865
1866
1867
1868 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1869 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1870 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1871 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1872 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1873 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1874 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1875 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1876 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1877 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1878 line option).
1879
1880 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1881 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1882 implementing SSL.
1883
1884 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1885 .code
1886 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1887 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1888 .endd
1889 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1890 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1891 .code
1892 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1893 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1894 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1895 .endd
1896 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1897 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1898 .code
1899 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1900 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1901 .endd
1902 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1903 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1904 .code
1905 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1906 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1907 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1908 .endd
1909 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1910 library and include files. For example:
1911 .code
1912 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1913 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1914 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1915 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1916 .endd
1917 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1918 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1919 .code
1920 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1921 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1922 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1923 .endd
1924
1925 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1926 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1927 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1928
1929
1930
1931
1932 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1933
1934 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1935 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1936 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1937 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1938 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1939 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1940 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1941 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1942 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1943 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1944 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1945 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1946 you might have
1947 .code
1948 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1949 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1950 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1951 .endd
1952 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1953 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1954 .code
1955 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1956 .endd
1957 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1958 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1959 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1960 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1961 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1962 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1963 further details.
1964
1965
1966 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1967 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1968 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1969 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1970 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1971 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1972 library files.
1973
1974 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1975 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1976 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1977 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1978 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1979 Exim used to
1980 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1981 withdrawn.
1982
1983
1984
1985 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1986 .cindex "lookup modules"
1987 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1988 .cindex ".so building"
1989 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
1990 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
1991 on demand.
1992 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
1993 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
1994 dependencies.
1995 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
1996
1997 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
1998 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
1999 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2000 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2001 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2002 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2003
2004 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2005 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2006 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2007 on demand:
2008 .code
2009 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2010 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2011 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2012 .endd
2013
2014
2015 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2016 .cindex "build directory"
2017 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2018 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2019 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2020 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2021 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2022 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2023 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2024
2025 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2026 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2027 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2028 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2029 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2030 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2031 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2032 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2033
2034 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2035 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2036 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2037
2038
2039
2040 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2041 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2042 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2043 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2044 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2045 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2046 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2047 .code
2048 FULLECHO='' make -e
2049 .endd
2050 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2051 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2052 given in addition to the short output.
2053
2054
2055
2056 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2057 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2058 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2059 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2060 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2061 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2062 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2063 order:
2064 .display
2065 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2066 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2067 &_Local/Makefile_&
2068 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2069 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2070 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2071 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2072 .endd
2073 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2074 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2075 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2076 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2077 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2078 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2079 and are often not needed.
2080
2081 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2082 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2083 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2084 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2085 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2086 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2087 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2088 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2089 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2090
2091
2092 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2093 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2094 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2095 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2096 default values are.
2097
2098
2099 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2100 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2101 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2102 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2103 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2104 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2105 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2106 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2107 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2108 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2109 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2110 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2111 containing the lines
2112 .code
2113 CC=cc
2114 CFLAGS=-std1
2115 .endd
2116 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2117 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2118
2119 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2120 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2121 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2122
2123
2124 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2125 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2126 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2127 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2128 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2129 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2130 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2131 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2132 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2133 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2134 .code
2135 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2136 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2137 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2138 .endd
2139 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2140 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2141 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2142 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2143 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2144 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2145 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2146 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2147 errors.
2148
2149 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2150 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2151 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2152 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2153 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2154 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2155 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2156 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2157 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2158 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2159 syntax. For instance:
2160 .code
2161 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2162 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2163 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2164 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2165 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2166 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2167 .endd
2168
2169 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2170 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2171 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2172 .code
2173 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2174 .endd
2175 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2176 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2177
2178 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2179 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2180 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2181 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2182 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2183 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2184 .code
2185 X11=/usr/X11R6
2186 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2187 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2188 .endd
2189 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2190 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2191 .code
2192 X11=/usr/openwin
2193 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2194 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2195 .endd
2196 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2197 definition of all three of these variables into your
2198 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2199
2200 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2201 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2202 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2203 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2204 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2205
2206 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2207 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2208 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2209 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2210 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2211 libraries.
2212
2213 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2214 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2215 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2216 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2217 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2218
2219
2220 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2221 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2222 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2223 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2224 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2225 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2226 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2227 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2228
2229
2230
2231 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2232 .cindex "building Eximon"
2233 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2234 where the files that are involved are
2235 .display
2236 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2237 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2238 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2239 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2240 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2241 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2242 .endd
2243 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2244 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2245 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2246 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2247 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2248 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2249 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2250 .ecindex IIDbuex
2251
2252
2253 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2254 .cindex "installing Exim"
2255 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2256 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2257 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2258 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2259 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2260 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2261 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2262 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2263 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2264 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2265 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2266 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2267
2268 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2269 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2270 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2271 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2272 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2273 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2274 alternative files, no default is installed.
2275
2276 .cindex "system aliases file"
2277 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2278 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2279 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2280 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2281 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2282 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2283 and outputs a comment to the user.
2284
2285 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2286 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2287 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2288 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2289 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2290
2291 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2292 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2293 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2294 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2295 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2296 over SMTP.
2297
2298 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2299 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2300 command such as
2301 .code
2302 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2303 .endd
2304 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2305 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2306 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2307 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2308 but this usage is deprecated.
2309
2310 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2311 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2312 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2313 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2314 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2315 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2316
2317 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2318 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2319 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2320 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2321 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2322 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2323 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2324
2325 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2326 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2327 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2328 command:
2329 .code
2330 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2331 .endd
2332 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2333 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2334 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2335 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2336 command:
2337 .code
2338 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2339 .endd
2340 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2341 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2342
2343 .ilist
2344 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2345 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2346 .next
2347 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2348 installed binary.
2349 .endlist
2350
2351 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2352 .code
2353 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2354 .endd
2355 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2356 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2357 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2358 .code
2359 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2360 .endd
2361
2362
2363
2364 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2365 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2366 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2367 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2368 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2369 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2370
2371 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2372 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2373 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2374
2375
2376
2377 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2378 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2379 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2380 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2381 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2382 necessary.
2383
2384
2385
2386
2387 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2388 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2389 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2390 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2391 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2392 .code
2393 exim -bV
2394 .endd
2395 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2396 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2397 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2398 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2399 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2400 example,
2401 .display
2402 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2403 .endd
2404 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2405 .display
2406 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2407 .endd
2408 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2409 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2410 user agent. For example:
2411 .code
2412 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2413 From: user@your.domain.example
2414 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2415 Subject: Testing Exim
2416
2417 This is a test message.
2418 ^D
2419 .endd
2420 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2421 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2422 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2423
2424 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2425 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2426 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2427 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2428 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2429 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2430 .display
2431 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2432 .endd
2433 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2434 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2435 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2436 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2437 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2438
2439 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2440 .cindex "lock files"
2441 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2442 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2443 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2444 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2445 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2446 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2447 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2448 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2449 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2450 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2451 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2452 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2453
2454 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2455 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2456 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2457 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2458 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2459 incoming SMTP mail.
2460
2461 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2462 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2463 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2464 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2465 production version.
2466
2467
2468 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2469 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2470 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2471 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2472 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2473 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2474 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2475 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2476 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2477 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2478 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2479 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2480 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2481
2482 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2483 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2484 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2485 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2486 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2487 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2488 as follows:
2489 .code
2490 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2491 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2492 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2493 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2494 .endd
2495 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2496 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2497 favourite user agent.
2498
2499 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2500 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2501 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2502 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2503 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2504 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2505
2506
2507
2508 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2509 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2510 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2511 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2512 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2513 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2514 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2515 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2516 configuration file.
2517
2518
2519
2520
2521 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2522 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2523 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2524 .code
2525 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2526 .endd
2527 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2528 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2529 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2530 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2531 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2532 .code
2533 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2534 .endd
2535 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2536
2537 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2538 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2539 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2540
2541
2542
2543
2544 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2546
2547 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2548 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2549 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2550 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2551 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2552 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2553 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2554 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2555 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2556
2557
2558 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2559 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2560 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2561 were present before any other options.
2562 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2563 standard output.
2564 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2565 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2566 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2567
2568 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2569 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2570 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2571 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2572 format.
2573
2574 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2575 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2576 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2577 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2578
2579 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2580 .cindex "queue runner"
2581 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2582 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2583 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2584
2585 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2586 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2587 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2588 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2589 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2590 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2591 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2592 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2593
2594
2595 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2596 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2597 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2598 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2599 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2600 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2601
2602 .ilist
2603 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2604 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2605 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2606 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2607 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2608 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2609
2610 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2611 .cindex "envelope sender"
2612 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2613 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2614 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2615 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2616 users to set envelope senders.
2617
2618 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2619 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2620 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2621 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2622 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2623 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2624 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2625
2626 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2627 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2628 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2629 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2630 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2631 that are available to trusted users.
2632 .next
2633 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2634 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2635 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2636 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2637 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2638
2639 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2640 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2641 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2642 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2643
2644 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2645 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2646 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2647 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2648
2649 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2650 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2651 false.
2652 .endlist
2653
2654
2655 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2656 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2657 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2658 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2659
2660
2661
2662
2663 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2664 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2665 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2666 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2667 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2668 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2669 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2670 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2671
2672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2673 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2674 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2675 . creates a man page for the options.
2676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2677
2678 .literal xml
2679 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2680 .literal off
2681
2682
2683 .vlist
2684 .vitem &%--%&
2685 .oindex "--"
2686 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2687 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2688 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2689 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2690
2691 .vitem &%--help%&
2692 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2693 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2694 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2695 no arguments.
2696
2697 .vitem &%--version%&
2698 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2699 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2700 displayed.
2701
2702 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2703 &%-Am%&
2704 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2705 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2706 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2707 ignored by Exim.
2708
2709 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2710 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2711 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2712 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2713 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2714 clean; it ignores this option.
2715
2716 .vitem &%-bd%&
2717 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2718 .cindex "daemon"
2719 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2720 .cindex "queue runner"
2721 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2722 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2723 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2724
2725 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2726 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2727 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2728 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2729
2730 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2731 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2732 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2733 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2734
2735 When a listening daemon
2736 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2737 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2738 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2739 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2740 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2741 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2742 running as root.
2743
2744 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2745 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2746 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2747
2748 The SIGHUP signal
2749 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2750 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2751 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2752 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2753 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2754 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2755 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2756 because these are reread each time they are used.
2757
2758 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2759 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2760 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2761 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2762
2763 .vitem &%-be%&
2764 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2765 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2766 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2767 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2768 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2769 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2770 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2771
2772 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2773 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2774 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2775 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2776 test data. A line history is supported.
2777
2778 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2779 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2780 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2781 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2782 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2783 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2784 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2785
2786 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2787 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2788 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2789 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2790
2791 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2792 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2793 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2794 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2795 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2796 of a file. For example:
2797 .code
2798 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2799 .endd
2800 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2801 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2802 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2803 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2804 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2805 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2806 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2807 &%-be%&).
2808
2809 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2810 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2811 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2812 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2813 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2814 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2815 system filters are recognized.
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2819 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2821 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2822 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2823 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2824 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2825 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2826 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2827 supplied.
2828
2829 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2830 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2831 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2832 .code
2833 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2834 .endd
2835 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2836 variables that are used by the user filter.
2837
2838 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2839 .code
2840 # Exim filter
2841 # Sieve filter
2842 .endd
2843 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2844 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2845 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2846 redirection lists.
2847
2848 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2849 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2850 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2851 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2852
2853 When testing a filter file,
2854 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2855 .cindex "envelope sender"
2856 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2857 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2858 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2859 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2860 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2861 options).
2862
2863 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2864 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2865 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2866 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2867 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2868 &$qualify_domain$&.
2869
2870 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2871 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2872 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2873 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2874 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2875 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2876 actually being delivered.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2880 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2881 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2882 prefix.
2883
2884 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2885 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2886 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2887 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2888 suffix.
2889
2890 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2891 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2892 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2893 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2894 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2895 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2896 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2897 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2898 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2899 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2900 after a full stop. For example:
2901 .code
2902 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2903 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2904 .endd
2905 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2906 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2907 conversion to the canonical form is
2908 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2909
2910 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2911 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2912 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2913 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2914 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2915
2916 &*Warning 1*&:
2917 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2918 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2919 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2920 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2921 connection.
2922
2923 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2924 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2925 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2926
2927 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2928 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2929 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2930 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2931 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2932 session were authenticated.
2933
2934 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2935 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2936 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2937
2938 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2939 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2940 specialized SMTP test program such as
2941 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2942
2943 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2944 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2945 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2946 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2947 updating the callout cache database.
2948
2949 .vitem &%-bi%&
2950 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2951 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2952 .cindex "building alias file"
2953 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2954 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2955 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2956 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2957 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2958 recognized.
2959
2960 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2961 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2962 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2963 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2964 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2965 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2966 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2967
2968 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2969 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2970 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2971 .cindex "querying exim information"
2972 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2973 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2974 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2975 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2976 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2977
2978 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2979 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2980 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2981 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2982 recognised DSCP names.
2983
2984 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2985 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2986 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2987 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2988 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2989 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2990 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2991 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
2992 way to guarantee a correct response.
2993
2994 .vitem &%-bm%&
2995 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
2996 .cindex "local message reception"
2997 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2998 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
2999 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3000 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3001 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3002 if no other conflicting option is present.
3003
3004 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3005 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3006 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3007 suppressing this for special cases.
3008
3009 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3010 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3011
3012 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3013 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3014 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3015
3016 The format
3017 .cindex "message" "format"
3018 .cindex "format" "message"
3019 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3020 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3021 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3022 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3023 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3024 .code
3025 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3026 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3027 .endd
3028 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3029 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3030 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3031 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3032 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3033
3034 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3035 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3036 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3037 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3038 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3039
3040 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3041 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3042 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3043 .cindex "malware scan test"
3044 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3045 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3046 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3047 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3048 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3049 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3050 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3051
3052 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3053 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3054 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3055 This option requires admin privileges.
3056
3057 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3058 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3059 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3060
3061 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3062 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3063 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3064 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3065 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3066 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3067 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3068 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3069 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3070
3071 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3072 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3073 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3074 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3075 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3076
3077 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3078 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3079 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3080 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3081
3082
3083 .vitem &%-bP%&
3084 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3085 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3086 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3087 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3088 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3089 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3090 arguments, for example:
3091 .code
3092 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3093 .endd
3094 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3095 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3096 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3097 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3098 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3099 users, the output is as in this example:
3100 .code
3101 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3102 .endd
3103 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3104 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3105
3106 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3107 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3108 backward compatibility.)
3109 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3110 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3111
3112 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3113 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3114 name will not be output.
3115
3116 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3117 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3118 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3119 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3120 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3121 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3122 written directly into the spool directory.
3123
3124 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3125 .code
3126 exim -bP +local_domains
3127 .endd
3128 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3129 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3130
3131 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3132 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3133 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3134 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3135 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3136 that driver are output. For example:
3137 .code
3138 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3139 .endd
3140 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3141 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3142 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3143 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3144 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3145 &%authenticators%&.
3146
3147 .cindex "environment"
3148 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3149 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3150 variables.
3151
3152 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3153 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3154 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3155 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3156 The output format is one item per line.
3157
3158 .vitem &%-bp%&
3159 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3160 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3161 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3162 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3163 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3164 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3165 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3166 to allow any user to see the queue.
3167
3168 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3169 .code
3170 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3171 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3172 <other addresses>
3173 .endd
3174 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3175 .cindex "size" "of message"
3176 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3177 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3178 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3179 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3180 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3181 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3182 before the sender address.
3183
3184 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3185 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3186 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3187
3188 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3189 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3190 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3191 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3192 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3193 complete.
3194
3195
3196 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3197 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3198 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3199 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3200 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3201 of just &"D"&.
3202
3203
3204 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3205 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3206 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3207 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3208 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3209 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3210
3211
3212 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3213 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3214 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3215 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3216 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3217 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3218
3219 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3220 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3221 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3222
3223 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3224 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3225 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3226
3227
3228 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3229 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3230 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3231 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3232 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3233 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3234
3235
3236 .vitem &%-brt%&
3237 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3238 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3239 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3240 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3241 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3242 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3243 .code
3244 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3245 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3246 .endd
3247 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3248 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3249 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3250 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3251 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3252 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3253 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3254 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3255 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3256 .code
3257 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3258 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3259 .endd
3260
3261 .vitem &%-brw%&
3262 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3263 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3264 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3265 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3266 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3267 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3268 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3269 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3270
3271 .vitem &%-bS%&
3272 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3273 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3274 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3275 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3276 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3277 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3278 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3279 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3280 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3281 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3282
3283 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3284 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3285 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3286
3287 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3288 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3289 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3290 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3291
3292 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3293 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3294 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3295
3296 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3297 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3298 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3299 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3300 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3301
3302 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3303 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3304
3305 .vitem &%-bs%&
3306 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3307 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3308 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3309 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3310 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3311 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3312 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3313 messages to the MTA.
3314
3315 In
3316 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3317 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3318 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3319 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3320 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3321 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3322 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3323
3324 .cindex "inetd"
3325 The
3326 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3327 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3328 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3329 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3330 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3331 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3332 the listening daemon.
3333
3334 .vitem &%-bt%&
3335 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3336 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3337 .cindex "address" "testing"
3338 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3339 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3340 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3341 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3342 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3343
3344 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3345 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3346
3347 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3348 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3349 security issues.
3350
3351 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3352 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3353 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3354 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3355 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3356 program.
3357
3358 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3359 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3360 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3361 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3362
3363 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3364 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3365 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3366 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3367 always shown.
3368
3369 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3370 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3371 message,
3372 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3373 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3374 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3375 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3376 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3377 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3378 doing such tests.
3379
3380 .vitem &%-bV%&
3381 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3382 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3383 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3384 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3385 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3386 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3387 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3388
3389 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3390 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3391 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3392 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3393 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3394 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3395 dynamic testing facilities.
3396
3397 .vitem &%-bv%&
3398 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3399 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3400 .cindex "address" "verification"
3401 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3402 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3403 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3404 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3405 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3406 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3407
3408 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3409 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3410 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3411
3412 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3413 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3414
3415 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3416 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3417 security issues.
3418
3419 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3420 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3421 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3422 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3423 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3424
3425 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3426 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3427 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3428 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3429 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3430 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3431 to succeed.
3432
3433 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3434 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3435 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3436
3437 The
3438 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3439 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3440 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3441 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3442
3443 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3444 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3445 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3446 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3447
3448 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3449 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3450 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3451 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3452 might happen.
3453
3454 .vitem &%-bw%&
3455 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3456 .cindex "daemon"
3457 .cindex "inetd"
3458 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3459 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3460 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3461 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3462
3463 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3464 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3465 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3466 each port only when the first connection is received.
3467
3468 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3469 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3470
3471 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3472 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3473 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3474 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3475 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3476 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3477 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3478 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3479 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3480 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3481 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3482
3483 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3484 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3485 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3486 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3487 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3488 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3489 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3490 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3491 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3492
3493 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3494 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3495 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3496 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3497 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3498 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3499 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3500
3501 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3502 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3503 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3504 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3505 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3506 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3507 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3508
3509 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3510 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3511 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3512 configuration file.
3513
3514 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3515 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3516 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3517 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3518 specified by this option.
3519
3520
3521 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3522 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3523 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3524 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3525 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3526 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3527 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3528 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3529
3530 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3531 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3532 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3533 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3534 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3535 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3536 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3537
3538 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3539 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3540 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3541 synonymous:
3542 .code
3543 exim -DABC ...
3544 exim -DABC= ...
3545 .endd
3546 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3547 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3548 example:
3549 .code
3550 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3551 .endd
3552 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3553 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3554
3555
3556 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3557 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3558 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3559 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3560 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3561 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3562 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3563 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3564 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3565 return code.
3566
3567 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3568 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3569 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3570 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3571 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3572 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3573 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3574 are:
3575 .display
3576 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3577 &`auth `& authenticators
3578 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3579 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3580 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3581 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3582 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3583 &`filter `& filter handling
3584 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3585 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3586 &`ident `& ident lookup
3587 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3588 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3589 &`load `& system load checks
3590 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3591 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3592 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3593 &`memory `& memory handling
3594 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3595 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3596 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3597 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3598 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3599 &`retry `& retry handling
3600 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3601 &`route `& address routing
3602 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3603 &`tls `& TLS logic
3604 &`transport `& transports
3605 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3606 &`verify `& address verification logic
3607 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3608 .endd
3609 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3610 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3611 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3612 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3613 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3614 turn everything off.
3615
3616 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3617 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3618 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3619 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3620 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3621 rather than stderr.
3622
3623 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3624 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3625 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3626 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3627 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3628 run in parallel.
3629
3630 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3631 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3632 in processing.
3633
3634 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3635 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3636
3637 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3638 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3639 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3640 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3641 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3642 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3643
3644 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3645 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3646 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3647 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3648 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3649
3650 .vitem &%-E%&
3651 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3652 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3653 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3654 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3655 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3656 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3657 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3658 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3659 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3660
3661 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3662 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3663 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3664 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3665 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3666 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3667
3668 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3669 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3670 .cindex "sender" "name"
3671 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3672 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3673 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3674 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3675 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3676 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3677
3678 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3679 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3680 .cindex "sender" "address"
3681 .cindex "address" "sender"
3682 .cindex "trusted users"
3683 .cindex "envelope sender"
3684 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3685 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3686 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3687 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3688 users to use it.
3689
3690 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3691 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3692 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3693 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3694 domain.
3695
3696 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3697 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3698 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3699 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3700 examples of shell commands:
3701 .code
3702 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3703 exim -f "" user@domain
3704 .endd
3705 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3706 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3707 &%-bv%& options.
3708
3709 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3710 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3711 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3712 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3713
3714 White
3715 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3716 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3717 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3718 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3719 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3720 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3721
3722 .vitem &%-G%&
3723 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3724 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3725 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3726 .code
3727 control = suppress_local_fixups
3728 .endd
3729 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3730 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3731 in future.
3732
3733 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3734 this option.
3735
3736 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3737 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3738 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3739 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3740 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3741 headers.)
3742
3743 .vitem &%-i%&
3744 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3745 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3746 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3747 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3748 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3749 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3750 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3751
3752 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3753 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3754 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3755 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3756 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3757 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3758 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3759 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3760
3761 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3762
3763 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3764 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3765 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3766 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3767 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3768 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3769 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3770 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3771 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3772
3773 Retry
3774 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3775 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3776 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3777 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3778 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3779 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3780
3781 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3782 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3783 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3784 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3785
3786 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3787 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3788 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3789 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3790 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3791 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3792 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3793 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3794 can be used only by an admin user.
3795
3796 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3797 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3798 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3799 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3800 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3801 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3802 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3803 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3804 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3805 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3806 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3807
3808 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3809 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3810 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3811 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3812 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3813
3814 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3815 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3816 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3817 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3818 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3819
3820 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3821 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3822 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3823 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3824 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3825
3826 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3827 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3828 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3829 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3830 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3831
3832 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3833 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3834 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3835 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3836 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3837
3838 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3839 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3840 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3841 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3842 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3843 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3844 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3845 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3846
3847 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3848 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3849 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3850 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3851 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3852 connection.
3853
3854 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3855 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3856 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3857 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3858 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3859
3860 .new
3861 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3862 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3863 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3864 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3865 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3866 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3867 .wen
3868
3869 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3870 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3871 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3872 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3873 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3874 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3875 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3876 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3877 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3878 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3879 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3880 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3881 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3882 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3883 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3884
3885 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3886 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3887 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3888 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3889 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3890 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3891 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3892 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3893 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3894 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3895
3896 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3897 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3898 .cindex "freezing messages"
3899 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3900 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3901 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3902 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3903 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3904 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3905 user.
3906
3907 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3908 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3909 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3910 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3911 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3912 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3913 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3914 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3915 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3916 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3917 user.
3918
3919 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3920 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3921 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3922 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3923 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3924 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3925 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3926
3927 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3928 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3929 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3930 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3931 .cindex "removing recipients"
3932 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3933 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3934 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3935 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3936 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3937 can be used only by an admin user.
3938
3939 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3940 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3941 .cindex "removing messages"
3942 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3943 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3944 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3945 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3946 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3947 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3948 placed on the queue.
3949
3950 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3951 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3952 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3953 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3954 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3955 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3956 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3957 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3958 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3959 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3960 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3961
3962 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3963 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3964 .cindex "thawing messages"
3965 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3966 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3967 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3968 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3969 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3970 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3971 by an admin user.
3972
3973 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3974 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3975 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3976 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3977 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3978 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3979
3980 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3981 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3982 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3983 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3984 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3985 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3986 only by an admin user.
3987
3988 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3989 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3990 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3991 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3992 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3993 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3994 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3995
3996 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3997 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3998 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3999 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4000 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4001 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4002
4003 .vitem &%-m%&
4004 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4005 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4006 treats it that way too.
4007
4008 .vitem &%-N%&
4009 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4010 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4011 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4012 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4013 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4014 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4015 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4016 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4017 than &"=>"&.
4018
4019 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4020 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4021 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4022 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4023 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4024 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4025 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4026 for that message.
4027
4028 .vitem &%-n%&
4029 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4030 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4031 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4032 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4033 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4034
4035 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4036 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4037 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4038 Exim.
4039
4040 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4041 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4042 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4043 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4044 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4045 description above.
4046
4047 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4048 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4049 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4050 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4051 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4052 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4053 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4054 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4055
4056 .vitem &%-odb%&
4057 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4058 .cindex "background delivery"
4059 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4060 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4061 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4062 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4063 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4064 processes to finish.
4065
4066 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4067 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4068 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4069 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4070
4071 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4072 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4073 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4074 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4075
4076 .vitem &%-odf%&
4077 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4078 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4079 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4080 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4081 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4082 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4083 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4084
4085 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4086 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4087 during deliveries.
4088
4089 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4090 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4091
4092 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4093 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4094 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4095 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4096
4097
4098 .vitem &%-odi%&
4099 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4100 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4101 Sendmail.
4102
4103 .vitem &%-odq%&
4104 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4105 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4106 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4107 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4108 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4109 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4110 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4111 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4112 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4113 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4114 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4115 forces queueing.
4116
4117 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4118 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4119 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4120 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4121 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4122 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4123 configuration file is in effect.
4124
4125 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4126 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4127 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4128 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4129 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4130 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4131 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4132 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4133 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4134 &%-qq%& option.
4135
4136 .vitem &%-oee%&
4137 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4138 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4139 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4140 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4141 message.
4142
4143 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4144 Provided
4145 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4146 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4147 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4148 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4149
4150 .vitem &%-oem%&
4151 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4152 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4153 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4154 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4155 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4156 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4157
4158 .vitem &%-oep%&
4159 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4160 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4161 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4162 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4163 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4164 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4165
4166 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4167 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4168 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4169 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4170 effect as &%-oep%&.
4171
4172 .vitem &%-oew%&
4173 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4174 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4175 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4176 effect as &%-oem%&.
4177
4178 .vitem &%-oi%&
4179 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4180 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4181 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4182 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4183 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4184 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4185 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4186
4187 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4188 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4189 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4190
4191 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4192 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4193 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4194 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4195 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4196 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4197 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4198 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4199
4200 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4201 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4202 .code
4203 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4204 .endd
4205 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4206 followed by a colon and the port number:
4207 .code
4208 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4209 .endd
4210 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4211 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4212 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4213 whichever one is last.
4214
4215 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4216 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4217 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4218 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4219 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4220 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4221 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4222 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4223
4224 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4225 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4226 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4227 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4228 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4229 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4230 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4231 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4232
4233 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4234 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4235 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4236 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4237 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4238 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4239 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4240 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4241 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4242 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4243
4244 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4245 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4246 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4247 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4248 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4249 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4250 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4251
4252 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4253 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4254 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4255 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4256 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4257 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4258 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4259 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4260 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4261
4262 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4263 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4264 is sending the bounce.
4265
4266 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4267 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4268 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4269 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4270 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4271 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4272 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4273 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4274 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4275 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4276 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4277 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4278
4279 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4280 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4281 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4282 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4283 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4284 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4285 uses the name it is given.
4286
4287 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4288 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4289 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4290 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4291 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4292 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4293 used, when there is no default.
4294
4295 .vitem &%-om%&
4296 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4297 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4298 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4299 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4300 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4301
4302 .vitem &%-oo%&
4303 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4304 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4305 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4306 whatever that means.
4307
4308 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4309 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4310 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4311 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4312 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4313 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4314 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4315 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4316 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4317
4318 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4319 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4320 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4321 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4322 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4323 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4324 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4325
4326 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4327 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4328 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4329 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4330 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4331 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4332 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4333 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4334
4335 .vitem &%-ov%&
4336 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4337 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4338
4339 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4340 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4341 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4342 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4343 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4344 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4345 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4346 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4347 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4348 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4349
4350 .vitem &%-pd%&
4351 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4352 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4353 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4354 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4355 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4356 needed.
4357
4358 .vitem &%-ps%&
4359 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4360 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4361 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4362 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4363 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4364 started.
4365
4366 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4367 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4368 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4369 .display
4370 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4371 .endd
4372 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4373 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4374 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4375 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4376 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4377
4378 .vitem &%-q%&
4379 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4380 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4381 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4382 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4383 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4384 and &%-S%& options).
4385
4386 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4387 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4388 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4389 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4390 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4391 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4392 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4393
4394 If
4395 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4396 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4397 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4398 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4399 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4400 proceeding.
4401
4402 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4403 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4404 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4405 this to be repeated periodically.
4406
4407 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4408 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4409 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4410 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4411
4412 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4413 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4414 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4415
4416 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4417 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4418 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4419 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4420
4421 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4422 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4423 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4424 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4425 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4426 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4427 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4428 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4429 transports are run.
4430
4431 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4432 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4433 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4434 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4435 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4436 delivered down a single SMTP
4437 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4438 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4439 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4440 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4441 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4442 intermittently.
4443
4444 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4445 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4446 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4447 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4448 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4449 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4450 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4451
4452 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4453 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4454 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4455 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4456 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4457 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4458 their retry times are tried.
4459
4460 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4461 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4462 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4463 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4464 frozen or not.
4465
4466 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4467 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4468 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4469 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4470 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4471 for later delivery.
4472
4473 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4474 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4475 .cindex queue named
4476 .cindex "named queues"
4477 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4478 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4479 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4480 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4481 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4482 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4483
4484 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4485 will specify a queue to operate on.
4486 For example:
4487 .code
4488 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4489 mailq -qGquarantine
4490 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4491 .endd
4492
4493 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4494 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4495 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4496 starting message id. For example:
4497 .code
4498 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4499 .endd
4500 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4501 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4502 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4503 .code
4504 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4505 .endd
4506 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4507 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4508 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4509 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4510 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4511 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4512
4513 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4514 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4515 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4516 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4517 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4518 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4519 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4520 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4521 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4522 .code
4523 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4524 .endd
4525 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4526 process every 30 minutes.
4527
4528 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4529 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4530
4531 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4532 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4533 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4534 compatibility.
4535
4536 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4537 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4538 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4539
4540 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4541 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4542 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4543 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4544 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4545 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4546 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4547 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4548 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4549
4550 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4551 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4552 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4553 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4554 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4555 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4556
4557 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4558 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4559 .code
4560 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4561 .endd
4562 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4563 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4564 applied to each queue run.
4565
4566 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4567 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4568 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4569 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4570 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4571 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4572 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4573 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4574 address will be skipped.
4575
4576 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4577 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4578 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4579 &'ff'& is present.
4580
4581 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4582 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4583 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4584 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4585 an arbitrary command instead.
4586
4587 .vitem &%-r%&
4588 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4589 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4590
4591 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4592 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4593 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4594 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4595 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4596 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4597 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4598 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4599
4600 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4601 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4602 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4603 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4604 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4605
4606 .vitem &%-t%&
4607 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4608 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4609 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4610 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4611 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4612 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4613 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4614 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4615 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4616 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4617
4618 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4619 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4620 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4621 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4622 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4623 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4624 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4625 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4626 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4627 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4628 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4629
4630 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4631 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4632 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4633 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4634 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4635 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4636
4637 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4638 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4639 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4640 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4641 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4642 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4643 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4644 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4645 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4646
4647 .vitem &%-ti%&
4648 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4649 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4650 compatibility with Sendmail.
4651
4652 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4653 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4654 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4655 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4656 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4657 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4658 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4659 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4660
4661
4662 .vitem &%-U%&
4663 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4664 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4665 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4666 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4667 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4668 set. Exim ignores this option.
4669
4670 .vitem &%-v%&
4671 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4672 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4673 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4674 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4675 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4676 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4677 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4678 unconditional.
4679
4680 .vitem &%-x%&
4681 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4682 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4683 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4684 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4685 this option.
4686
4687 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4688 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4689 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4690 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4691
4692 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4693 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4694 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4695 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4696 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4697 under most shells.
4698 .endlist
4699
4700 .ecindex IIDclo1
4701 .ecindex IIDclo2
4702
4703
4704 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4705 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4706 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4707 . creates a man page for the options.
4708 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4709
4710 .literal xml
4711 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4712 .literal off
4713
4714
4715
4716
4717
4718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4720
4721
4722 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4723 "The runtime configuration file"
4724
4725 .cindex "run time configuration"
4726 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4727 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4728 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4729 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4730 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4731 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4732 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4733 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4734 control.
4735
4736 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4737 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4738 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4739 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4740 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4741 actually alter the string.
4742
4743 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4744 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4745 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4746 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4747 existing file in the list.
4748
4749 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4750 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4751 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4752 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4753 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4754 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4755 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4756 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4757 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4758 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4759 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4760
4761 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4762 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4763 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4764 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4765 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4766
4767 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4768 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4769 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4770 compromise the Exim user account.
4771
4772 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4773 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4774 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4775 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4776 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4777 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4778 configuration.
4779
4780
4781
4782 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4783 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4784 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4785 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4786 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4787 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4788 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4789 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4790 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4791 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4792 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4793
4794 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4795 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4796 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4797 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4798 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4799 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4800 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4801 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4802 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4803 &%-M%&).
4804
4805 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4806 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4807 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4808 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4809 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4810
4811 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4812 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4813 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4814 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4815 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4816 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4817
4818 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4819 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4820 necessarily be discarded.
4821 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4822 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4823 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4824 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4825 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4826 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4827
4828 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4829 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4830 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4831 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4832 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4833 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4834 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4835
4836 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4837 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4838 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4839
4840
4841
4842 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4843 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4844 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4845 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4846 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4847 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4848 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4849 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4850
4851 .ilist
4852 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4853 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4854 .next
4855 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4856 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4857 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4858 .next
4859 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4860 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4861 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4862 .next
4863 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4864 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4865 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4866 .next
4867 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4868 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4869 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4870 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4871 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4872 .next
4873 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4874 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4875 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4876 .next
4877 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4878 want to use this feature, you must set
4879 .code
4880 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4881 .endd
4882 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4883 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4884 .endlist
4885
4886 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4887 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4888 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4889 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4890
4891 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4892 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4893 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4894 and does not introduce a comment.
4895
4896 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4897 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4898 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4899 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4900 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4901
4902 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4903 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4904 change settings as required.
4905
4906 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4907 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4908 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4909 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4910 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4911 described.
4912
4913
4914
4915 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4916 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4917 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4918 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4919 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4920 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4921 using this syntax:
4922 .display
4923 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4924 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4925 .endd
4926 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4927 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4928 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4929 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4930 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4931 name is required.
4932
4933 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4934 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4935 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4936 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4937
4938 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4939 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4940 for example:
4941 .code
4942 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4943 .include /some/file
4944 .endd
4945 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4946 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4947 inclusion appears.
4948
4949
4950
4951 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4952 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4953 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4954 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4955 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4956 definition, and must be of the form
4957 .display
4958 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4959 .endd
4960 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4961 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4962 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4963 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4964 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4965
4966 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4967 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4968 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4969
4970 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4971 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4972 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4973 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4974 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4975 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4976 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4977 define
4978 .display
4979 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4980 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4981 .endd
4982 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4983 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4984 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4985 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4986 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4987 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4988
4989
4990 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4991 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4992 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4993 &'='&. For example:
4994 .code
4995 MAC = initial value
4996 ...
4997 MAC == updated value
4998 .endd
4999 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5000 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5001 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5002 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5003 .code
5004 MAC = initial value
5005 ...
5006 MAC == MAC and something added
5007 .endd
5008 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5009 from a number of other files.
5010
5011 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5012 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5013 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5014 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5015 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5016 file to be ignored.
5017
5018
5019
5020 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5021 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5022 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5023 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5024 .code
5025 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5026 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5027 .endd
5028 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5029 .code
5030 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5031 .endd
5032 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5033 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5034 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5035
5036
5037 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5038 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5039 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5040 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5041 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5042 (see below).
5043
5044 The following classes of macros are defined:
5045 .display
5046 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5047 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5048 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5049 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5050 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5051 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5052 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5053 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5054 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5055 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5056 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5057 .endd
5058
5059 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5060
5061
5062 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5063 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5064 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5065 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5066 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5067 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5068 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5069
5070 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5071 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5072 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5073 line. Thus:
5074 .code
5075 .ifdef AAA
5076 message_size_limit = 50M
5077 .else
5078 message_size_limit = 100M
5079 .endif
5080 .endd
5081 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5082 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5083 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5084 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5085 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5086
5087 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5088 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5089 in this line"& will always be true.
5090
5091 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5092 to clarify complicated nestings.
5093
5094
5095
5096 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5097 .cindex "common option syntax"
5098 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5099 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5100 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5101 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5102 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5103 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5104 space) and then the value. For example:
5105 .code
5106 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5107 .endd
5108 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5109 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5110 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5111 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5112 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5113 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5114 word &"hide"&. For example:
5115 .code
5116 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5117 .endd
5118 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5119 .code
5120 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5121 .endd
5122 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5123 all instances of the same driver.
5124
5125 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5126 that are found in option settings.
5127
5128
5129 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5130 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5131 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5132 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5133 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5134 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5135 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5136 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5137 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5138 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5139 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5140 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5141 .code
5142 queue_only
5143 queue_only = true
5144 .endd
5145 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5146 .code
5147 no_queue_only
5148 queue_only = false
5149 .endd
5150 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5151
5152
5153
5154
5155 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5156 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5157 .cindex "format" "integer"
5158 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5159 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5160 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5161 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5162 hexadecimal number.
5163
5164 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5165 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5166 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5167 When the values
5168 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5169 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5170 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5171 used.
5172
5173
5174 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5175 .cindex "integer format"
5176 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5177 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5178 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5179 Such options are always output in octal.
5180
5181
5182 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5183 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5184 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5185 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5186 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5187
5188
5189
5190 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5191 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5192 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5193 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5194 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5195
5196 .table2 30pt
5197 .irow &%s%& seconds
5198 .irow &%m%& minutes
5199 .irow &%h%& hours
5200 .irow &%d%& days
5201 .irow &%w%& weeks
5202 .endtable
5203
5204 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5205 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5206 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5207
5208
5209
5210 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5211 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5212 .cindex "format" "string"
5213 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5214 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5215 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5216 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5217 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5218 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5219 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5220 therefore equivalent:
5221 .code
5222 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5223 trusted_users = uucp:\
5224 # This comment line is ignored
5225 mail
5226 .endd
5227 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5228 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5229 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5230 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5231 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5232
5233 .table2 100pt
5234 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5235 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5236 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5237 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5238 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5239 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5240 character"
5241 .endtable
5242
5243 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5244 character, that character replaces the pair.
5245
5246 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5247 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5248 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5249 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5250 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5251 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5252
5253
5254 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5255 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5256 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5257 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5258 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5259 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5260 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5261 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5262 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5263 within a quoted configuration string.
5264
5265
5266 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5267 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5268 .cindex "format" "user name"
5269 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5270 .cindex "format" "group name"
5271 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5272 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5273 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5274 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5275
5276
5277 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5278 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5279 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5280 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5281 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5282 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5283 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5284 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5285 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5286 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5287 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5288
5289 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5290 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5291 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5292 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5293 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5294 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5295 example, the list
5296 .code
5297 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5298 .endd
5299 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5300
5301 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5302 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5303 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5304 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5305
5306 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5307 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5308 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5309 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5310 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5311 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5312 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5313 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5314 .code
5315 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5316 .endd
5317 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5318 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5319 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5320
5321 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5322 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5323 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5324 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5325 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5326 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5327 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5328 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5329 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5330 .code
5331 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5332 .endd
5333 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5334 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5335 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5336 the value in quotes. For example:
5337 .code
5338 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5339 .endd
5340 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5341 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5342 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5343 enclosing an empty list item.
5344
5345
5346
5347 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5348 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5349 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5350 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5351 .code
5352 senders = user@domain :
5353 .endd
5354 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5355 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5356 items, the second of which is empty:
5357 .code
5358 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5359 .endd
5360 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5361 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5362 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5363 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5364 .code
5365 senders = :
5366 .endd
5367 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5368 is at the end of the list.
5369
5370
5371
5372
5373 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5374 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5375 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5376 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5377 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5378 a sequence of lines like this:
5379 .display
5380 <&'instance name'&>:
5381 <&'option'&>
5382 ...
5383 <&'option'&>
5384 .endd
5385 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5386 followed by three options settings:
5387 .code
5388 localuser:
5389 driver = accept
5390 check_local_user
5391 transport = local_delivery
5392 .endd
5393 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5394 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5395 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5396 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5397 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5398 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5399
5400 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5401 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5402
5403 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5404 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5405 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5406 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5407 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5408 server.
5409
5410 .cindex "generic options"
5411 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5412 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5413 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5414 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5415 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5416 .cindex "private options"
5417 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5418 they all have default values.
5419
5420 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5421 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5422 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5423
5424 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5425 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5426 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5427 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5428 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5429 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5430 configuration lines:
5431 .code
5432 remote_smtp:
5433 driver = smtp
5434 .endd
5435 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5436 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5437 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5438 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5439 thus:
5440 .code
5441 special_smtp:
5442 driver = smtp
5443 port = 1234
5444 command_timeout = 10s
5445 .endd
5446 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5447 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5448 lines.
5449
5450 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5451 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5452 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5453 option.
5454
5455
5456
5457
5458
5459
5460 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5462
5463 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5464 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5465 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5466 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5467 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5468 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5469 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5470 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5471 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5472 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5473 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5474
5475
5476
5477 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5478 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5479 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5480 the line
5481 .code
5482 # primary_hostname =
5483 .endd
5484 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5485 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5486 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5487 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5488
5489 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5490 .code
5491 domainlist local_domains = @
5492 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5493 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5494 .endd
5495 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5496 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5497 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5498 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5499
5500 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5501 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5502 on the local host.
5503
5504 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5505 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5506 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5507 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5508 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5509 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5510
5511 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5512 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5513 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5514 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5515 domain is permitted.
5516
5517 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5518 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5519 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5520 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5521 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5522 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5523
5524 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5525 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5526 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5527
5528 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5529 .code
5530 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5531 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5532 .endd
5533 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5534 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5535 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5536 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5537 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5538 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5539 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5540 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5541 contents of a message to be checked.
5542
5543 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5544 .code
5545 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5546 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5547 .endd
5548 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5549 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5550 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5551 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5552
5553 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5554 .code
5555 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5556 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5557 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5558 .endd
5559 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5560 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5561 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5562 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5563 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5564 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5565 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5566
5567 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5568 .code
5569 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5570 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5571 .endd
5572 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5573 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5574 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5575 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5576 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5577 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5578 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5579 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5580 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5581 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5582 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5583 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5584 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5585 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5586 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5587 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5588
5589 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5590 .code
5591 # qualify_domain =
5592 # qualify_recipient =
5593 .endd
5594 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5595 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5596 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5597 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5598 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5599 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5600
5601 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5602 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5603 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5604 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5605 .code
5606 # allow_domain_literals
5607 .endd
5608 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5609 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5610 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5611 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5612 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5613 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5614
5615 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5616 .code
5617 never_users = root
5618 .endd
5619 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5620 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5621 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5622 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5623 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5624 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5625 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5626 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5627
5628 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5629 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5630 line,
5631 .code
5632 host_lookup = *
5633 .endd
5634 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5635 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5636 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5637 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5638 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5639 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5640 unreachable.
5641
5642 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5643 1413 (hence their names):
5644 .code
5645 rfc1413_hosts = *
5646 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5647 .endd
5648 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5649 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5650 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5651 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5652 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5653 information, you can change this.
5654
5655 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5656 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5657 .code
5658 prdr_enable = true
5659 .endd
5660
5661 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5662 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5663 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5664 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5665 .code
5666 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5667 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5668 .endd
5669 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5670 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5671
5672 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5673 over the default:
5674 .code
5675 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5676 +tls_certificate_verified
5677 .endd
5678
5679 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5680 .code
5681 # percent_hack_domains =
5682 .endd
5683 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5684 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5685 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5686
5687 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5688 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5689 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5690 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5691 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5692 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5693 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5694 always bounce messages.
5695 .code
5696 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5697 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5698 .endd
5699 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5700 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5701 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5702 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5703 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5704
5705 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5706 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5707 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5708 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5709 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5710 not often needed).
5711 .code
5712 # split_spool_directory = true
5713 .endd
5714
5715 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5716 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5717 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5718 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5719 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5720 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5721 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5722 .code
5723 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5724 .endd
5725
5726 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5727 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5728 that are not 8-bit clean.
5729 .code
5730 # accept_8bitmime = false
5731 .endd
5732
5733 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5734 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5735 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5736 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5737 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5738 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5739 .code
5740 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5741 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5742 .endd
5743
5744
5745 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5746 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5747 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5748 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5749 It starts with the line
5750 .code
5751 begin acl
5752 .endd
5753 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5754 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5755 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5756
5757 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5758 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5759 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5760 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5761 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5762 result of the ACL processing.
5763 .code
5764 acl_check_rcpt:
5765 .endd
5766 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5767 ACL, and names it.
5768 .code
5769 accept hosts = :
5770 .endd
5771 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5772 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5773 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5774 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5775 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5776 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5777
5778 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5779 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5780 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5781 manner.
5782 .code
5783 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5784 domains = +local_domains
5785 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5786
5787 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5788 domains = !+local_domains
5789 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5790 .endd
5791 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5792 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5793 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5794 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5795 in Internet mail addresses.
5796
5797 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5798 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5799 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5800 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5801 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5802 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5803 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5804 policy of being as safe as possible.
5805
5806 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5807 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5808 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5809 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5810 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5811 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5812
5813 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5814 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5815 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5816 have to modify this rule.
5817
5818 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5819 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5820 common convention of local parts constructed as
5821 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5822 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5823 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5824 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5825 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5826 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5827
5828 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5829 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5830 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5831 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5832 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5833 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5834 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5835 .code
5836 accept local_parts = postmaster
5837 domains = +local_domains
5838 .endd
5839 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5840 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5841 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5842 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5843 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5844
5845 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5846 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5847 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5848 .code
5849 require verify = sender
5850 .endd
5851 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5852 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5853 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5854 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5855 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5856 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5857 discusses the details of address verification.
5858 .code
5859 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5860 control = submission
5861 .endd
5862 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5863 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5864 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5865 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5866 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5867 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5868 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5869 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5870 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5871 .code
5872 accept authenticated = *
5873 control = submission
5874 .endd
5875 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5876 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5877 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5878 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5879 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5880 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5881 .code
5882 require message = relay not permitted
5883 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5884 .endd
5885 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5886 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5887 .code
5888 require verify = recipient
5889 .endd
5890 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5891 fails, the address is rejected.
5892 .code
5893 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5894 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5895 # $dnslist_text
5896 # dnslists = black.list.example
5897 #
5898 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5899 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5900 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5901 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5902 .endd
5903 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5904 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5905 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5906 line.
5907 .code
5908 # require verify = csa
5909 .endd
5910 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5911 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5912 records.
5913 .code
5914 accept
5915 .endd
5916 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5917 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5918 .code
5919 acl_check_data:
5920 .endd
5921 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5922 of this ACL are commented out:
5923 .code
5924 # deny malware = *
5925 # message = This message contains a virus \
5926 # ($malware_name).
5927 .endd
5928 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5929 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5930 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5931 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5932 .code
5933 # warn spam = nobody
5934 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5935 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5936 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5937 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5938 .endd
5939 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5940 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5941 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5942 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5943 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5944 whatever the spam score.
5945 .code
5946 accept
5947 .endd
5948 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5949
5950
5951 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5952 .cindex "default" "routers"
5953 .cindex "routers" "default"
5954 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5955 by the line
5956 .code
5957 begin routers
5958 .endd
5959 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5960 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5961 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5962 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5963 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5964 .code
5965 # domain_literal:
5966 # driver = ipliteral
5967 # domains = !+local_domains
5968 # transport = remote_smtp
5969 .endd
5970 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5971 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5972 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5973 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5974 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5975 .code
5976 dnslookup:
5977 driver = dnslookup
5978 domains = ! +local_domains
5979 transport = remote_smtp
5980 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5981 no_more
5982 .endd
5983 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5984 domains. This is specified by the line
5985 .code
5986 domains = ! +local_domains
5987 .endd
5988 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5989 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5990 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5991 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5992 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5993 passed on to the following routers.
5994
5995 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5996 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5997 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5998 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5999 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6000
6001 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6002 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6003 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6004 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6005 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6006 the address fails and is bounced.
6007
6008 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6009 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6010 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6011 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6012 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6013 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6014 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6015 out.
6016 .code
6017 system_aliases:
6018 driver = redirect
6019 allow_fail
6020 allow_defer
6021 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6022 # user = exim
6023 file_transport = address_file
6024 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6025 .endd
6026 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6027 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6028 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6029 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6030 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6031 the next router.
6032
6033 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6034 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6035 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6036 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6037 .code
6038 userforward:
6039 driver = redirect
6040 check_local_user
6041 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6042 # local_part_suffix_optional
6043 file = $home/.forward
6044 # allow_filter
6045 no_verify
6046 no_expn
6047 check_ancestor
6048 file_transport = address_file
6049 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6050 reply_transport = address_reply
6051 .endd
6052 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6053 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6054 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6055 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6056 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6057 namely:
6058 .code
6059 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6060 # local_part_suffix_optional
6061 .endd
6062 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6063 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6064 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6065 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6066 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6067 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6068 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6069
6070 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6071 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6072 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6073 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6074
6075 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6076 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6077 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6078 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6079 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6080 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6081 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6082
6083 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6084 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6085 There are two reasons for doing this:
6086
6087 .olist
6088 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6089 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6090 unnecessary work.
6091 .next
6092 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6093 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6094 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6095 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6096 this time.
6097 .endlist
6098
6099 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6100 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6101 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6102 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6103
6104 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6105 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6106 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6107 .code
6108 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6109 .endd
6110 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6111 transport.
6112 .code
6113 localuser:
6114 driver = accept
6115 check_local_user
6116 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6117 # local_part_suffix_optional
6118 transport = local_delivery
6119 .endd
6120 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6121 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6122 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6123 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6124 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6125
6126
6127 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6128 .cindex "default" "transports"
6129 .cindex "transports" "default"
6130 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6131 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6132 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6133 .code
6134 begin transports
6135 .endd
6136 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6137 .code
6138 remote_smtp:
6139 driver = smtp
6140 hosts_try_prdr = *
6141 .endd
6142 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6143 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6144 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6145 It is negotiated between client and server
6146 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6147 All other options are defaulted.
6148 .code
6149 local_delivery:
6150 driver = appendfile
6151 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6152 delivery_date_add
6153 envelope_to_add
6154 return_path_add
6155 # group = mail
6156 # mode = 0660
6157 .endd
6158 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6159 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6160 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6161 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6162 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6163 show how this can be done.
6164
6165 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6166 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6167 similarly-named options above.
6168 .code
6169 address_pipe:
6170 driver = pipe
6171 return_output
6172 .endd
6173 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6174 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6175 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6176 be returned to the sender.
6177 .code
6178 address_file:
6179 driver = appendfile
6180 delivery_date_add
6181 envelope_to_add
6182 return_path_add
6183 .endd
6184 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6185 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6186 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6187 .code
6188 address_reply:
6189 driver = autoreply
6190 .endd
6191 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6192 filter files.
6193
6194
6195
6196 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6197 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6198 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6199 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6200 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6201 introduced by the line
6202 .code
6203 begin retry
6204 .endd
6205 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6206 errors:
6207 .code
6208 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6209 .endd
6210 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6211 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6212 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6213 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6214 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6215
6216 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6217 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6218 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6219
6220
6221 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6222 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6223 .code
6224 begin rewrite
6225 .endd
6226 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6227 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6228
6229
6230
6231 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6232 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6233 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6234 .code
6235 begin authenticators
6236 .endd
6237 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6238 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6239 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6240 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6241 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6242 to support most MUA software.
6243
6244 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6245 .code
6246 #PLAIN:
6247 # driver = plaintext
6248 # server_set_id = $auth2
6249 # server_prompts = :
6250 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6251 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6252 .endd
6253 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6254 .code
6255 #LOGIN:
6256 # driver = plaintext
6257 # server_set_id = $auth1
6258 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6259 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6260 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6261 .endd
6262
6263 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6264 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6265 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6266 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6267 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6268 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6269 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6270 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6271
6272 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6273 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6274 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6275 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6276
6277 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6278 usercode and password are in different positions.
6279 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6280
6281 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6282
6283
6284
6285 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6286 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6287
6288 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6289
6290 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6291 .cindex "PCRE"
6292 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6293 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6294 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6295 regular expressions is discussed in
6296 online Perl manpages, in
6297 many Perl reference books, and also in
6298 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6299 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6300
6301 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6302 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6303 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6304 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6305 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6306 case-insensitive.
6307
6308 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6309 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6310 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6311 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6312 .code
6313 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6314 .endd
6315 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6316 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6317 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6318 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6319 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6320 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6321 matched.
6322
6323 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6324 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6325 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6326 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6327 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6328 match anywhere in the subject string.
6329
6330 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6331 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6332 .code
6333 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6334 .endd
6335 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6336 You need to use:
6337 .code
6338 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6339 .endd
6340 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6341 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6342
6343
6344
6345 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6346 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6347
6348 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6349 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6350 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6351 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6352 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6353 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6354
6355 .olist
6356 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6357 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6358 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6359 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6360 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6361 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6362 .next
6363 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6364 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6365 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6366 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6367 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6368 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6369 .endlist
6370
6371 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6372 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6373 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6374 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6375 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6376 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6377
6378 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6379 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6380 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6381 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6382 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6383 .code
6384 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6385 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6386 .endd
6387 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6388 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6389 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6390 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6391 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6392 .code
6393 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6394 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6395 .endd
6396 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6397 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6398
6399 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6400 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6401 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6402 .code
6403 domain1:
6404 domain2:
6405 .endd
6406 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6407 matches the list item.
6408
6409 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6410 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6411 .code
6412 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6413 .endd
6414 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6415 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6416 causes a second lookup to occur.
6417
6418 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6419 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6420 lookup is permitted.
6421
6422
6423 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6424 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6425 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6426 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6427
6428 .ilist
6429 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6430 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6431 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6432 .next
6433 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6434 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6435 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6436 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6437 .endlist
6438
6439 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6440 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6441 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6442 .code
6443 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6444 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6445 .endd
6446 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6447 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6448 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6449
6450
6451
6452
6453 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6454 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6455 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6456 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6457
6458 .ilist
6459 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6460 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6461 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6462 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6463 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6464 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6465 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6466 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6467 be found in several places:
6468 .display
6469 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6470 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6471 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6472 .endd
6473 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6474 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6475 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6476 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6477 .next
6478 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6479 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6480 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6481 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6482 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6483 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6484 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6485
6486 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6487 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6488 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6489 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6490 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6491 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6492 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6493 .next
6494 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6495 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6496 .cindex "sasldb2"
6497 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6498 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6499 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6500 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6501 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6502 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6503 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6504 .next
6505 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6506 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6507 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6508 .cindex "Courier"
6509 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6510 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6511 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6512 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6513 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6514 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6515 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6516 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6517 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6518 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6519 .next
6520 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6521 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6522 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6523 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6524 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6525 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6526 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6527 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6528 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6529 .next
6530 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6531 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6532 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6533 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6534 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6535 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6536 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6537 .code
6538 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6539 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6540 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6541 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6542 .endd
6543 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6544 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6545 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6546 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6547 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6548
6549 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6550 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6551 lookup types support only literal keys.
6552
6553 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6554 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6555 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6556 .next
6557 .cindex "linear search"
6558 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6559 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6560 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6561 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6562 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6563 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6564 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6565 in the file is used.
6566
6567 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6568 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6569 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6570 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6571 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6572 colon, for example:
6573 .code
6574 baduser: :fail:
6575 .endd
6576 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6577 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6578 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6579 wildcarding of any kind.
6580
6581 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6582 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6583 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6584 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6585 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6586 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6587 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6588 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6589 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6590
6591 .next
6592 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6593 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6594 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6595 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6596 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6597 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6598 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6599 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6600
6601 .next
6602 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6603 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6604 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6605 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6606 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6607 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6608 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6609 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6610 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6611
6612 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6613 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6614 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6615 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6616
6617 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6618 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6619
6620 .olist
6621 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6622 .code
6623 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6624 *fish data for anythingfish
6625 .endd
6626 .next
6627 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6628 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6629 .code
6630 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6631 .endd
6632 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6633 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6634 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6635 .code
6636 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6637 .endd
6638 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6639 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6640 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6641 .code
6642 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6643 .endd
6644
6645 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6646 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6647 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6648 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6649 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6650
6651 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6652 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6653 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6654 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6655 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6656
6657 .next
6658 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6659 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6660 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6661 example:
6662 .code
6663 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6664 .endd
6665 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6666 .endlist olist
6667
6668 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6669 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6670 be followed by optional colons.
6671
6672 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6673 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6674 lookup types support only literal keys.
6675 .endlist ilist
6676
6677
6678 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6679 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6680 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6681 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6682 many of them are given in later sections.
6683
6684 .ilist
6685 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6686 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6687 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6688 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6689 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6690 .next
6691 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6692 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6693 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6694 .next
6695 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6696 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6697 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6698 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6699 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6700 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6701 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6702 .next
6703 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6704 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6705 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6706 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6707 .next
6708 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6709 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6710 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6711 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6712 .next
6713 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6714 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6715 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6716 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6717 .next
6718 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6719 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6720 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6721 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6722 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6723 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6724 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6725 password value. For example:
6726 .code
6727 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6728 .endd
6729 .next
6730 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6731 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6732 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6733 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6734
6735 .next
6736 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6737 .cindex lookup Redis
6738 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6739 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6740
6741 .next
6742 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6743 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6744 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6745 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6746
6747 .next
6748 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6749 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6750 .next
6751 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6752 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6753 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6754 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6755 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6756 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6757 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6758 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6759 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6760 .code
6761 require condition = \
6762 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6763 .endd
6764 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6765 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6766 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6767 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6768 .endlist
6769
6770
6771
6772 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6773 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6774 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6775 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6776 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6777 options such as a list of local domains.
6778
6779 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6780 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6781 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6782 or may give up altogether.
6783
6784
6785
6786 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6787 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6788 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6789 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6790 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6791 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6792 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6793 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6794
6795 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6796 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6797 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6798
6799 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6800 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6801 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6802
6803 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6804 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6805 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6806 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6807 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6808 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6809 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6810 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6811 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6812 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6813 .code
6814 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6815 .endd
6816 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6817 looks up these keys, in this order:
6818 .code
6819 jane@eyre.example
6820 *@eyre.example
6821 *
6822 .endd
6823 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6824 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6825 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6826 Exim move on to try the next key.
6827
6828
6829
6830 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6831 .cindex "partial matching"
6832 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6833 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6834 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6835 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6836 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6837 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6838 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6839 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6840 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6841 a key in a DBM file is
6842 .code
6843 *.dates.fict.example
6844 .endd
6845 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6846 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6847 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6848 file.
6849
6850 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6851 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6852 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6853
6854 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6855 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6856 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6857 partial matching keys
6858 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6859 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6860 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6861
6862 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6863 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6864 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6865 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6866 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6867 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6868 remains.
6869
6870 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6871 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6872 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6873 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6874 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6875 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6876 .code
6877 2250.dates.fict.example
6878 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6879 *.dates.fict.example
6880 *.fict.example
6881 .endd
6882 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6883 finishes.
6884
6885 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6886 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6887 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6888 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6889 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6890 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6891 .code
6892 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6893 .endd
6894 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6895 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6896 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6897 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6898 .code
6899 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6900 .endd
6901 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6902 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6903
6904 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6905 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6906 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6907
6908 .ilist
6909 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6910 .next
6911 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6912 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6913 .next
6914 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6915 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6916 for &"*"& on its own.
6917 .next
6918 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6919 .endlist
6920
6921
6922 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6923 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6924 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6925 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6926 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6927 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6928 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6929
6930 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6931 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6932 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6933 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6934 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6935
6936
6937
6938
6939 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6940 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6941 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6942 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6943 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6944 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6945 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6946
6947 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6948 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6949 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6950 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6951 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6952 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6953
6954 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6955 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6956 complete.
6957
6958
6959
6960
6961 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6962 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6963 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6964 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6965 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6966 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6967 .code
6968 [name=$local_part]
6969 .endd
6970 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6971 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6972 .code
6973 [name="$local_part"]
6974 .endd
6975 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6976 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6977 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6978 of the following form is provided:
6979 .code
6980 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6981 .endd
6982 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6983 .code
6984 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6985 .endd
6986 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6987 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6988 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6989
6990
6991
6992
6993 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6994 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6995 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6996 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6997 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6998 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6999 an expansion string could contain:
7000 .code
7001 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7002 .endd
7003 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7004 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7005 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7006 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7007
7008 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7009 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7010 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7011
7012 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7013 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7014 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7015 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7016 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7017 .code
7018 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7019 .endd
7020 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7021 white space is ignored.
7022 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7023 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7024 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7025
7026 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7027 When the type is PTR,
7028 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7029 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7030 .code
7031 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7032 .endd
7033 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7034 altered and nothing is added.
7035
7036 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7037 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7038 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7039 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7040 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7041 The field separator can be modified as above.
7042
7043 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7044 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7045 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7046 unless a field separator is specified.
7047 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7048 For SPF records the
7049 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7050 .code
7051 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7052 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7053 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7054 .endd
7055 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7056 white space is ignored.
7057
7058 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7059 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7060 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7061 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7062 specified.
7063 .code
7064 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7065 .endd
7066
7067 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7068 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7069 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7070 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7071 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7072 each followed by a comma,
7073 that may appear before the record type.
7074
7075 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7076 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7077 a defer-option modifier.
7078 The possible keywords are
7079 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7080 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7081 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7082 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7083 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7084 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7085 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7086 .code
7087 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7088 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7089 .endd
7090 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7091 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7092
7093 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7094 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7095 The possible keywords are
7096 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7097 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7098 with the lookup.
7099 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7100 is not labelled as authenticated data
7101 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7102 The default is &"never"&.
7103
7104 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7105
7106 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7107 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7108 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7109 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7110 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7111 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7112
7113 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7114 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7115 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7116
7117 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7118 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7119 .cindex DNS TTL
7120 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7121 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7122 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7123
7124
7125 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7126 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7127 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7128 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7129 the pseudo-type MXH:
7130 .code
7131 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7132 .endd
7133 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7134 returned.
7135
7136 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7137 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7138 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7139 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7140 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7141 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7142 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7143 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7144 .code
7145 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7146 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7147 .endd
7148 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7149 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7150 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7151
7152 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7153 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7154 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7155 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7156 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7157 such a list.
7158
7159 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7160 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7161 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7162 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7163 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7164 result of a successful lookup such as:
7165 .code
7166 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7167 .endd
7168 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7169 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7170 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7171
7172 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7173 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7174 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7175 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7176 .code
7177 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7178 .endd
7179
7180
7181 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7182 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7183 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7184 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7185 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7186 .code
7187 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7188 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7189 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7190 .endd
7191 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7192 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7193 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7194 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7195
7196 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7197 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7198 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7199
7200
7201
7202
7203 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7204 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7205 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7206 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7207 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7208 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7209 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7210 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7211 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7212 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7213 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7214 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7215 .code
7216 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7217 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7218 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7219 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7220 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7221 .endd
7222 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7223 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7224
7225 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7226 the way they handle the results of a query:
7227
7228 .ilist
7229 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7230 gives an error.
7231 .next
7232 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7233 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7234 .next
7235 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7236 from all of them are returned.
7237 .endlist
7238
7239
7240 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7241 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7242 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7243 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7244
7245
7246 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7247 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7248 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7249 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7250 .code
7251 data = ${lookup ldap \
7252 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7253 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7254 .endd
7255 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7256 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7257 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7258 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7259
7260 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7261 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7262 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7263
7264 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7265 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7266 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7267 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7268 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7269 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7270 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7271 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7272 &_exim.conf_&.
7273
7274
7275 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7276 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7277 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7278 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7279 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7280 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7281
7282 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7283 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7284 the string:
7285 .code
7286 * => \2A
7287 ( => \28
7288 ) => \29
7289 \ => \5C
7290 .endd
7291 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7292 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7293 .code
7294 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7295 .endd
7296 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7297 .code
7298 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7299 .endd
7300 yields
7301 .code
7302 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7303 .endd
7304 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7305 .code
7306 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7307 .endd
7308 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7309 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7310 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7311 .code
7312 , + " \ < > ;
7313 .endd
7314 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7315 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7316 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7317 .code
7318 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7319 .endd
7320 yields
7321 .code
7322 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7323 .endd
7324 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7325 .code
7326 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7327 .endd
7328 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7329 authentication below.
7330
7331
7332 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7333 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7334 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7335 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7336 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7337 by starting it with
7338 .code
7339 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7340 .endd
7341 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7342 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7343 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7344 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7345 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7346 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7347 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7348 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7349 failures, and timeouts.
7350
7351 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7352 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7353 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7354 doubled. For example
7355 .code
7356 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7357 .endd
7358 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7359 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7360 the local host) is used.
7361
7362 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7363 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7364 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7365 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7366 not available.
7367
7368 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7369 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7370 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7371 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7372 .code
7373 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7374 .endd
7375 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7376 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7377 .code
7378 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7379 .endd
7380 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7381 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7382 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7383 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7384 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7385 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7386 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7387 backup host.
7388
7389 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7390 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7391 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7392
7393 .ilist
7394 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7395 interface.
7396 .next
7397 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7398 .endlist
7399
7400
7401 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7402 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7403
7404
7405
7406 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7407 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7408 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7409 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7410 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7411 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7412 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7413 them. The following names are recognized:
7414 .display
7415 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7416 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7417 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7418 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7419 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7420 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7421 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7422 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7423 .endd
7424 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7425 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7426 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7427 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7428
7429 .cindex LDAP timeout
7430 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7431 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7432 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7433 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7434 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7435 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7436 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7437 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7438 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7439 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7440
7441 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7442 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7443
7444 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7445 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7446 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7447 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7448 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7449 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7450 alternate list (colon-separated).
7451
7452 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7453 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7454 .code
7455 ${lookup ldap
7456 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7457 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7458 {$value}fail}
7459 .endd
7460 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7461 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7462 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7463 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7464
7465 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7466 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7467 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7468
7469 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7470 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7471 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7472 quoting has two advantages:
7473
7474 .ilist
7475 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7476 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7477 .next
7478 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7479 .endlist
7480
7481 For example, a setting such as
7482 .code
7483 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7484 .endd
7485 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7486
7487 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7488 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7489 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7490 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7491 .code
7492 PASS=${quote:$3}
7493 .endd
7494 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7495 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7496 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7497
7498
7499
7500 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7501 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7502 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7503 as a sequence of values, for example
7504 .code
7505 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7506 .endd
7507 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7508 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7509 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7510 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7511 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7512 directory.
7513
7514 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7515 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7516 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7517 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7518
7519 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7520 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7521 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7522 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7523 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7524 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7525 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7526 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7527 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7528
7529 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7530 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7531 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7532 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7533 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7534
7535 .code
7536 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7537 value1.1,value1,,2
7538
7539 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7540 value two
7541
7542 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7543 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7544
7545 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7546 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7547
7548 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7549 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7550 .endd
7551 You can
7552 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7553 results of LDAP lookups.
7554 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7555 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7556 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7557 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7558 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7559 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7560
7561
7562
7563
7564 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7565 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7566 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7567 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7568 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7569 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7570 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7571 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7572 .code
7573 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7574 .endd
7575 might return the string
7576 .code
7577 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7578 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7579 .endd
7580 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7581 .code
7582 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7583 .endd
7584 would just return
7585 .code
7586 Martin Guerre
7587 .endd
7588 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7589 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7590 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7591
7592
7593
7594 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7595 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7596 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7597 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7598 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7599 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7600 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7601 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7602 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7603 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7604 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7605 .cindex lookup Redis
7606 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7607 and SQLite
7608 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7609 might be
7610 .code
7611 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7612 {$value}fail}
7613 .endd
7614 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7615 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7616 .code
7617 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7618 {$value}}
7619 .endd
7620 might be
7621 .code
7622 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7623 .endd
7624 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7625 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7626 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7627 .code
7628 Mister X
7629 .endd
7630 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7631 with a newline between the data for each row.
7632
7633
7634 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7635 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7636 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7637 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7638 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7639 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7640 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7641 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7642 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7643 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7644 .cindex lookup Redis
7645 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7646 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7647 or &%redis_servers%&
7648 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7649 information.
7650 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7651 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7652 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7653 For all but Redis
7654 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7655 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7656 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7657 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7658 .code
7659 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7660 .endd
7661 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7662 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7663 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7664 .code
7665 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7666 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7667 .endd
7668 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7669 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7670 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7671 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7672 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7673 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7674
7675 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7676 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7677 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7678 information.
7679 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7680 host, database number, and password.
7681 .olist
7682 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7683 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7684 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7685 .next
7686 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7687 .next
7688 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7689 .endlist
7690
7691 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7692 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7693 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7694 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7695
7696 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7697 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7698
7699 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7700 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7701 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7702 done by starting the query with
7703 .display
7704 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7705 .endd
7706 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7707 .olist
7708 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7709 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7710 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7711 taken from there.
7712 .next
7713 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7714 .endlist
7715 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7716 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7717 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7718
7719 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7720 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7721 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7722 like this:
7723 .code
7724 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7725 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7726 master/db/name/pw
7727 .endd
7728 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7729 .code
7730 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7731 .endd
7732 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7733 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7734 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7735 .code
7736 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7737 .endd
7738
7739
7740 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7741 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7742 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7743 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7744 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7745 the default value is &"exim"&.
7746 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7747 .display
7748 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7749 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7750 .endd
7751 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7752 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7753
7754 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7755 the queries.
7756
7757 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7758 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7759
7760 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7761 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7762 is zero because no rows are affected.
7763
7764
7765 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7766 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7767 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7768 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7769 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7770 looks like this:
7771 .code
7772 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7773 .endd
7774 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7775 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7776 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7777
7778 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7779 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7780 affected.
7781
7782 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7783 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7784 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7785 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7786 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7787 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7788 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7789 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7790 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7791 .code
7792 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7793 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7794 .endd
7795 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7796 .code
7797 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7798 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7799 .endd
7800 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7801 quote, which it doubles.
7802
7803 .cindex timeout SQLite
7804 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7805 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7806 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7807 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7808 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7809 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7810 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7811 option.
7812
7813 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7814 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7815 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7816 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7817 Examples:
7818 .code
7819 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7820 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7821 .endd
7822
7823 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7824 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7825
7826
7827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7828 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7829
7830 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7831 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7832 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7833 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7834 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7835 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7836 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7837 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7838 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7839
7840 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7841 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7842 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7843 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7844
7845 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7846 support all the complexity available in
7847 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7848
7849
7850
7851 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7852 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7853 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7854
7855 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7856 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7857
7858 The result of
7859 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7860 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7861 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7862 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7863 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7864
7865
7866 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7867 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7868 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7869
7870 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7871 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7872 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7873 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7874 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7875 .code
7876 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7877 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7878 .endd
7879 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7880 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7881 senders based on the receiving domain.
7882
7883
7884
7885
7886 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7887 .cindex "list" "negation"
7888 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7889 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7890 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7891 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7892 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7893 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7894
7895 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7896 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7897 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7898 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7899 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7900 .code
7901 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7902 .endd
7903 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7904 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7905 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7906 .code
7907 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7908 .endd
7909 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7910 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7911 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7912
7913 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7914 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7915 item.
7916
7917
7918
7919 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7920 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7921 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7922 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7923 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7924 file names are not allowed,
7925 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7926 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7927 lines:
7928
7929 .ilist
7930 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7931 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7932 .next
7933 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7934 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7935 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7936 .code
7937 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7938 .endd
7939 .endlist
7940
7941 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7942 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7943 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7944 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7945
7946 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7947 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7948 .code
7949 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7950 .endd
7951 and the file contains the lines
7952 .code
7953 !a.b.c
7954 *.b.c
7955 .endd
7956 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7957 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7958
7959
7960
7961 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7962 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7963 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7964 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7965 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7966 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7967 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7968 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7969
7970 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7971 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7972 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7973 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7974
7975
7976
7977
7978 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7979 .cindex "named lists"
7980 .cindex "list" "named"
7981 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7982 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7983 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7984 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7985 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7986 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7987 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7988 .code
7989 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7990 .endd
7991 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7992 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7993 configured with the line
7994 .code
7995 domains = +local_domains
7996 .endd
7997 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7998 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7999 .code
8000 dnslookup:
8001 driver = dnslookup
8002 domains = ! +local_domains
8003 transport = remote_smtp
8004 no_more
8005 .endd
8006 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8007 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8008 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8009 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8010 .code
8011 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8012 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8013 .endd
8014 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8015 .code
8016 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8017 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8018 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8019 .endd
8020 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8021 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8022 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8023 .code
8024 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8025 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8026 .endd
8027 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8028 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8029 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8030 .code
8031 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8032 .endd
8033 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8034 referenced lists if you can.
8035
8036 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8037 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8038 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8039 .code
8040 domains = +local_domains
8041 .endd
8042 on several of your routers
8043 or in several ACL statements,
8044 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8045 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8046 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8047 the same each time they are referenced.
8048
8049 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8050 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8051 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8052 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8053
8054
8055
8056 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8057 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8058 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8059 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8060 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8061 write
8062 .code
8063 ALIST = host1 : host2
8064 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8065 .endd
8066 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8067 .code
8068 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8069 .endd
8070 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8071 list, and write
8072 .code
8073 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8074 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8075 .endd
8076 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8077 .code
8078 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8079 .endd
8080
8081
8082 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8083 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8084 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8085 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8086 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8087 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8088 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8089 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8090 message. For example:
8091 .code
8092 domainlist special_domains = \
8093 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8094 .endd
8095 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8096 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8097 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8098 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8099 same list each time.
8100
8101 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8102 cache the result anyway. For example:
8103 .code
8104 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8105 .endd
8106 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8107 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8108
8109
8110
8111 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8112 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8113 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8114 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8115 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8116
8117 .ilist
8118 .cindex "primary host name"
8119 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8120 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8121 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8122 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8123 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8124 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8125 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8126 differ only in their names.
8127 .next
8128 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8129 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8130 .cindex "domain literal"
8131 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8132 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8133 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8134 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8135 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8136 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8137 .next
8138 .cindex "@mx_any"
8139 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8140 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8141 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8142 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8143 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8144 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8145 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8146 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8147 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8148 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8149 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8150
8151 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8152 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8153 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8154 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8155 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8156
8157 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8158 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8159 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8160 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8161 on a router). For example:
8162 .code
8163 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8164 .endd
8165 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8166 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8167
8168 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8169 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8170 contain negative items.
8171
8172 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8173 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8174 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8175 .code
8176 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8177 an.other.domain : ...
8178 .endd
8179 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8180 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8181 .code
8182 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8183 an.other.domain ? ...
8184 .endd
8185 .next
8186 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8187 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8188 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8189 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8190 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8191 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8192 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8193 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8194 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8195 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8196
8197 .next
8198 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8199 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8200 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8201 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8202 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8203 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8204 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8205 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8206 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8207
8208 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8209 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8210 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8211 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8212 expression by expansion, of course).
8213 .next
8214 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8215 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8216 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8217 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8218 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8219 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8220 .code
8221 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8222 .endd
8223 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8224 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8225 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8226 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8227 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8228 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8229 other statements in the same ACL.
8230
8231 .next
8232 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8233 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8234 .code
8235 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8236 .endd
8237 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8238 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8239
8240 .next
8241 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8242 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8243 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8244 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8245 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8246 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8247 expansion variable.
8248 .next
8249 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8250 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8251 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8252 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8253 .code
8254 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8255 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8256 .endd
8257 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8258 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8259 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8260 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8261 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8262 .next
8263 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8264 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8265 between the pattern and the domain.
8266 .endlist
8267
8268 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8269 .code
8270 domainlist funny_domains = \
8271 @ : \
8272 lib.unseen.edu : \
8273 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8274 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8275 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8276 nis;domains.byname : \
8277 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8278 .endd
8279 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8280 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8281 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8282 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8283 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8284 patterns earlier.
8285
8286
8287
8288 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8289 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8290 .cindex "list" "host list"
8291 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8292 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8293 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8294 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8295 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8296 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8297 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8298
8299
8300 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8301 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8302 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8303 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8304 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8305 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8306 not used.
8307
8308 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8309 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8310 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8311
8312
8313
8314 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8315 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8316 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8317 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8318 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8319 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8320 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8321 concerns.)
8322
8323 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8324 inspecting its IP address:
8325
8326 .ilist
8327 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8328 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8329 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8330 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8331 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8332 with the IP address of the subject host.
8333
8334 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8335 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8336 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8337 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8338 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8339
8340 .next
8341 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8342 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8343 domain name, as just described.
8344
8345 .next
8346 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8347 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8348 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8349 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8350 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8351 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8352 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8353 that can never match a client host.
8354
8355 .next
8356 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8357 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8358 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8359 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8360 .code
8361 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8362 accept hosts = @[]
8363 .endd
8364 .next
8365 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8366 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8367 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8368 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8369 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8370 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8371 significant end of the address.
8372
8373 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8374 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8375 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8376 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8377 .code
8378 192.168.23.236/31
8379 .endd
8380 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8381 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8382 matches.
8383
8384 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8385 .code
8386 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8387 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8388 .endd
8389 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8390 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8391 For example:
8392 .code
8393 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8394 .endd
8395 could make use of a file containing
8396 .code
8397 172.16.0.0/12
8398 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8399 .endd
8400 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8401 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8402 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8403 .code
8404 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8405 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8406 .endd
8407 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8408 list.
8409 .endlist
8410
8411
8412
8413 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8414 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8415 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8416 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8417 address, the pattern takes this form:
8418 .display
8419 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8420 .endd
8421 For example:
8422 .code
8423 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8424 .endd
8425 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8426 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8427 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8428 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8429 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8430 returned by the lookup is not used.
8431
8432 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8433 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8434 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8435 patterns of this form:
8436 .display
8437 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8438 .endd
8439 For example:
8440 .code
8441 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8442 .endd
8443 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8444 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8445 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8446 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8447 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8448
8449 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8450 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8451 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8452 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8453 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8454 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8455 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8456 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8457 addresses are always used.
8458
8459 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8460 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8461 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8462 configurations.
8463
8464 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8465 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8466 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8467 case the IP address is used on its own.
8468
8469
8470
8471 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8472 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8473 .cindex "unknown host name"
8474 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8475 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8476 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8477 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8478 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8479 above.)
8480
8481 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8482 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8483 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8484 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8485 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8486 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8487 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8488
8489 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8490 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8491
8492 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8493 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8494 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8495 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8496 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8497 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8498 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8499 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8500 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8501
8502 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8503 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8504
8505 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8506 .cindex "alias for host"
8507 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8508 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8509
8510 .ilist
8511 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8512 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8513 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8514 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8515 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8516 expression.
8517 .next
8518 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8519 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8520 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8521 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8522 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8523 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8524 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8525 example,
8526 .code
8527 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8528 .endd
8529 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8530 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8531 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8532 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8533 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8534 .code
8535 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8536 .endd
8537 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8538 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8539 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8540 required.
8541 .endlist
8542
8543
8544
8545
8546 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8547 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8548 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8549 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8550 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8551 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8552
8553 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8554 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8555
8556 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8557 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8558 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8559 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8560 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8561 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8562 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8563 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8564 not recognized in an indirected file).
8565
8566 .ilist
8567 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8568 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8569 .code
8570 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8571 .endd
8572 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8573 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8574
8575 .next
8576 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8577 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8578 example:
8579 .code
8580 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8581 192.168.4.5
8582 .endd
8583 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8584 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8585 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8586 .endlist
8587
8588 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8589 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8590 list.
8591
8592 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8593 "SECTmixwilhos"
8594 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8595
8596 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8597 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8598 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8599
8600 .ilist
8601 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8602 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8603 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8604 .code
8605 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8606 .endd
8607 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8608 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8609 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8610 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8611 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8612 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8613 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8614
8615 .next
8616 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8617 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8618 .code
8619 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8620 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8621 .endd
8622 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8623 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8624 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8625 this section.
8626 .endlist
8627
8628
8629 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8630 "SECTtemdnserr"
8631 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8632 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8633 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8634 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8635 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8636 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8637 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8638 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8639 host lists such as whitelists.
8640
8641
8642
8643 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8644 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8645 .cindex "unknown host name"
8646 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8647 If a pattern is of the form
8648 .display
8649 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8650 .endd
8651 for example
8652 .code
8653 dbm;/host/accept/list
8654 .endd
8655 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8656 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8657 is not used.
8658
8659 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8660 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8661 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8662 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8663 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8664 lookup, both using the same file.
8665
8666
8667
8668 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8669 If a pattern is of the form
8670 .display
8671 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8672 .endd
8673 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8674 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8675 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8676 .code
8677 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8678 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8679 .endd
8680 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8681 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8682 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8683 operator.
8684
8685 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8686 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8687 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8688
8689 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8690 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8691 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8692 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8693 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8694 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8695
8696
8697
8698
8699
8700 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8701 .cindex "list" "address list"
8702 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8703 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8704 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8705 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8706 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8707 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8708 using this option setting:
8709 .code
8710 senders = :
8711 .endd
8712 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8713 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8714 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8715 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8716
8717 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8718 example:
8719 .code
8720 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8721 .endd
8722 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8723 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8724 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8725 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8726 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8727 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8728 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8729 .code
8730 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8731 *@+hostile_domains:\
8732 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8733 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8734 .endd
8735 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8736 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8737 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8738 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8739 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8740
8741 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8742 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8743 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8744 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8745 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8746 .code
8747 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8748 .endd
8749
8750 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8751 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8752 senders:
8753
8754 .ilist
8755 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8756 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8757 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8758 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8759 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8760 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8761 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8762 .code
8763 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8764 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8765 .endd
8766 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8767 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8768
8769 .next
8770 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8771 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8772 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8773 example:
8774 .code
8775 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8776 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8777 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8778 .endd
8779 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8780 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8781 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8782 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8783
8784 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8785 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8786 panic log.
8787 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8788 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8789 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8790 default. For example, with this lookup:
8791 .code
8792 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8793 .endd
8794 the file could contains lines like this:
8795 .code
8796 user1@domain1.example
8797 *@domain2.example
8798 .endd
8799 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8800 that are tried is:
8801 .code
8802 nimrod@jaeger.example
8803 *@jaeger.example
8804 *
8805 .endd
8806 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8807 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8808
8809 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8810 .code
8811 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8812 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8813 .endd
8814 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8815 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8816 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8817 .endlist
8818
8819
8820 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8821 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8822 always fails.
8823
8824
8825 .ilist
8826 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8827 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8828 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8829 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8830 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8831 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8832 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8833 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8834 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8835
8836 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8837 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8838 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8839 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8840 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8841 with
8842 .code
8843 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8844 .endd
8845 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8846 .code
8847 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8848 .endd
8849 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8850
8851 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8852 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8853 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8854 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8855 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8856 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8857 .code
8858 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8859 spammer3 : spammer4
8860 .endd
8861 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8862 doubling.
8863
8864 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8865 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8866 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8867 might have entries like
8868 .code
8869 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8870 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8871 *: ^\d{8}$
8872 .endd
8873 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8874 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8875 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8876 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8877
8878 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8879 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8880 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8881
8882 .next
8883 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8884 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8885 can only return a single list of local parts.
8886 .endlist
8887
8888 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8889 in these two examples:
8890 .code
8891 senders = +my_list
8892 senders = *@+my_list
8893 .endd
8894 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8895 example it is a named domain list.
8896
8897
8898
8899
8900 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8901 .cindex "case of local parts"
8902 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8903 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8904 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8905 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8906 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8907 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8908 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8909 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8910 default.
8911
8912 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8913 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8914 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8915 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8916 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8917 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8918 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8919 case-independent.
8920
8921 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8922 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8923 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8924 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8925 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8926 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8927 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8928 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8929
8930
8931
8932 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8933 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8934 .cindex "local part" "list"
8935 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8936 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8937 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8938 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8939 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8940 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8941 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8942 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8943
8944 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8945 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8946 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8947 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8948 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8949 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8950 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8951 types.
8952 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8953
8954
8955
8956
8957 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8958 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8959
8960 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8961 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8962 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8963 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8964
8965 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8966 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8967 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8968 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8969 escape character, as described in the following section.
8970
8971 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8972 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8973 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8974 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8975 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8976 reasons.
8977
8978
8979
8980 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8981 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8982 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8983 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8984 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8985 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8986 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8987 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8988
8989 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8990 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8991 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8992 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8993 .code
8994 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8995 .endd
8996 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8997 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8998 string.
8999
9000
9001
9002 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9003 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9004 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9005 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9006 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9007 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9008 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9009 encoding.
9010
9011 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9012 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9013 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9014
9015
9016 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9017 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9018 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9019 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9020 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9021 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9022 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9023 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9024 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9025 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9026 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9027 and &%nhash%&.
9028
9029 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9030 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9031 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9032
9033 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9034 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9035 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9036 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9037 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9038 .code
9039 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9040 .endd
9041 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9042 Exim message identifier. For example:
9043 .code
9044 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9045 .endd
9046 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9047 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9048
9049
9050 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9051 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9052 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9053 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9054 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9055 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9056 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9057 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9058 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9059 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9060 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9061 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9062 being expanded.
9063
9064
9065
9066
9067 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9068 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9069 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9070 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9071 white space is significant.
9072
9073 .vlist
9074 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9075 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9076 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9077 .code
9078 $local_part
9079 ${domain}
9080 .endd
9081 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9082 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9083 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9084 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9085 given, the expansion fails.
9086
9087 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9088 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9089 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9090 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9091 .code
9092 ${lc:$local_part}
9093 .endd
9094 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9095 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9096 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9097 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9098 string easier to understand.
9099
9100 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9101 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9102 expansion item below.
9103
9104
9105 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9106 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9107 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9108 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9109 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9110 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9111 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9112 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9113 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9114 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9115 the result of the expansion.
9116 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9117 the expansion result is an empty string.
9118 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9119
9120
9121 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9122 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9123 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9124 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9125 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9126 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9127 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9128 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9129 .display
9130 &`version `&
9131 &`serial_number `&
9132 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9133 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9134 &`notbefore `& time
9135 &`notafter `& time
9136 &`sig_algorithm `&
9137 &`signature `&
9138 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9139 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9140 &`crl_uri `& list
9141 .endd
9142 If the field is found,
9143 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9144 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9145 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9146 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9147
9148 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9149 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9150 extracted is used.
9151
9152 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9153
9154 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9155 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9156 not quite
9157 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9158 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9159 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9160 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9161 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9162 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9163 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9164 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9165
9166 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9167 take an optional modifier of "int"
9168 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9169 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9170 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9171
9172 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9173 newline-separated by default,
9174 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9175 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9176 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9177
9178 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9179 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9180 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9181 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9182 if so the element tags are omitted.
9183
9184 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9185
9186 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9187 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9188 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9189 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9190 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9191 .code
9192 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9193 .endd
9194 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9195 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9196 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9197
9198 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9199 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9200 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9201 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9202 must have the following type:
9203 .code
9204 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9205 .endd
9206 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9207 function should return one of the following values:
9208
9209 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9210 into the expanded string that is being built.
9211
9212 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9213 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9214
9215 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9216 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9217
9218 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9219
9220 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9221 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9222 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9223
9224
9225 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9226 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9227 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9228 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9229 removed.
9230 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9231 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9232 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9233
9234 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9235 appear, for example:
9236 .code
9237 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9238 .endd
9239 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9240 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9241
9242 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9243 search failure.
9244 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9245 search success.
9246
9247 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9248 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9249
9250
9251 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9252 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9253 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9254 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9255 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9256 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9257 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9258 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9259 .display
9260 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9261 .endd
9262 .vindex "&$value$&"
9263 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9264 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9265 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9266 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9267 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9268 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9269 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9270 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9271 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9272
9273 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9274 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9275 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9276 yield &"2001"&:
9277 .code
9278 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9279 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9280 .endd
9281 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9282 appear, for example:
9283 .code
9284 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9285 .endd
9286 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9287 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9288
9289
9290 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9291 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9292 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9293 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9294 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9295 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9296 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9297 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9298 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9299 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9300 <&'string3'&> as before.
9301
9302 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9303 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9304 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9305 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9306 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9307 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9308 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9309 provided. For example:
9310 .code
9311 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9312 .endd
9313 yields &"42"&, and
9314 .code
9315 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9316 .endd
9317 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9318 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9319
9320
9321 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9322 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9323 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9324 .vindex "&$item$&"
9325 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9326 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9327 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9328 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9329 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9330 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9331 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9332 .code
9333 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9334 .endd
9335 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9336 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9337
9338
9339 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9340 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9341 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9342 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9343 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9344 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9345
9346 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9347 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9348 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9349 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9350 .code
9351 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9352 .endd
9353 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9354 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9355 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9356 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9357 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9358 .code
9359 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9360 .endd
9361 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9362 letters appear. For example:
9363 .display
9364 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9365 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9366 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9367 .endd
9368
9369 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9370 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9371 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9372 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9373 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9374 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9375 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9376 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9377 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9378 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9379 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9380 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9381 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9382 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9383 .code
9384 $header_reply-to:
9385 .endd
9386 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9387 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9388 lines) may be present.
9389
9390 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9391 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9392
9393 .ilist
9394 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9395 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9396 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9397
9398 .next
9399 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9400 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9401 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9402 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9403 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9404 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9405 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9406 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9407
9408 .next
9409 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9410 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9411 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9412 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9413 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9414 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9415 .endlist ilist
9416
9417 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9418 command of the following form:
9419 .code
9420 headers charset "UTF-8"
9421 .endd
9422 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9423 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9424 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9425 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9426 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9427 ISO-8859-1.
9428
9429 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9430 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9431 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9432 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9433
9434 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9435 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9436 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9437 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9438 router or transport are not accessible.
9439
9440 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9441 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9442 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9443 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9444 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9445 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9446 point they are added.
9447 When any of the above ACLs ar
9448 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9449
9450 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9451 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9452 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9453 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9454 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9455 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9456 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9457 header.)
9458
9459 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9460 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9461 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9462 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9463 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9464 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9465 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9466 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9467
9468
9469 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9470 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9471 .cindex &%hmac%&
9472 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9473 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9474 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9475 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9476 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9477 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9478 present. For example:
9479 .code
9480 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9481 .endd
9482 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9483 produces:
9484 .code
9485 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9486 .endd
9487 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9488 an Exim configuration:
9489 .code
9490 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9491 .endd
9492 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9493 .code
9494 headers_add = \
9495 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9496 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9497 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9498 .endd
9499 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9500 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9501 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9502 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9503 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9504 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9505
9506
9507 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9508 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9509 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9510 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9511 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9512 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9513 .code
9514 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9515 .endd
9516 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9517 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9518 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9519 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9520 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9521
9522 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9523 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9524 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9525 .code
9526 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9527 .endd
9528 you can use
9529 .code
9530 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9531 .endd
9532
9533
9534
9535 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9536 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9537 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9538 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9539 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9540 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9541
9542
9543
9544 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9545 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9546 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9547 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9548 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9549 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9550 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9551 some of the braces:
9552 .code
9553 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9554 .endd
9555 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9556 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9557 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9558
9559
9560 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9561 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9562 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9563 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9564 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9565 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9566 apart from an optional leading minus,
9567 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9568
9569 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9570 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9571
9572 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9573 If the number is negative, the fields are
9574 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9575 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9576 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9577
9578 If the modulus of the
9579 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9580 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9581
9582 For example:
9583 .code
9584 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9585 .endd
9586 yields &"42"&, and
9587 .code
9588 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9589 .endd
9590 yields &"result: 42"&.
9591
9592 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9593 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9594 extracted is used.
9595 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9596
9597
9598 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9599 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9600 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9601 described in the next item.
9602
9603 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9604 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9605 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9606 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9607 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9608 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9609 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9610 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9611 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9612
9613 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9614 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9615 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9616 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9617 out by the system administrator.
9618
9619 .vindex "&$value$&"
9620 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9621 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9622 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9623 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9624 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9625 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9626 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9627 original lookup fails.
9628
9629 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9630 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9631 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9632 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9633 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9634 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9635 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9636 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9637
9638 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9639 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9640 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9641 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9642
9643 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9644 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9645 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9646 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9647
9648 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9649 .code
9650 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9651 .endd
9652 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9653 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9654 .code
9655 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9656 {$value}fail}
9657 .endd
9658
9659
9660 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9661 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9662 .vindex "&$item$&"
9663 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9664 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9665 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9666 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9667 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9668 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9669 .code
9670 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9671 .endd
9672 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9673 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9674 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9675
9676 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9677 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9678 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9679 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9680 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9681 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9682 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9683 .code
9684 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9685 .endd
9686 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9687 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9688 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9689 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9690 example,
9691 .code
9692 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9693 .endd
9694 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9695
9696
9697
9698 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9699 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9700 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9701 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9702 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9703 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9704 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9705 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9706
9707 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9708 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9709 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9710 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9711 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9712 not its contents.
9713
9714 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9715 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9716 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9717
9718 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9719 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9720
9721
9722 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9723 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9724 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9725 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9726 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9727 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9728 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9729 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9730
9731 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9732 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9733 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9734 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9735 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9736 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9737 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9738 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9739 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9740 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9741
9742 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9743 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9744 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9745 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9746
9747 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9748 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9749 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9750 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9751 is the expansion of the third argument.
9752
9753 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9754 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9755 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9756
9757 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9758 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9759 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9760 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9761 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9762 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9763 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9764 newlines are left in the string.
9765 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9766 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9767 the string expansion fails.
9768
9769 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9770 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9771
9772
9773
9774 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9775 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9776 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9777 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9778 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9779 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9780 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9781 examples:
9782 .code
9783 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9784 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9785 .endd
9786 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9787 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9788 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9789 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9790 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9791 example:
9792 .code
9793 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9794 .endd
9795 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9796 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9797 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9798 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9799 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9800 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9801 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9802 .code
9803 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9804 .endd
9805 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9806 and must be present if the argument is given.
9807 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9808 One option type is currently recognised, defining whether (the default)
9809 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9810 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9811 .code
9812 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9813 .endd
9814 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9815 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9816 turns them into spaces:
9817 .code
9818 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9819 .endd
9820 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9821 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9822 addition, the following errors can occur:
9823
9824 .ilist
9825 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9826 .next
9827 Failure to connect the socket;
9828 .next
9829 Failure to write the request string;
9830 .next
9831 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9832 .endlist
9833
9834 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9835 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9836 errors occurs. For example:
9837 .code
9838 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9839 {socket failure}}
9840 .endd
9841 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9842 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9843 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9844 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9845 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9846
9847 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9848 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9849
9850
9851 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9852 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9853 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9854 .vindex "&$value$&"
9855 .vindex "&$item$&"
9856 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9857 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9858 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9859 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9860 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9861 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9862 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9863 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9864 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9865 .code
9866 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9867 .endd
9868 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9869 can be found:
9870 .code
9871 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9872 .endd
9873 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9874 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9875 expansion items.
9876
9877 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9878 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9879 expansion item above.
9880
9881 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9882 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9883 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9884 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9885 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9886 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9887 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9888 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9889 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9890
9891 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9892 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9893 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9894 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9895 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9896 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9897 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9898 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9899 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9900 character.
9901
9902 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9903 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9904 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9905 .vindex "&$value$&"
9906 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9907 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9908 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9909 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9910 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9911 &$value$&.
9912
9913 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9914 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9915 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9916 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9917
9918 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9919 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9920 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9921 troubleshoot:
9922 .code
9923 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9924 log_message = Output of id: $value
9925 .endd
9926 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9927 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9928 .code
9929 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9930 .endd
9931
9932 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9933 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9934 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9935 .code
9936 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9937 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9938 ...
9939 endif
9940 .endd
9941 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9942 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9943 commands.
9944
9945 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9946 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9947 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9948 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9949
9950 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9951 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9952
9953
9954 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9955 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9956 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9957 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9958 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9959 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9960 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9961 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9962 .code
9963 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9964 .endd
9965 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9966 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9967 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9968 .code
9969 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9970 .endd
9971 yields &"defabc"&, and
9972 .code
9973 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9974 .endd
9975 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9976 the regular expression from string expansion.
9977
9978
9979
9980 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9981 .cindex sorting "a list"
9982 .cindex list sorting
9983 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9984 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9985 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9986 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9987 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9988 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9989 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9990 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9991 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9992 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9993 to give values for comparison.
9994
9995 The item result is a sorted list,
9996 with the original list separator,
9997 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9998
9999 Examples:
10000 .code
10001 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10002 .endd
10003 sorts a list of numbers, and
10004 .code
10005 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10006 .endd
10007 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10008
10009
10010 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10011 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10012 .cindex "substring extraction"
10013 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10014 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10015 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10016 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10017 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10018 .code
10019 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10020 .endd
10021 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10022 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10023 omitted.
10024
10025 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10026 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10027 length required. For example
10028 .code
10029 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10030 .endd
10031 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10032 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10033 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10034 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
10035
10036 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10037 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
10038 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10039 .code
10040 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10041 .endd
10042 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10043 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10044 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10045 .code
10046 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10047 .endd
10048 yields an empty string, but
10049 .code
10050 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10051 .endd
10052 yields &"1"&.
10053
10054 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10055 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
10056 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10057 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10058 .code
10059 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10060 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10061 .endd
10062 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10063
10064
10065
10066 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10067 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10068 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10069 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10070 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
10071 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10072 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10073 replacement list. For example
10074 .code
10075 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10076 .endd
10077 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10078 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10079 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10080 place.
10081 .endlist
10082
10083
10084
10085 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10086 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10087 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10088 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10089 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10090 following operations can be performed:
10091
10092 .vlist
10093 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10094 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10095 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10096 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10097 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10098 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10099
10100
10101 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10102 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10103 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10104 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10105 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10106 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10107 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10108 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10109 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10110
10111 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10112 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10113 character. For example:
10114 .code
10115 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10116 .endd
10117 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10118 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10119 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10120 processing lists.
10121
10122 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10123 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10124 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10125 email address separator. For the example header line:
10126 .code
10127 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10128 .endd
10129 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10130 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10131 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10132 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10133 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10134 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10135 quoted.
10136 .code
10137 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10138 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10139 user@example.com
10140 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10141 Last:user@example.com
10142 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10143 user@example.com
10144 .endd
10145
10146 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10147 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10148 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10149 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10150 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10151 Only lowercase letters are used.
10152
10153 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10154 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10155 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10156 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10157 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10158
10159 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10160 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10161 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10162 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10163 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10164 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10165 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10166 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10167 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10168
10169 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10170 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10171 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10172 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10173 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10174 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10175 string.
10176
10177 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10178 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10179 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10180 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10181 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10182 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10183
10184 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10185 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10186
10187
10188 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10189 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10190 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10191 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10192 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10193
10194
10195 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10196 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10197 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10198 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10199 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10200
10201
10202 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10203 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10204 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10205 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10206 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10207 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10208 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10209
10210 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10211 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10212 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10213 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10214 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10215 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10216
10217
10218 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10219 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10220 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10221 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10222 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10223 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10224 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10225 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10226 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10227 C programming language):
10228 .table2 70pt 300pt
10229 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10230 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10231 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10232 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10233 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10234 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10235 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10236 .endtable
10237 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10238 space is permitted before or after operators.
10239
10240 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10241 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10242 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10243 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10244 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10245
10246 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10247 or 1024*1024*1024,
10248 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10249 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10250
10251 .display
10252 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10253 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10254 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10255 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10256 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10257 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10258 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10259 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10260 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10261 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10262 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10263 .endd
10264
10265 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10266 .code
10267 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10268 condition = \
10269 ${if and { \
10270 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10271 { \
10272 < \
10273 {$recipients_count} \
10274 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10275 } \
10276 }{yes}{no}}
10277 .endd
10278 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10279 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10280
10281
10282 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10283 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10284 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10285 example,
10286 .code
10287 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10288 .endd
10289 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10290 and then re-expands what it has found.
10291
10292
10293 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10294 .cindex "Unicode"
10295 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10296 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10297 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10298 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10299 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10300 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10301 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10302 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10303 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10304
10305 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10306 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10307 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10308 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10309 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10310 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10311 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10312
10313
10314 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10315 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10316 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10317 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10318 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10319 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10320 .code
10321 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10322 .endd
10323 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10324 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10325
10326
10327
10328 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10329 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10330 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10331 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10332 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10333 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10334
10335
10336
10337 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10338 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10339 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10340 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10341 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10342 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10343 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10344
10345
10346 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10347 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10348 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10349 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10350 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10351 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10352 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10353
10354 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10355 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10356 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10357 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10358 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10359 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10360 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10361 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10362 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10363
10364
10365 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10366 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10367 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10368 .cindex "lower casing"
10369 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10370 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10371 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10372 .code
10373 ${lc:$local_part}
10374 .endd
10375
10376 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10377 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10378 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10379 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10380 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10381 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10382 .code
10383 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10384 .endd
10385 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10386 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10387 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10388
10389
10390 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10391 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10392 .cindex "list" "item count"
10393 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10394 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10395 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10396
10397
10398 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10399 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10400 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10401 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10402 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10403 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10404 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10405 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10406 matching list is returned.
10407
10408
10409 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10410 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10411 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10412 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10413 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10414 empty.
10415
10416
10417 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10418 .cindex "masked IP address"
10419 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10420 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10421 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10422 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10423 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10424 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10425 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10426 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10427 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10428 .code
10429 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10430 .endd
10431 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10432 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10433 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10434 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10435 .code
10436 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10437 .endd
10438 returns the string
10439 .code
10440 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10441 .endd
10442 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10443
10444
10445 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10446 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10447 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10448 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10449 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10450 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10451 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10452
10453 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10454 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10455
10456
10457 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10458 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10459 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10460 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10461 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10462 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10463 .code
10464 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10465 .endd
10466 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10467
10468
10469 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10470 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10471 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10472 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10473 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10474 is an empty string or
10475 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10476 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10477 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10478 respectively For example,
10479 .code
10480 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10481 .endd
10482 becomes
10483 .code
10484 "ab\"*\"cd"
10485 .endd
10486 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10487 variable or a message header.
10488
10489 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10490 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10491 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10492 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10493 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10494 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10495 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10496
10497
10498 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10499 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10500 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10501 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10502 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10503 .code
10504 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10505 .endd
10506 returns
10507 .code
10508 two%20%5C2A%20two
10509 .endd
10510 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10511 yields an unchanged string.
10512
10513
10514 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10515 .cindex "random number"
10516 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10517 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10518 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10519 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10520 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10521 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10522 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10523 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10524 random().
10525
10526
10527 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10528 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10529 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10530 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10531 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10532 for DNS. For example,
10533 .code
10534 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10535 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10536 .endd
10537 returns
10538 .code
10539 4.2.0.192
10540 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10541 .endd
10542
10543
10544 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10545 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10546 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10547 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10548 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10549 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10550 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10551 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10552 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10553 characters
10554 .code
10555 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10556 .endd
10557 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10558 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10559 characters.
10560
10561
10562 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10563 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10564 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10565 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10566 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10567 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10568 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10569 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10570
10571 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10572 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10573 to use this operator as well.
10574
10575
10576
10577 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10578 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10579 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10580 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10581 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10582 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10583 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10584
10585
10586 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10587 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10588 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10589 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10590 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10591 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10592 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10593
10594 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10595 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10596
10597
10598 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10599 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10600 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10601 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10602 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10603 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10604 and returns
10605 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10606
10607 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10608 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10609
10610
10611 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10612 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10613 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10614 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10615 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10616 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10617 and returns
10618 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10619
10620 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10621 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10622 with 256 being the default.
10623
10624 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10625 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later.
10626
10627
10628 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10629 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10630 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10631 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10632 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10633 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10634 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10635 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10636 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10637 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10638 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10639 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10640 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10641
10642 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10643 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10644 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10645
10646 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10647 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10648 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10649
10650
10651
10652 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10653 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10654 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10655 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10656 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10657 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10658
10659
10660 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10661 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10662 .cindex "substring extraction"
10663 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10664 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10665 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10666 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10667 .code
10668 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10669 .endd
10670 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10671 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10672
10673 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10674 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10675 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10676 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10677 seconds.
10678
10679 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10680 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10681 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10682 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10683 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10684 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10685 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10686
10687 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10688 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10689 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10690 .cindex "upper casing"
10691 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10692 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10693 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10694
10695 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10696 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10697 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10698 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10699 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10700 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10701 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10702
10703 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10704 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10705 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10706 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10707 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10708 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10709 .cindex EAI
10710 .cindex internationalisation
10711 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10712 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10713 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10714 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10715 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10716 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10717 .endlist
10718
10719
10720
10721
10722
10723
10724 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10725 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10726 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10727 while expanding strings:
10728
10729 .vlist
10730 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10731 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10732 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10733 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10734 condition.
10735
10736 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10737 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10738 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10739 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10740 are:
10741 .display
10742 &`= `& equal
10743 &`== `& equal
10744 &`> `& greater
10745 &`>= `& greater or equal
10746 &`< `& less
10747 &`<= `& less or equal
10748 .endd
10749 For example:
10750 .code
10751 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10752 .endd
10753 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10754 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10755 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10756 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10757 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10758 zero.
10759
10760 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10761 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10762 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10763
10764
10765 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10766 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10767 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10768 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10769 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10770 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10771 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10772 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10773 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10774 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10775 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10776 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10777 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10778 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10779
10780 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10781 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10782 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10783 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10784 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10785 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10786 false if zero.
10787 An empty string is treated as false.
10788 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10789 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10790 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10791
10792 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10793 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10794 For example:
10795 .code
10796 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10797 .endd
10798
10799
10800 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10801 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10802 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10803 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10804 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10805 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10806 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10807 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10808
10809 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10810
10811 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10812 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10813 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10814 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10815 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10816 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10817 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10818 included in the binary.
10819
10820 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10821 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10822 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10823 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10824 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10825 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10826 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10827 string in LDAP form is:
10828 .code
10829 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10830 .endd
10831 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10832 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10833 .code
10834 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10835 .endd
10836 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10837 supported:
10838
10839 .ilist
10840 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10841 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10842 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10843 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10844 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10845 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10846 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10847 comparison fails.
10848
10849 .next
10850 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10851 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10852 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10853 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10854 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10855 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10856
10857 .next
10858 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10859 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10860 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10861 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10862 whatever its length.
10863
10864 .next
10865 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10866 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10867 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10868 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10869 .endlist
10870 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10871 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10872 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10873 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10874 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10875 support &[crypt16()]&.
10876
10877 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10878 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10879 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10880 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10881 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10882
10883 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10884 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10885 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10886
10887 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10888 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10889 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10890 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10891 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10892
10893 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10894 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10895 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10896 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10897 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10898 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10899 .code
10900 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10901 .endd
10902 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10903 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10904
10905 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10906 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10907 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10908 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10909 exists in the message. For example,
10910 .code
10911 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10912 .endd
10913 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10914 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10915
10916 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10917 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10918 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10919 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10920 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10921 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10922 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10923 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10924 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10925
10926 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10927 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10928 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10929 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10930 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10931 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10932 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10933 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10934
10935 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10936 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10937 .cindex "first delivery"
10938 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10939 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10940 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10941 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10942
10943
10944 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10945 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10946 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10947 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10948 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10949 .vindex "&$item$&"
10950 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10951 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10952 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10953 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10954 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10955 .ilist
10956 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10957 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10958 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10959 .next
10960 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10961 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10962 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10963 .endlist
10964 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10965 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10966 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10967 list separator is changed to a comma:
10968 .code
10969 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10970 .endd
10971 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10972 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10973
10974 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10975
10976
10977 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10978 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10979 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10980 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10981 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10982 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10983 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10984 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10985 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10986 case-independent.
10987
10988 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10989 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10990 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10991 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10992 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10993 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10994 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10995 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10996 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10997 case-independent.
10998
10999 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11000 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11001 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11002 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11003 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11004 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11005 is true.
11006
11007 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11008 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11009 .code
11010 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11011 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11012 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11013 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11014 .endd
11015
11016 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11017 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11018 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11019 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11020 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11021 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11022 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11023 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11024 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11025 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11026 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11027
11028 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11029 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11030 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11031 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11032 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11033
11034 .new
11035 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11036 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11037 check.
11038 This is no longer the case.
11039 .wen
11040
11041 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11042 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11043 .code
11044 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11045 .endd
11046 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11047
11048 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11049 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11050 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11051 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11052 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11053 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11054 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11055 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11056 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11057 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11058 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11059 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11060 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11061 this can be used.
11062
11063
11064 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11065 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11066 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11067 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11068 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11069 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11070 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11071 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11072 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11073 case-independent.
11074
11075 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11076 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11077 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11078 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11079 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11080 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11081 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11082 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11083 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11084 case-independent.
11085
11086
11087 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11088 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11089 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11090 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11091 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11092 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11093 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11094 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11095 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11096 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11097 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11098 For example,
11099 .code
11100 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11101 .endd
11102 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11103 backslashes is also required.
11104
11105 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11106 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11107 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11108 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11109 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11110 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11111
11112 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11113 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11114 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11115 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11116 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11117 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11118 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11119 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11120
11121 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11122 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11123 See &*match_local_part*&.
11124
11125 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11126 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11127 See &*match_local_part*&.
11128
11129 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11130 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11131 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11132 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11133 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11134 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11135 .code
11136 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11137 .endd
11138 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11139
11140 .ilist
11141 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11142 .next
11143 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11144 .next
11145 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11146 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11147 in a single test such as
11148 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11149 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11150 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11151 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11152 .code
11153 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11154 .endd
11155 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11156 .next
11157 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11158 .next
11159 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11160 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11161 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11162 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11163 masks. For example:
11164 .code
11165 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11166 .endd
11167 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11168 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11169 address mask, for example:
11170 .code
11171 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11172 .endd
11173 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11174 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11175 .code
11176 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11177 .endd
11178 .endlist ilist
11179
11180 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11181 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11182
11183 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11184
11185 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11186 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11187 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11188 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11189 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11190 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11191 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11192 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11193 example is:
11194 .code
11195 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11196 .endd
11197 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11198 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
11199 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11200 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11201 .code
11202 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11203 .endd
11204 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11205 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11206 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11207 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11208 caselessly.
11209
11210 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11211 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11212
11213 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11214 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11215 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11216 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11217
11218 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11219 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11220 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11221 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11222 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11223 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11224 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11225 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11226 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11227 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11228 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11229 .code
11230 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11231 .endd
11232 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11233 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11234
11235 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11236 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11237 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11238 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11239 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11240 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11241 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11242
11243 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11244 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11245 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11246 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11247 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11248 .code
11249 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11250 .endd
11251 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11252 .code
11253 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11254 .endd
11255 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11256 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11257 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11258 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11259 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11260 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11261 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11262 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11263
11264
11265 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11266 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11267 .cindex "Cyrus"
11268 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11269 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11270 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11271 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11272 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11273 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11274
11275 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11276 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11277 building Exim. For example:
11278 .code
11279 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11280 .endd
11281 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11282 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11283 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11284 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11285
11286 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11287 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11288 configuration, you might have this:
11289 .code
11290 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11291 .endd
11292 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11293 .code
11294 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11295 .endd
11296 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11297 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11298 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11299 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11300 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11301 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11302
11303
11304 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11305 .cindex "Radius"
11306 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11307 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11308 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11309 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11310 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11311 support.
11312
11313 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11314 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11315 this library, you need to set
11316 .code
11317 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11318 .endd
11319 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11320 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11321 .code
11322 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11323 .endd
11324 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11325 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11326 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11327
11328 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11329 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11330 the authentication is successful. For example:
11331 .code
11332 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11333 .endd
11334
11335
11336 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11337 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11338 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11339 .cindex "Cyrus"
11340 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11341 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11342 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11343 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11344 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11345 by a process that is not running as root.
11346
11347 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11348 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11349 building Exim. For example:
11350 .code
11351 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11352 .endd
11353 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11354 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11355 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11356
11357 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11358 two are mandatory. For example:
11359 .code
11360 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11361 .endd
11362 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11363 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11364 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11365 .endlist vlist
11366
11367
11368
11369 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11370 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11371 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11372 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11373 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11374 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11375 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11376
11377
11378 .vlist
11379 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11380 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11381 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11382 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11383 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11384 For example,
11385 .code
11386 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11387 .endd
11388 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11389 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11390 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11391
11392 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11393 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11394 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11395 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11396 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11397 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11398 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11399 parsed but not evaluated.
11400 .endlist
11401 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11402
11403
11404
11405
11406 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11407 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11408 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11409 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11410 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11411
11412 .vlist
11413 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11414 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11415 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11416 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11417 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11418 In the expansion condition case
11419 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11420 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11421 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11422 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11423 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11424 matching condition.
11425
11426 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11427 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11428 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11429 any unused variables being made empty.
11430
11431 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11432 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11433 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11434 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11435 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11436 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11437 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11438 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11439 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11440 during subsequent delivery.
11441
11442 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11443 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11444 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11445 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11446 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11447 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11448 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11449 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11450 delivery.
11451
11452 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11453 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11454 this variable has the number of arguments.
11455
11456 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11457 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11458 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11459 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11460 be preserved by coding like this:
11461 .code
11462 warn !verify = sender
11463 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11464 .endd
11465 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11466 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11467 failure.
11468
11469 .vitem &$address_data$&
11470 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11471 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11472 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11473 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11474 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11475 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11476 user filter files.
11477
11478 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11479 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11480 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11481 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11482 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11483 from the child's routing.
11484
11485 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11486 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11487 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11488 address.
11489
11490 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11491 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11492 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11493
11494 .vitem &$address_file$&
11495 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11496 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11497 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11498 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11499 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11500 .code
11501 /home/r2d2/savemail
11502 .endd
11503 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11504 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11505 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11506 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11507 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11508 to the relevant file.
11509
11510 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11511 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11512 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11513 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11514
11515 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11516 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11517 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11518 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11519
11520 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11521 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11522 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11523 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11524 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11525 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11526 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11527 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11528 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11529 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11530 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11531 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11532 command line option.
11533
11534 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11535 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11536 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11537 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11538 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11539 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11540 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11541 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11542 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11543 the ACL's as well.
11544
11545
11546 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11547 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11548 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11549 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11550 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11551 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11552 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11553 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11554 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11555 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11556 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11557
11558 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11559 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11560 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11561 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11562 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11563
11564
11565 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11566 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11567 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11568 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11569 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11570 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11571 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11572 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11573 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11574 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11575 an undefined mechanism.
11576
11577 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11578 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11579 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11580 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11581 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11582 the ACL malware condition.
11583
11584 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11585 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11586 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11587 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11588 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11589 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11590
11591 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11592 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11593 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11594 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11595 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11596 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11597 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11598
11599 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11600 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11601 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11602 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11603 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11604
11605 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11606 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11607 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11608 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11609 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11610
11611 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11612 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11613 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11614 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11615 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11616 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11617 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11618
11619 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11620 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11621 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11622 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11623 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11624 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11625 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11626
11627 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11628 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11629 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11630 address that was connected to.
11631
11632 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11633 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11634 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11635 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11636 compilations of the same version of the program.
11637
11638 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11639 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11640 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11641 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11642 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11643 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11644
11645 .vitem &$config_file$&
11646 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11647 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11648
11649 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11650 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11651 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11652 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11653 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11654 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11655 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11656 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11657 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11658 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11659 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11660 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11661 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11662 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11663 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11664 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11665 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11666 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11667 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11668 &$dkim_key_length$&
11669 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11670 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11671
11672 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11673 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11674 When a message has been received this variable contains
11675 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11676 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11677
11678 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11679 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11680 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11681 &$dnslist_value$&
11682 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11683 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11684 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11685 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11686 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11687 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11688 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11689 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11690 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11691
11692 .vitem &$domain$&
11693 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11694 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11695 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11696 case for &$domain$&.
11697
11698 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11699 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11700 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11701 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11702
11703 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11704 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11705 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11706 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11707 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11708 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11709
11710 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11711 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11712 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11713
11714 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11715
11716 .ilist
11717 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11718 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11719 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11720 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11721 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11722 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11723 the &(smtp)& transport.
11724
11725 .next
11726 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11727 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11728 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11729 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11730
11731 .next
11732 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11733 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11734 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11735 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11736 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11737 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11738
11739 .next
11740 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11741 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11742 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11743 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11744 .endlist
11745
11746
11747 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11748 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11749 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11750 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11751 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11752 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11753 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11754 used.
11755
11756 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11757 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11758 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11759 to nothing.
11760
11761 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11762 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11763 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11764
11765 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11766 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11767 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11768
11769 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11770 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11771 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11772
11773 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11774 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11775 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11776 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11777 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11778 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11779
11780 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11781 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11782 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11783 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11784 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11785
11786 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11787 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11788 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11789 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11790 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11791
11792 .vitem &$home$&
11793 .vindex "&$home$&"
11794 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11795 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11796 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11797 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11798 by a setting on the transport itself.
11799
11800 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11801 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11802 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11803
11804 .vitem &$host$&
11805 .vindex "&$host$&"
11806 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11807 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11808 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11809 to local and remote transports.
11810
11811 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11812 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11813 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11814 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11815 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11816 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11817 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11818 is connected.
11819
11820 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11821 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11822 client is connected.
11823
11824
11825 .vitem &$host_address$&
11826 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11827 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11828 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11829 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11830
11831 .vitem &$host_data$&
11832 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11833 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11834 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11835 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11836 .code
11837 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11838 message = $host_data
11839 .endd
11840 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11841 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11842 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11843 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11844 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11845 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11846 variables is set to &"1"&.
11847
11848 .ilist
11849 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11850 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11851
11852 .next
11853 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11854 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11855 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11856 .endlist ilist
11857
11858 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11859 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11860 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11861 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11862 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11863 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11864 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11865 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11866 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11867 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11868
11869 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11870 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11871 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11872
11873 .vitem &$host_port$&
11874 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11875 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11876 for an outbound connection.
11877
11878 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
11879 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
11880 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
11881 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
11882 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
11883 to &$spool_directory$& later.
11884
11885 .vitem &$inode$&
11886 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11887 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11888 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11889 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11890 a unique name for the file.
11891
11892 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11893 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11894 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11895
11896 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11897 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11898 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11899
11900 .vitem &$item$&
11901 .vindex "&$item$&"
11902 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11903 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11904 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11905 empty.
11906
11907 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11908 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11909 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11910 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11911 lookup.
11912
11913 .vitem &$load_average$&
11914 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11915 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11916 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11917 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11918
11919 .vitem &$local_part$&
11920 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11921 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11922 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11923 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11924 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11925
11926 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11927 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11928 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11929 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11930 once.
11931
11932 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11933 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11934 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11935 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11936 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11937 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11938
11939 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11940 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11941 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11942 &$address_pipe$&).
11943
11944 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11945 local part of the recipient address.
11946
11947 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11948 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11949 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11950
11951 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11952 the addresses
11953 .code
11954 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11955 abc\:xyz@test.example
11956 .endd
11957 the value of &$local_part$& is
11958 .code
11959 abc:xyz
11960 .endd
11961 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11962 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11963 have:
11964 .code
11965 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11966 .endd
11967 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11968 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11969 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11970
11971 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11972 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11973 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11974 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11975 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11976 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11977 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11978
11979 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11980 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11981 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11982 variable expands to nothing.
11983
11984 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11985 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11986 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11987 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11988 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11989
11990 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11991 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11992 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11993 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11994 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11995
11996 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11997 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11998 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11999 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12000
12001 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12002 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12003 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12004
12005 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12006 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12007 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12008 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12009 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12010 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12011 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12012 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12013
12014 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12015 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12016 This contains the expanded value of the
12017 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12018 been read.
12019
12020 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12021 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12022 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12023 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12024 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12025 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12026
12027 .vitem &$log_space$&
12028 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12029 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12030 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12031 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12032 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12033 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12034
12035
12036 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12037 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12038 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12039 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12040 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12041 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12042 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12043 and &"yes"& if it was.
12044 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12045 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12046 as authenticated data.
12047
12048 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12049 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12050 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12051 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12052 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12053 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12054 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12055 variable is empty.
12056
12057 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12058 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12059 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12060 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12061 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12062
12063 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12064 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12065 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12066 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12067 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12068 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12069 character(s).
12070
12071 .vitem &$message_age$&
12072 .cindex "message" "age of"
12073 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12074 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12075 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12076 delivery attempt.
12077
12078 .vitem &$message_body$&
12079 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12080 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12081 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12082 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12083 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12084 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12085 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12086 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12087 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12088
12089 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12090 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12091 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12092 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12093 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12094
12095 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12096 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12097 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12098 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12099 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12100 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12101 &$message_body$&.
12102
12103 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12104 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12105 .cindex "message body" "size"
12106 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12107 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12108 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12109 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12110 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12111
12112 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12113 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12114 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12115 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12116 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12117 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12118 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12119 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12120
12121 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12122 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12123 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12124 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12125 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12126 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12127
12128 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12129 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12130 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12131 contents of header lines is done.
12132
12133 .vitem &$message_id$&
12134 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12135
12136 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12137 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12138 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12139 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12140 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12141 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12142 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12143 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12144 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12145 from the body is not counted.
12146
12147 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12148 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12149 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12150 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12151 header and the body).
12152
12153 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12154 .code
12155 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12156 condition = \
12157 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12158 .endd
12159 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12160 message has not yet been received.
12161
12162 .vitem &$message_size$&
12163 .cindex "size" "of message"
12164 .cindex "message" "size"
12165 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12166 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12167 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12168 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12169 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12170 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12171 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12172 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12173 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12174
12175 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12176 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12177 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12178 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12179
12180 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12181 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12182 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12183 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12184
12185 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12186 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12187 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12188
12189 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12190 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12191 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12192 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12193 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12194 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12195 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12196 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12197 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12198 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12199
12200 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12201 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12202 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12203
12204 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12205 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12206 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12207 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12208 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12209 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12210 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12211 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12212 the original address.
12213
12214 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12215 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12216 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12217 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12218 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12219
12220 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12221 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12222 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12223
12224 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12225 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12226 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12227 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12228 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12229 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12230 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12231 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12232 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12233
12234 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12235 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12236 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12237 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12238 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12239 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12240 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12241 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12242 user.
12243
12244 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12245 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12246 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12247 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12248
12249 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12250 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12251 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12252 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12253
12254 .vitem &$pid$&
12255 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12256 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12257 This variable contains the current process id.
12258
12259 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12260 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12261 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12262 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12263 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12264 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12265 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12266 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12267 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12268 variable"& error if encountered.
12269
12270 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12271 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12272 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12273 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12274 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12275 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12276 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12277
12278
12279 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12280 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12281 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12282 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12283 &$proxy_session$&
12284 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12285 or SOCKS5 support.
12286 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12287
12288 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12289 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12290 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12291 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12292
12293 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12294 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12295 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12296 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12297
12298 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12299 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12300 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12301 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12302
12303 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12304 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12305 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12306 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12307
12308 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12309 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12310 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12311
12312 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12313 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12314 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12315 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12316
12317 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12318 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12319 .cindex "named queues"
12320 .cindex queues named
12321 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12322
12323 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12324 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12325 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12326 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12327 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12328
12329 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12330 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12331 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12332 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12333 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12334 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12335
12336 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12337 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12338 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12339 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12340 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12341
12342 .vitem &$received_count$&
12343 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12344 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12345 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12346 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12347 delivering.
12348
12349 .vitem &$received_for$&
12350 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12351 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12352 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12353 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12354 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12355
12356 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12357 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12358 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12359 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12360 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12361 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12362 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12363 option.
12364
12365 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12366 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12367 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12368 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12369 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12370 time.
12371 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12372
12373 .vitem &$received_port$&
12374 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12375 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12376
12377 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12378 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12379 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12380 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12381 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12382 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12383 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12384 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12385 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12386
12387 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12388 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12389 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12390 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12391 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12392 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12393
12394 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12395 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12396 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12397
12398 .vitem &$received_time$&
12399 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12400 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12401 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12402
12403 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12404 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12405 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12406 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12407 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12408 .display
12409 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12410 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12411 .endd
12412 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12413 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12414 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12415 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12416
12417 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12418 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12419 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12420 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12421
12422 .ilist
12423 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12424 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12425
12426 .next
12427 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12428
12429 .next
12430 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12431 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12432 MAIL).
12433
12434 .next
12435 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12436 .next
12437
12438 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12439 .endlist
12440
12441 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12442 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12443
12444 .vitem &$recipients$&
12445 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12446 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12447 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12448 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12449 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12450 cases:
12451
12452 .olist
12453 In a system filter file.
12454 .next
12455 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12456 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12457 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12458 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12459 .next
12460 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12461 .endlist
12462
12463
12464 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12465 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12466 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12467 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12468 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12469 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12470
12471
12472 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12473 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12474 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12475 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12476
12477 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12478 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12479 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12480 these variables contain the
12481 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12482
12483
12484 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12485 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12486 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12487 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12488 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12489 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12490 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12491
12492 .vitem &$return_path$&
12493 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12494 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12495 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12496 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12497 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12498 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12499 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12500 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12501 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12502 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12503 envelope sender.
12504
12505 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12506 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12507 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12508
12509 .vitem &$router_name$&
12510 .cindex "router" "name"
12511 .cindex "name" "of router"
12512 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12513 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12514
12515 .vitem &$runrc$&
12516 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12517 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12518 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12519 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12520 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12521 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12522 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12523 another.
12524
12525 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12526 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12527 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12528 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12529 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12530 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12531 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12532 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12533
12534 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12535 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12536 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12537 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12538 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12539 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12540
12541 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12542 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12543 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12544 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12545 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12546 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12547 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12548 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12549
12550 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12551 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12552 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12553
12554 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12555 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12556 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12557
12558 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12559 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12560 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12561 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12562 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12563 this:
12564 .display
12565 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12566 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12567 .endd
12568 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12569 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12570 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12571 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12572
12573 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12574 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12575 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12576 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12577 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12578 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12579 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12580 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12581 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12582 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12583 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12584 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12585 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12586
12587 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12588 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12589 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12590 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12591 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12592
12593 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12594 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12595 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12596 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12597 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12598 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12599
12600 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12601 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12602 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12603 this variable contains that
12604 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12605
12606 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12607 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12608 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12609 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12610 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12611 &$authenticated_id$&.
12612
12613 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12614 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12615 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12616 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12617 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12618 resolver library states that both
12619 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12620 other times, this variable is false.
12621
12622 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12623 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12624 library, by setting:
12625 .code
12626 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12627 .endd
12628
12629 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12630 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12631
12632 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12633 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12634
12635 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12636 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12637 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12638 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12639
12640
12641 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12642 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12643 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12644 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12645 other means, this variable is empty.
12646
12647 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12648 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12649 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12650 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12651 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12652 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12653 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12654
12655 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12656 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12657 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12658 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12659
12660 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12661 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12662 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12663 is set to &"1"&.
12664
12665 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12666 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12667 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12668 following are true:
12669
12670 .ilist
12671 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12672 .next
12673 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12674 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12675 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12676 .next
12677 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12678 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12679 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12680 .next
12681 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12682 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12683 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12684 .next
12685 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12686 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12687 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12688 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12689 .code
12690 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12691 .endd
12692 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12693 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12694 .endlist
12695
12696
12697 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12698 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12699 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12700 number that was used on the remote host.
12701
12702 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12703 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12704 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12705 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12706 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12707 called Exim.
12708
12709 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12710 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12711 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12712 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12713
12714 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12715 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12716 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12717 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12718 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12719 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12720 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12721 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12722 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12723 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12724 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12725 the parentheses.
12726
12727 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12728 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12729 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12730 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12731 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12732
12733 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12734 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12735 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12736 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12737 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12738
12739 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12740 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12741 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12742 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12743 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12744 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12745 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12746
12747 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12748 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12749 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12750 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12751 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12752
12753 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12754 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12755 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12756 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12757 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12758 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12759
12760 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12761 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12762 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12763 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12764 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12765 .code
12766 MAIL FROM:<>
12767 MAIL FROM: <>
12768 .endd
12769 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12770 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12771 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12772 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12773
12774 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12775 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12776 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12777 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12778 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12779 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12780 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12781
12782 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12783 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12784 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12785 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12786 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12787 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12788 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12789 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12790 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12791 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12792 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12793
12794 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12795 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12796 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12797 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12798 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12799 message is junk mail.
12800
12801 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12802 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12803 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12804 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12805
12806
12807 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12808 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12809 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12810
12811 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12812 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12813 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12814 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12815 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12816 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12817
12818 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12819 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12820 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12821 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12822 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12823 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12824 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12825 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12826 .code
12827 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12828 .endd
12829 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12830
12831
12832 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12833 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12834 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12835 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12836 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12837 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12838
12839 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12840 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12841 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12842 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12843 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12844 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12845 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12846 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12847
12848 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12849 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12850 the outbound.
12851
12852 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12853 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12854 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12855 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12856 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12857 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12858
12859 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12860 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12861 .cindex certificate variables
12862 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12863 inbound connection when the message was received.
12864 It is only useful as the argument of a
12865 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12866 or a &%def%& condition.
12867
12868 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12869 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12870 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12871 inbound connection when the message was received.
12872 It is only useful as the argument of a
12873 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12874 or a &%def%& condition.
12875 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12876 which is not the leaf.
12877
12878 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12879 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12880 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12881 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12882 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12883 or a &%def%& condition.
12884
12885 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12886 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12887 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12888 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12889 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12890 or a &%def%& condition.
12891 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12892 which is not the leaf.
12893
12894 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12895 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12896 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12897 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12898
12899 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12900 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12901 the outbound.
12902
12903 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12904 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12905 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12906 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12907 and &"0"& otherwise.
12908
12909 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12910 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12911 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12912 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12913 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12914 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12915 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12916 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12917 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12918
12919 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12920 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12921 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12922
12923 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12924 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12925 This variable is
12926 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12927 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12928 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12929 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12930
12931 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12932 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12933 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12934 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12935 .code
12936 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12937 1 No response to request
12938 2 Response not verified
12939 3 Verification failed
12940 4 Verification succeeded
12941 .endd
12942
12943 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12944 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12945 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12946 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12947 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12948
12949 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12950 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12951 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12952 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
12953 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12954 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12955 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12956 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12957 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12958 which is not the leaf.
12959
12960 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12961 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12962 the outbound.
12963
12964 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12965 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12966 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12967 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12968 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12969 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12970 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12971 which is not the leaf.
12972
12973 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12974 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12975 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12976 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12977 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12978 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12979 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12980 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12981 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12982 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12983 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12984
12985 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12986 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12987 the outbound.
12988
12989 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12990 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12991 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12992 During outbound
12993 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12994 the transport.
12995
12996 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12997 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12998 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12999 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13000
13001 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13002 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13003 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13004
13005 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13006 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13007 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13008
13009 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13010 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13011 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13012 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13013 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13014 values for those that are behind (west).
13015
13016 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13017 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13018 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13019 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13020
13021 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13022 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13023 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13024 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13025 flag.
13026
13027 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13028 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13029 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13030 -0500.
13031
13032 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13033 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13034 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13035 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13036
13037 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13038 .cindex "transport" "name"
13039 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13040 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13041 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13042
13043 .vitem &$value$&
13044 .vindex "&$value$&"
13045 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13046 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13047 &*reduce*& expansion.
13048
13049 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13050 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13051 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13052 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13053 Otherwise, empty.
13054
13055 .vitem &$version_number$&
13056 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13057 The version number of Exim.
13058
13059 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13060 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13061 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13062 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13063
13064 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13065 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13066 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13067 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13068 .endlist
13069 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13070
13071
13072
13073 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13074 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13075
13076 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13077 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13078 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13079 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13080 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13081 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13082 the line
13083 .code
13084 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13085 .endd
13086 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13087
13088
13089 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13090 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13091 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13092 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13093 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13094 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13095 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13096 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13097 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13098
13099 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13100 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13101 should usually be something like
13102 .code
13103 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13104 .endd
13105 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13106 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13107 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13108 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13109 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13110 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13111 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13112 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13113 two ways:
13114
13115 .ilist
13116 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13117 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13118 a startup when Exim is entered.
13119 .next
13120 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13121 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13122 .endlist
13123
13124 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13125 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13126
13127 .ilist
13128 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13129 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13130 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13131 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13132 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13133 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13134 defaults to false.
13135
13136
13137 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13138 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13139 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13140 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13141 forms:
13142 .code
13143 ${perl{foo}}
13144 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13145 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13146 .endd
13147 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13148 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13149 with an error message of the form
13150 .code
13151 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13152 .endd
13153 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13154 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13155 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13156 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13157 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13158 that was passed to &%die%&.
13159
13160
13161 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13162 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13163 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13164 the Perl code
13165 .code
13166 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13167 .endd
13168 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13169 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13170 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13171
13172 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13173 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13174 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13175 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13176
13177 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13178 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13179 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13180 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13181 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13182 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13183 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13184
13185
13186 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13187 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13188 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13189 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13190 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13191 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13192 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13193 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13194 avoided, but the output is lost.
13195
13196 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13197 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13198 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13199 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13200 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13201 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13202 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13203 .code
13204 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13205 .endd
13206 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13207 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13208 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13209 as the first subroutine argument.
13210 .ecindex IIDperl
13211
13212
13213 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13214 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13215
13216 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13217 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13218 "Starting the daemon"
13219 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13220 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13221 .cindex "network interface"
13222 .cindex "interface" "network"
13223 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13224 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13225 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13226 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13227 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13228 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13229 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13230 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13231 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13232 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13233 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13234
13235 .olist
13236 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13237 and ports to listen on.
13238 .next
13239 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13240 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13241 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13242 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13243 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13244 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13245 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13246 as an error situation.
13247 .next
13248 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13249 for the outgoing connection.
13250 .endlist
13251
13252
13253 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13254 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13255 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13256 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13257 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13258
13259 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13260 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13261 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13262 chapter describes how they operate.
13263
13264 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13265 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13266
13267
13268
13269 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13270 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13271 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13272 following options:
13273
13274 .ilist
13275 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13276 or service names.
13277 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13278 .next
13279 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13280 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13281 .endlist
13282
13283 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13284 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13285 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13286 colons. For example:
13287 .code
13288 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13289 192.168.23.65 ; \
13290 ::1 ; \
13291 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13292 .endd
13293 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13294 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13295
13296 .olist
13297 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13298 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13299 .code
13300 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13301 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13302 .endd
13303 .next
13304 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13305 with a colon separator, for example:
13306 .code
13307 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13308 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13309 .endd
13310 .endlist
13311
13312 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13313 default setting contains just one port:
13314 .code
13315 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13316 .endd
13317 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13318 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13319 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13320 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13321 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13322
13323
13324
13325 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13326 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13327 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13328 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13329 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13330 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13331 .code
13332 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13333 .endd
13334 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13335 .code
13336 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13337 .endd
13338 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13339
13340
13341
13342 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13343 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13344 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13345 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13346 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13347 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13348 exim.
13349
13350 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13351 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13352 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13353 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13354 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13355 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13356 .code
13357 -oX 1225
13358 .endd
13359 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13360 whereas
13361 .code
13362 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13363 .endd
13364 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13365 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13366 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13367
13368
13369
13370 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13371 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13372 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13373 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13374 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13375 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13376 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13377 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13378 list of port numbers or service names,
13379 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13380 common use of this option is expected to be
13381 .code
13382 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13383 .endd
13384 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13385 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13386 this way when a daemon is started.
13387
13388 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13389 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13390 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13391 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13392 connections via the daemon.)
13393
13394
13395
13396
13397 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13398 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13399 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13400 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13401 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13402 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13403 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13404 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13405 .code
13406 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13407 .endd
13408 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13409 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13410 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13411 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13412 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13413 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13414 .code
13415 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13416 .endd
13417 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13418 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13419 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13420 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13421 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13422
13423 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13424 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13425 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13426 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13427 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13428 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13429 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13430 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13431 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13432 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13433 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13434 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13435
13436 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13437 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13438 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13439 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13440 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13441
13442
13443
13444 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13445 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13446 .code
13447 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13448 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13449 .endd
13450 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13451 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13452 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13453 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13454
13455 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13456 .code
13457 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13458 .endd
13459 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13460 .code
13461 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13462 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13463 .endd
13464 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13465 IPv4 loopback address only:
13466 .code
13467 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13468 .endd
13469 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13470 .code
13471 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13472 .endd
13473 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13474
13475
13476
13477 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13478 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13479 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13480 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13481 treated as local.
13482
13483 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13484 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13485 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13486 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13487
13488 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13489 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13490 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13491 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13492 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13493 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13494 used for listening. Consider this example:
13495 .code
13496 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13497 192.168.53.235 ; \
13498 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13499
13500 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13501 .endd
13502 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13503 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13504 Exim is routing.
13505
13506 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13507 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13508 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13509 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13510 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13511 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13512 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13513 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13514
13515
13516
13517 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13518 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13519 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13520 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13521 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13522 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13523 details.
13524
13525
13526
13527
13528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13529 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13530
13531 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13532 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13533 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13534 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13535
13536 .ilist
13537 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13538 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13539 .next
13540 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13541 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13542 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13543 .next
13544 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13545 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13546 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13547 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13548 settings.
13549 .endlist
13550
13551 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13552 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13553 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13554 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13555 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13556 listed in more than one group.
13557
13558 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13559 .table2
13560 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13561 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13562 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13563 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13564 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13565 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13566 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13567 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13568 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13569 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13570 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13571 .endtable
13572
13573
13574 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13575 .table2
13576 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13577 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13578 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13579 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13580 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13581 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13582 .endtable
13583
13584
13585
13586 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13587 .table2
13588 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13589 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13590 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13591 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13592 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13593 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13594 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13595 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13596 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13597 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13598 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13599 .endtable
13600
13601
13602
13603 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13604 .table2
13605 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13606 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13607 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13608 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13609 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13610 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13611 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13612 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13613 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13614 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13615 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13616 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13617 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13618 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13619 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13620 .endtable
13621
13622
13623
13624 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13625 .table2
13626 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13627 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13628 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13629 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13630 .endtable
13631
13632
13633
13634 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13635 .table2
13636 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13637 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13638 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13639 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13640 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13641 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13642 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13643 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13644 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13645 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13646 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13647 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13648 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13649 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13650 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13651 .endtable
13652
13653
13654
13655 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13656 .table2
13657 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13658 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13659 .endtable
13660
13661
13662
13663 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13664 .table2
13665 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13666 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13667 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13668 .endtable
13669
13670
13671
13672 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13673 .table2
13674 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13675 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13676 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13677 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13678 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13679 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13680 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13681 .endtable
13682
13683
13684
13685 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13686 .table2
13687 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13688 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13689 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13690 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13691 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13692 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13693 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13694 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13695 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13696 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13697 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13698 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13699 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13700 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13701 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13702 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13703 connection"
13704 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13705 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13706 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13707 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13708 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13709 .endtable
13710
13711
13712
13713 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13714 .table2
13715 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13716 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13717 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13718 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13719 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13720 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13721 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13722 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13723 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13724 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13725 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13726 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13727 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13728 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13729 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13730 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13731 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13732 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13733 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13734 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13735 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13736 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13737 words""&"
13738 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13739 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13740 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13741 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13742 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13743 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13744 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13745 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13746 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13747 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13748 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13749 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13750 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13751 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13752 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13753 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13754 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13755 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13756 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13757 .endtable
13758
13759
13760
13761 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13762 .table2
13763 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13764 item"
13765 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13766 item"
13767 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13768 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13769 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13770 .endtable
13771
13772
13773
13774 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13775 .table2
13776 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13777 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13778 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13779 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13780 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13781 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13782 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13783 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13784 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13785 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13786 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13787 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13788 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13789 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13790 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13791 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13792 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13793 .endtable
13794
13795
13796
13797 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13798 .table2
13799 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13800 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13801 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13802 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13803 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13804 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13805 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13806 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13807 .endtable
13808
13809
13810
13811 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13812 .table2
13813 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13814 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13815 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13816 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13817 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13818 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13819 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13820 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13821 .endtable
13822
13823
13824
13825
13826 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13827 .table2
13828 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13829 .endtable
13830
13831
13832
13833
13834
13835 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13836 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13837
13838 .table2
13839 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13840 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13841 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13842 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13843 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13844 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13845 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13846 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13847 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13848 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13849 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13850 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13851 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13852 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13853 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13854 connection"
13855 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13856 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13857 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13858 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13859 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13860 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13861 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13862 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13863 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13864 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13865 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13866 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13867 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13868 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13869 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13870 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13871 .endtable
13872
13873
13874
13875 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13876 .table2
13877 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13878 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13879 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
13880 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13881 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13882 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13883 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13884 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13885 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13886 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13887 .endtable
13888
13889
13890
13891 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13892 .table2
13893 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13894 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13895 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13896 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13897 words""&"
13898 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13899 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13900 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13901 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13902 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13903 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13904 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13905 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13906 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13907 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13908 .endtable
13909
13910
13911
13912 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13913 .table2
13914 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13915 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13916 directory"
13917 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13918 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13919 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13920 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13921 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13922 .endtable
13923
13924
13925
13926 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13927 .table2
13928 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13929 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13930 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13931 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13932 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13933 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13934 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13935 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13936 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13937 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13938 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13939 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13940 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13941 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13942 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13943 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13944 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13945 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13946 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13947 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13948 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13949 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13950 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13951 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13952 .endtable
13953
13954
13955
13956 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13957 .table2
13958 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13959 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13960 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13961 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
13962 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13963 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13964 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13965 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13966 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13967 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13968 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13969 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13970 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13971 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13972 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13973 .endtable
13974
13975
13976
13977 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13978 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13979 &dagger;.
13980
13981 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13982 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13983 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13984 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13985 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13986 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13987 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13988 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13989 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13990
13991 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13992 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13993 It now defaults to true.
13994 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13995 .display
13996 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13997 .endd
13998
13999 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14000 .code
14001 log_selector = +8bitmime
14002 .endd
14003
14004 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14005 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14006 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14007 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14008 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14009 further details.
14010
14011 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14012 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14013 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14014 SMTP messages.
14015
14016 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14017 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14018 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14019 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14020 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14021
14022 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14023 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14024 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14025 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14026 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14027
14028 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14029 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14030 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14031 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14032
14033 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14034 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14035 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14036 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14037 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14038
14039 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14040 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14041 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14042 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14043 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14044 This option defines the ACL that,
14045 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14046 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14047 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14048 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14049
14050 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14051 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14052 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14053 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14054 of a received message.
14055 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
14056
14057 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14058 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14059 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14060 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14061
14062 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14063 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14064 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14065 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14066
14067 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14068 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14069 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14070 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14071 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14072
14073
14074 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14075 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14076 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14077 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14078
14079 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14080 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14081 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14082 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14083 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14084
14085 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14086 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14087 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14088 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14089 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14090
14091 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14092 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14093 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14094 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14095 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14096
14097 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14098 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14099 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14100 further details.
14101
14102 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14103 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14104 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14105 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14106
14107 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14108 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14109 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14110 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14111
14112 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14113 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14114 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14115 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14116
14117 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14118 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14119 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14120 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14121
14122 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14123 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14124 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14125 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14126 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14127
14128 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14129 .cindex "admin user"
14130 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14131 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14132 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14133 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14134 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14135 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14136 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14137
14138 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14139 .cindex "domain literal"
14140 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14141 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14142 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14143 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14144
14145 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14146 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14147 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14148 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14149 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14150 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14151 the local host's IP addresses.
14152
14153
14154 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14155 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14156 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14157 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14158 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14159 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14160 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14161 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14162 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14163
14164 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14165 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14166 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14167 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14168 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14169 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14170 experiment if they wish.
14171
14172 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14173 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14174 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14175 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14176 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14177 suitable setting is:
14178 .code
14179 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14180 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14181 .endd
14182 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14183 .code
14184 dns_check_names_pattern =
14185 .endd
14186 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14187
14188
14189 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14190 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14191 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14192 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14193 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14194 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14195 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14196 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14197 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14198 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14199 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14200
14201 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14202 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14203 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14204 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14205 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14206 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14207
14208 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14209 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14210 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14211 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14212 .code
14213 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14214 .endd
14215 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14216 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14217 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14218 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14219
14220
14221 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14222 .cindex "thawing messages"
14223 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14224 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14225 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14226 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14227 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14228 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14229
14230 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14231 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14232 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14233
14234
14235 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14236 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14237 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14238 .code
14239 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14240 .endd
14241 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14242 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14243
14244
14245 .option bi_command main string unset
14246 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14247 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14248 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14249 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14250 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14251
14252
14253 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14254 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14255 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14256 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14257 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14258 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14259
14260
14261 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14262 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14263 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14264 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14265
14266 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14267 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14268 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14269 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14270 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14271 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14272 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14273 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14274 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14275 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14276
14277 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14278 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14279 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14280 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14281 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14282 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14283 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14284 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14285 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14286 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14287
14288 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14289 during reception of a message.
14290 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14291
14292 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14293
14294
14295 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14296 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14297 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14298 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14299
14300
14301 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14302 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14303 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14304 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14305 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14306 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14307 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14308 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14309 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14310
14311 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14312 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14313 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14314 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14315 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14316 messages.
14317
14318 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14319 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14320 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14321 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14322 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14323 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14324 connection. A typical setting might be:
14325 .code
14326 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14327 .endd
14328 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14329 .code
14330 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14331 .endd
14332 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14333 address.
14334
14335 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14336 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14337 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14338 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14339 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14340 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14341
14342
14343 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14344 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14345 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14346 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14347
14348
14349 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14350 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14351 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14352 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14353
14354
14355 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14356 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14357 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14358 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14359
14360
14361 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14362 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14363 callout verification. The default value is
14364 .code
14365 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14366 .endd
14367 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14368
14369
14370 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14371 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14372
14373
14374 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14375 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14376
14377 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14378 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14379 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14380 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14381 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14382 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14383 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14384 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14385 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14386 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14387
14388
14389 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14390 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14391
14392
14393 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14394 .cindex "checking disk space"
14395 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14396 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14397 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14398 message is accepted.
14399
14400 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14401 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14402 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14403 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14404 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14405 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14406 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14407 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14408
14409
14410 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14411 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14412 .code
14413 check_spool_space = 100M
14414 check_spool_inodes = 100
14415 .endd
14416 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14417 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14418 transit.
14419
14420 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14421 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14422 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14423
14424 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14425 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14426 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14427 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14428 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14429 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14430
14431 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14432 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14433 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14434
14435 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14436 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14437 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14438
14439 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14440 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14441 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14442 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14443
14444 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14445 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14446 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14447 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14448 these hosts.
14449 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14450
14451 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14452 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14453 .cindex memory debugging
14454 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14455 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14456 it should normally be left as default.
14457
14458 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14459 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14460 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14461 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14462 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14463 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14464
14465 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14466 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14467 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14468 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14469 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14470 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14471 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14472
14473 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14474 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14475
14476 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14477 .cindex "warning of delay"
14478 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14479 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14480 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14481 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14482 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14483 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14484 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14485 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14486 with
14487 .code
14488 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14489 .endd
14490 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14491 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14492 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14493 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14494 .code
14495 delay_warning = 6h
14496 .endd
14497 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14498 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14499 .code
14500 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14501 .endd
14502 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14503 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14504 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14505
14506 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14507 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14508 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14509 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14510 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14511 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14512 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14513 not sent. The default is:
14514 .code
14515 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14516 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14517 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14518 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14519 } {no}{yes}}
14520 .endd
14521 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14522 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14523 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14524 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14525
14526 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14527 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14528 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14529 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14530 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14531 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14532 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14533 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14534
14535 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14536 .cindex "load average"
14537 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14538 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14539 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14540 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14541 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14542
14543
14544 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14545 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14546 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14547 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14548 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14549 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14550 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14551 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14552
14553 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14554 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14555 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14556 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14557 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14558 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14559 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14560 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14561
14562 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14563 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14564 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14565 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14566
14567
14568 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14569 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14570 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14571 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14572 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14573 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14574 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14575
14576
14577 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14578 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14579 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14580 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14581 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14582 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14583
14584
14585 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14586 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14587 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14588 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14589 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14590 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14591 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14592 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14593 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14594 by a setting such as this:
14595 .code
14596 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14597 .endd
14598 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14599 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14600 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14601 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14602 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14603 options are applied after this global option.
14604
14605 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14606 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14607 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14608 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14609 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14610 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14611 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14612 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14613 value of this option. The default pattern is
14614 .code
14615 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14616 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14617 .endd
14618 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14619 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14620 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14621 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14622 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14623 empty string.
14624
14625 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14626 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14627 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14628
14629 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14630 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14631 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14632 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14633
14634
14635 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14636 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14637 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14638 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14639 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14640 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14641
14642 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14643
14644
14645 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14646 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14647 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14648 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14649 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14650 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14651 domain matches this list.
14652
14653 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14654 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14655 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14656
14657
14658 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14659 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14660 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14661 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14662 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14663 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14664 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14665 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14666 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14667 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14668 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14669 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14670 to set in them.
14671 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14672
14673
14674 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14675 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14676
14677
14678 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14679 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14680 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14681 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14682 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14683 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14684 match with this expanded domain list.
14685
14686 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14687 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14688 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14689 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14690 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14691 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14692
14693 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14694 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14695 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14696
14697 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14698 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14699 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14700 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14701 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14702
14703 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14704 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14705 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14706 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14707 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14708 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14709 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14710 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14711 on.
14712
14713 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14714
14715 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14716 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14717 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14718
14719
14720 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14721 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14722 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14723 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14724
14725 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14726 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14727 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14728 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14729 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14730 and accepted from, these hosts.
14731 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14732 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14733 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14734 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14735 are sent.
14736
14737 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14738 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14739 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14740 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14741 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14742 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14743 .code
14744 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14745 .endd
14746 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14747 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14748
14749 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14750 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14751 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14752 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14753 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14754 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14755 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14756 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14757 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14758
14759
14760 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14761 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14762 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14763 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14764 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14765 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14766 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14767 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14768 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14769
14770 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14771 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14772 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14773 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14774 are examined. For example:
14775 .code
14776 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14777 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14778 postmaster@mydomain.example
14779 .endd
14780 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14781 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14782 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14783 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14784 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14785 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14786 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14787
14788
14789 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14790 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14791 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14792 .display
14793 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14794 .endd
14795 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14796 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14797 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14798 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14799 overrides the default.
14800
14801 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14802 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14803 and warning messages. For example:
14804 .code
14805 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14806 .endd
14807 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14808 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14809 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14810 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14811 not used.
14812
14813
14814 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14815 .cindex events
14816 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14817 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14818
14819
14820 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14821 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14822 .cindex "Exim group"
14823 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14824 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14825 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14826 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14827 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14828 security issues.
14829
14830
14831 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14832 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14833 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14834 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14835 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14836 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14837 other place.
14838 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14839 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14840 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14841 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14842
14843
14844 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14845 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14846 .cindex "Exim user"
14847 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14848 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14849 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14850 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14851
14852 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14853 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14854 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14855 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14856
14857
14858 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14859 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14860 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14861 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14862
14863
14864 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14865 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14866
14867 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14868 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14869 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14870 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14871 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14872 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14873 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14874 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14875 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14876 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14877 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14878 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14879 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14880 addresses.
14881
14882
14883 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14884 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14885 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14886 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14887 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14888 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14889 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14890 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14891 retries.
14892
14893 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14894 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14895 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14896 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14897
14898
14899
14900 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14901 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14902 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14903 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14904 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14905 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14906 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14907 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14908 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14909 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14910 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14911 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14912 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14913 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14914 logging that you require.
14915
14916
14917 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14918 .cindex "HP-UX"
14919 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14920 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14921 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14922 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14923 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14924 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14925 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14926 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14927
14928 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14929 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14930 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14931 user's name.
14932
14933 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14934 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14935 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14936 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14937 .code
14938 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14939 gecos_name = $1
14940 .endd
14941
14942 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14943 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14944
14945
14946 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14947 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14948 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14949 implementations of TLS.
14950
14951
14952 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14953 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14954 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14955
14956 See
14957 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14958 for documentation.
14959
14960
14961
14962 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14963 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14964 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14965 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14966 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14967 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14968
14969
14970
14971 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14972 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14973 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14974 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14975 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14976 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14977 sections are rejected.
14978
14979
14980 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14981 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14982 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14983 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14984 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14985 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14986 zero means &"no limit"&.
14987
14988
14989
14990
14991 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14992 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14993 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14994 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14995 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14996 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14997 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14998 if you want to do semantic checking.
14999 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15000 set.
15001
15002
15003 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15004 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15005 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15006 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15007 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15008 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15009 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15010 .code
15011 helo_allow_chars = _
15012 .endd
15013 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15014
15015
15016 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15017 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15018 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15019 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15020 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15021 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15022 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15023 do.
15024
15025
15026 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15027 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15028 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15029 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15030 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15031 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15032 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15033 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15034 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15035 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15036 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15037 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15038
15039 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15040 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15041 EHLO command either:
15042
15043 .ilist
15044 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15045 .next
15046 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15047 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15048 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15049 calling host address, or
15050 .next
15051 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15052 .endlist
15053
15054 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15055 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15056 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15057
15058 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15059 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15060 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15061
15062 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15063 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15064 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15065 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15066 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15067 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15068 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15069 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15070 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15071 error.
15072
15073 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15074 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15075 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15076 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15077 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15078 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15079 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15080 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15081 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15082
15083 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15084 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15085 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15086 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15087 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15088
15089 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15090 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15091 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15092 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15093
15094
15095 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15096 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15097 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15098 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15099 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15100 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15101 default configuration file contains
15102 .code
15103 host_lookup = *
15104 .endd
15105 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15106 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15107
15108 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15109 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15110 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15111
15112 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15113 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15114 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15115 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15116 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15117 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15118
15119
15120 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15121 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15122 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15123 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15124 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15125 if you want.
15126
15127 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15128 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15129 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15130 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15131
15132
15133
15134 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15135 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15136 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15137 as soon as the connection is made.
15138 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15139 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15140 connections immediately.
15141
15142 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15143 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15144 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15145 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15146 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15147
15148
15149 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15150 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15151 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15152 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15153 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15154 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15155 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15156 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15157 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15158 .code
15159 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15160 .endd
15161 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15162
15163
15164
15165 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15166 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15167 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15168 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15169
15170
15171 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15172 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15173 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15174 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15175 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15176 records
15177 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15178 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15179
15180 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15181 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15182 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15183 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15184 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15185 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15186 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15187
15188
15189 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15190 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15191 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15192 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15193 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15194
15195
15196
15197 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15198 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15199 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15200 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15201 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15202 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15203
15204 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15205 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15206 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15207 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15208 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15209 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15210 for frozen messages. For example,
15211 .code
15212 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15213 .endd
15214 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15215 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15216 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15217 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15218 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15219 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15220
15221
15222 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15223 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15224 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15225 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15226 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15227 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15228 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15229 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15230 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15231 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15232
15233
15234 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15235 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15236
15237 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15238 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15239 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15240 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15241 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15242 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15243 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15244 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15245 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15246
15247 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15248 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15249
15250 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15251 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15252 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15253 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15254
15255 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15256 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15257 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15258 anymore.
15259
15260 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15261 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15262 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15263 details.
15264
15265
15266 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15267 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15268 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15269 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15270 logged.
15271
15272
15273 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15274 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15275 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15276 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15277 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15278 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15279 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15280 and constrained to be a directory.
15281
15282
15283 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15284 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15285 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15286 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15287 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15288 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15289 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15290 and constrained to be a file.
15291
15292
15293 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15294 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15295 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15296 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15297 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15298 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15299
15300
15301 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15302 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15303 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15304 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15305 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15306 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15307 identity to be proven.
15308
15309
15310 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15311 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15312 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15313 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15314 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15315
15316
15317 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15318 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15319 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15320 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15321 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15322 with LDAP support.
15323
15324
15325 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15326 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15327 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15328 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15329 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15330 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15331 to hard/demand.
15332
15333
15334 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15335 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15336 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15337 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15338 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15339 of SSL-on-connect.
15340 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15341 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15342 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15343
15344
15345 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15346 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15347 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15348 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15349 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15350 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15351 has been built with LDAP support.
15352
15353
15354
15355 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15356 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15357 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15358 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15359 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15360 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15361 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15362
15363 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15364 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15365 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15366
15367 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15368 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15369 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15370 and the default qualify domain.
15371
15372 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15373 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15374 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15375 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15376
15377 .cindex "envelope sender"
15378 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15379 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15380 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15381
15382 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15383 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15384 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15385
15386
15387
15388
15389 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15390 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15391 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15392 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15393 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15394 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15395 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15396 example, if
15397 .code
15398 local_from_prefix = *-
15399 .endd
15400 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15401 .code
15402 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15403 .endd
15404 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15405 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15406 qualify domain.
15407
15408
15409 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15410 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15411
15412
15413 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15414 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15415 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15416 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15417 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15418 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15419 &%local_interfaces%& is
15420 .code
15421 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15422 .endd
15423 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15424 .code
15425 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15426 .endd
15427
15428 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15429 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15430 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15431 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15432 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15433 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15434 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15435 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15436
15437
15438
15439 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15440 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15441 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15442 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15443 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15444 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15445 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15446 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15447
15448
15449
15450
15451 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15452 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15453 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15454 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15455 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15456 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15457 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15458 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15459 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15460 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15461 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15462 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15463 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15464 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15465 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15466
15467
15468
15469 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15470 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15471 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15472 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15473 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15474 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15475 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15476 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15477 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15478 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15479 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15480 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15481 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15482 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15483 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15484
15485
15486 .option log_selector main string unset
15487 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15488 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15489 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15490 minus characters. For example:
15491 .code
15492 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15493 .endd
15494 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15495 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15496
15497
15498 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15499 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15500 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15501 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15502 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15503 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15504 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15505 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15506 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15507 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15508 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15509 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15510 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15511
15512
15513 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15514 .cindex "too many open files"
15515 .cindex "open files, too many"
15516 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15517 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15518 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15519 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15520 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15521 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15522 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15523 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15524 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15525 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15526 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15527 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15528
15529
15530 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15531 .cindex "length of login name"
15532 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15533 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15534 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15535 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15536 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15537 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15538
15539
15540 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15541 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15542 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15543 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15544 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15545 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15546 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15547 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15548
15549
15550 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15551 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15552 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15553 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15554 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15555 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15556 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15557
15558
15559 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15560 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15561 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15562 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15563 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15564 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15565 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15566 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15567 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15568 empty string, the option is ignored.
15569
15570
15571 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15572 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15573 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15574 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15575 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15576 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15577 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15578 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15579 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15580 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15581 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15582 colons will become hyphens.
15583
15584
15585 .option message_logs main boolean true
15586 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15587 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15588 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15589 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15590 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15591 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15592 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15593 which is not affected by this option.
15594
15595
15596 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15597 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15598 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15599 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15600 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15601 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15602 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15603 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15604 optionally followed by K or M.
15605
15606 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15607 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15608 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15609 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15610 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15611
15612 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15613 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15614 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15615 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15616 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15617 message that an individual transport can process.
15618
15619 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15620 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15621 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15622 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15623 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15624 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15625 some problems may result.
15626
15627 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15628 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15629 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15630
15631
15632 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15633 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15634 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15635 .code
15636 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15637 .endd
15638 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15639 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15640 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15641 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15642 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15643
15644
15645 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15646 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15647 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15648 contains a full description of this facility.
15649
15650
15651
15652 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15653 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15654 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15655 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15656 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15657
15658
15659 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15660 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15661 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15662 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15663 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15664 safety precaution.
15665
15666 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15667 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15668 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15669 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15670 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15671
15672 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15673 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15674 example is
15675 .code
15676 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15677 .endd
15678 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15679 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15680 transport driver.
15681
15682
15683 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15684 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15685 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15686 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15687 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15688
15689 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15690 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15691 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15692 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15693 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15694 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15695 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15696
15697 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15698 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15699 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15700 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15701 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15702
15703 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15704
15705 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15706 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15707 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15708 some now infamous attacks.
15709
15710 Examples:
15711 .code
15712 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15713 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15714 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15715
15716 # Disable older protocol versions:
15717 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15718 .endd
15719
15720 Possible options may include:
15721 .ilist
15722 &`all`&
15723 .next
15724 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15725 .next
15726 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15727 .next
15728 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15729 .next
15730 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15731 .next
15732 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15733 .next
15734 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15735 .next
15736 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15737 .next
15738 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15739 .next
15740 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15741 .next
15742 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15743 .next
15744 &`no_compression`&
15745 .next
15746 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15747 .next
15748 &`no_sslv2`&
15749 .next
15750 &`no_sslv3`&
15751 .next
15752 &`no_ticket`&
15753 .next
15754 &`no_tlsv1`&
15755 .next
15756 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15757 .next
15758 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15759 .next
15760 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15761 .next
15762 &`single_dh_use`&
15763 .next
15764 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15765 .next
15766 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15767 .next
15768 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15769 .next
15770 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15771 .next
15772 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15773 .next
15774 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15775 .endlist
15776
15777 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15778 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15779 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15780 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15781 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15782 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15783
15784
15785 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15786 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15787 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15788 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15789 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15790
15791
15792 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15793 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15794 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15795 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15796 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15797 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15798 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15799 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15800 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15801 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15802 an ACL.
15803
15804 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15805 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15806 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15807 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15808 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15809 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15810 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15811
15812
15813 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15814 .cindex "Perl"
15815 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15816 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15817
15818
15819 .option perl_startup main string unset
15820 .cindex "Perl"
15821 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15822 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15823
15824 .option perl_startup main boolean false
15825 .cindex "Perl"
15826 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
15827
15828
15829 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15830 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15831 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15832 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15833 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15834 PostgreSQL support.
15835
15836
15837 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15838 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15839 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15840 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15841 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15842 to the host name:
15843 .code
15844 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15845 .endd
15846 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15847 spool directory.
15848 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15849 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15850 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15851
15852
15853 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15854 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15855 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15856 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15857 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15858 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15859 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15860 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15861 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15862
15863
15864 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15865 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15866 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15867 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15868 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15869 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15870 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15871 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15872
15873 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15874 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15875 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15876 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15877 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15878 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15879 volume of mail. Use with care!
15880
15881
15882 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15883 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15884 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15885 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15886 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15887 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15888 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15889 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15890 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15891 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15892
15893 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15894 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15895 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15896 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15897 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15898 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15899
15900
15901 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15902 .cindex "printing characters"
15903 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15904 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15905 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15906 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15907 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15908 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15909 characters.
15910
15911 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15912 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15913 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15914 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15915 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15916 standards.
15917
15918
15919 .option process_log_path main string unset
15920 .cindex "process log path"
15921 .cindex "log" "process log"
15922 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15923 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15924 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15925 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15926 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15927 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15928 different spool directories.
15929
15930
15931 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15932 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15933 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15934 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15935 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15936 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15937 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15938
15939
15940 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15941 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15942 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15943 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15944 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15945 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15946 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15947 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15948 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15949
15950 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15951 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15952 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15953 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15954 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15955 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15956 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15957
15958
15959 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15960 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15961 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15962
15963
15964
15965 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15966 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15967 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15968 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15969 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15970 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15971 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15972 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15973
15974
15975 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15976 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15977 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15978 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15979 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15980
15981
15982 .option queue_only main boolean false
15983 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15984 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15985 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15986 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15987 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15988 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15989
15990 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15991 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15992 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15993 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15994
15995
15996 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15997 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15998 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15999 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16000 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16001 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16002 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16003 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16004 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16005 .code
16006 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16007 .endd
16008 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16009 &_/some/file_& exists.
16010
16011
16012 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16013 .cindex "load average"
16014 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16015 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16016 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16017 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16018 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16019 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16020 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16021 false.
16022
16023 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16024 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16025 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16026 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16027
16028
16029 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16030 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16031 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16032 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16033 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16034 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16035 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16036 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16037 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16038 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16039 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16040 re-evaluated for each message.
16041
16042
16043 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16044 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16045 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16046 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16047 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16048 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16049
16050
16051 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16052 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16053 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16054 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16055 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16056 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16057 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16058 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16059 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16060 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16061 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16062 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16063 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16064
16065
16066
16067 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16068 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16069 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16070 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16071 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16072 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16073 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16074 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16075 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16076
16077 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16078 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16079 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16080 the daemon's command line.
16081
16082 .cindex queues named
16083 .cindex "named queues"
16084 To set limits for different named queues use
16085 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16086
16087 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16088 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16089 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16090 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16091 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16092 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16093 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16094 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16095 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16096 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16097 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16098 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16099 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16100 &%queue_domains%&.
16101
16102
16103 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16104 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16105 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16106 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16107 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16108 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16109 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16110
16111 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16112 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16113 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16114 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16115 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16116 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16117 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16118 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16119 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16120 header lines. The default setting is:
16121
16122 .code
16123 received_header_text = Received: \
16124 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16125 {${if def:sender_ident \
16126 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16127 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16128 by $primary_hostname \
16129 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16130 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16131 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16132 ${if def:sender_address \
16133 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16134 id $message_exim_id\
16135 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16136 .endd
16137
16138 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16139 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16140 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16141 header lines such as the following:
16142 .code
16143 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16144 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16145 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16146 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16147 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16148 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16149 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16150 .endd
16151 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16152 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16153 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16154 message was accepted.
16155
16156
16157 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16158 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16159 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16160 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16161 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16162 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16163 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16164 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16165
16166
16167 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16168 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16169 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16170 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16171 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16172 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16173 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16174 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16175 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16176 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16177 option was not set.
16178
16179
16180 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16181 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16182 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16183 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16184 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16185 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16186 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16187 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16188 done.
16189
16190 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16191 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16192 RCPT commands in a single message.
16193
16194
16195 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16196 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16197 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16198 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16199 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16200 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16201 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16202
16203
16204 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16205 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16206 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16207 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16208 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16209 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16210 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16211 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16212 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16213 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16214 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16215 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16216 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16217 tagged with its process id.
16218
16219 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16220 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16221 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16222 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16223 is received.
16224
16225 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16226 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16227 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16228 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16229 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16230 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16231 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16232 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16233 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16234 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16235 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16236
16237 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16238 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16239 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16240 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16241
16242
16243 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16244 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16245 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16246 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16247 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16248 .code
16249 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16250 .endd
16251 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16252 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16253
16254
16255 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16256 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16257 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16258 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16259 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16260 past failures.
16261
16262
16263 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16264 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16265 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16266 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16267 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16268 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16269 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16270 the default value.
16271
16272
16273 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16274 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16275 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16276 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16277 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16278 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16279 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16280 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16281 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16282 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16283
16284
16285 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16286 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16287
16288
16289 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16290 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16291 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16292 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16293 an item in the list.
16294 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16295 for the system.
16296
16297 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16298 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16299 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16300 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16301 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16302
16303
16304 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16305 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16306 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16307 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16308 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16309 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16310 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16311 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16312 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16313 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16314
16315 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16316 .cindex "environment"
16317 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16318 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16319 default list is empty,
16320
16321
16322 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16323 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16324 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16325 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16326 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16327 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16328 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16329
16330
16331
16332 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16333 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16334 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16335 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16336 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16337 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16338 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16339 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16340 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16341 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16342 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16343
16344
16345
16346 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16347 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16348 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16349 .cindex "inetd"
16350 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16351 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16352 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16353 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16354 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16355 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16356
16357 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16358 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16359 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16360 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16361
16362
16363 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16364 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16365 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16366 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16367 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16368 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16369 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16370 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16371
16372 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16373 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16374 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16375 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16376 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16377 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16378 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16379 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16380
16381
16382 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16383 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16384 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16385 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16386 live with.
16387
16388
16389 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16390 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16391 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16392 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16393 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16394 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16395 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16396 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16397 . the option name to split.
16398
16399 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16400 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16401 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16402 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16403 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16404 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16405 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16406 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16407 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16408 seen).
16409
16410
16411 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16412 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16413 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16414 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16415 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16416 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16417 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16418 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16419 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16420 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16421 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16422
16423 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16424 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16425 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16426 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16427 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16428 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16429
16430
16431
16432 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16433 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16434 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16435 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16436 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16437 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16438 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16439 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16440 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16441 to all messages received in the same connection.
16442
16443 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16444 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16445 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16446 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16447
16448
16449 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16450
16451 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16452 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16453 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16454 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16455 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16456 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16457 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16458 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16459 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16460 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16461 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16462 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16463 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16464
16465
16466 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16467 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16468 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16469 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16470 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16471 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16472 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16473 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16474 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16475 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16476 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16477 individual host.
16478
16479 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16480 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16481 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16482 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16483
16484
16485 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16486 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16487 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16488 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16489 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16490 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16491 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16492 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16493 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16494
16495 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16496 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16497 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16498 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16499
16500 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16501 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16502 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16503 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16504 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16505 For example:
16506 .code
16507 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16508 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16509 .endd
16510
16511 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16512 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16513 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16514 &%helo_data%& value.
16515
16516 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16517 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16518 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16519 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16520 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16521 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16522 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16523 .code
16524 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16525 $version_number $tod_full
16526 .endd
16527 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16528 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16529 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16530 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16531 multiline response).
16532
16533
16534 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16535 .cindex "checking disk space"
16536 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16537 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16538 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16539 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16540 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16541 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16542 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16543
16544
16545 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16546 .cindex "connection backlog"
16547 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16548 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16549 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16550 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16551 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16552 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16553 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16554 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16555 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16556 attacks by SYN flooding.
16557
16558
16559 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16560 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16561 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16562 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16563 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16564 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16565 fewer, but they still exist.
16566
16567 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16568 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16569 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16570 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16571 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16572 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16573 does detect many instances.
16574
16575 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16576 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16577 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16578 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16579
16580
16581
16582 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16583 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16584 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16585 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16586 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16587 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16588 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16589 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16590 example:
16591 .code
16592 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16593 $sender_host_address
16594 .endd
16595 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16596 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16597 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16598 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16599 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16600 the command.
16601
16602
16603 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16604 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16605 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16606 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16607 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16608
16609
16610 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16611 .cindex "load average"
16612 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16613 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16614 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16615 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16616 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16617 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16618
16619
16620
16621 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16622 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16623 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16624 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16625 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16626 .code
16627 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16628 .endd
16629 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16630 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16631 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16632 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16633 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16634
16635 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16636 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16637 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16638 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16639 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16640 not count towards the limit.
16641
16642
16643
16644 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16645 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16646 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16647 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16648 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16649 that subvert web
16650 clients
16651 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16652 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16653
16654
16655
16656 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16657 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16658 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16659 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16660 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16661 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16662 recipients.
16663
16664 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16665 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16666 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16667 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16668
16669 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16670 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16671 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16672 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16673 values:
16674
16675 .ilist
16676 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16677 .next
16678 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16679 fractional parts are allowed here.
16680 .next
16681 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16682 .next
16683 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16684 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16685 .endlist
16686
16687 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16688 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16689 .code
16690 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16691 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16692 .endd
16693 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16694 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16695 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16696 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16697
16698
16699 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16700 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16701
16702
16703 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16704 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16705
16706
16707 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16708 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16709 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16710 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16711 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16712 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16713 the message is abandoned.
16714 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16715 .code
16716 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16717 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16718 .endd
16719 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16720 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16721
16722 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16723 expanded before use and may depend on
16724 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16725
16726
16727 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16728 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16729 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16730 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16731 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16732 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16733
16734
16735 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16736 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16737 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16738
16739
16740 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16741 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16742 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16743 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16744 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16745 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16746 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16747 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16748 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16749 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16750 .code
16751 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16752 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16753 .endd
16754
16755
16756 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16757 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16758 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16759 the availability thereof is advertised in
16760 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16761 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16762
16763
16764 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16765 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16766 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16767 The default value is
16768 .code
16769 127.0.0.1 783
16770 .endd
16771 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16772
16773
16774
16775 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16776 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16777 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16778 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16779 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16780 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16781 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16782 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16783 arrival of the message.
16784
16785 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16786 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16787 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16788 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16789 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16790
16791 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16792 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16793 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16794 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16795 automatically deleted.
16796
16797 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16798 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16799 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16800 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16801 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16802 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16803 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16804 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16805 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16806
16807
16808 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16809 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16810 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16811 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16812 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16813 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16814 &$primary_hostname$&.
16815
16816 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16817 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16818 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16819 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16820 as failures in the configuration file.
16821
16822 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16823 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16824
16825 .new
16826 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
16827 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
16828 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternate format
16829 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
16830 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
16831 Currently it is only done for messages received using the EMSTP CHUNKING
16832 option.
16833
16834 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
16835 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
16836 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
16837 will need to be aware of the potential different format.
16838
16839 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
16840 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is contructed for them).
16841 The transimssion benefit is maintained.
16842 .wen
16843
16844 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16845 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16846 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16847 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16848
16849 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16850 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16851 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16852 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16853 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16854 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16855
16856 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16857 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16858 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16859 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16860 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16861 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16862 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16863
16864
16865 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16866 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16867 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16868 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16869 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16870 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16871 domain causes a syntax error.
16872 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16873 syntax checking.
16874
16875
16876 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16877 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16878 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16879 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16880 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16881 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16882 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16883 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16884 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16885 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16886 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16887 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16888
16889
16890 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16891 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16892 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16893 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16894 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16895 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16896 details of Exim's logging.
16897
16898
16899 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
16900 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
16901 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
16902 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
16903 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
16904 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
16905 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16906
16907
16908
16909 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16910 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16911 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16912 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16913 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16914
16915
16916
16917 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16918 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16919 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16920 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16921 details of Exim's logging.
16922
16923
16924 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16925 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16926 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16927 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16928 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16929 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16930 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16931 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16932 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16933 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16934 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16935 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
16936
16937
16938 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16939 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16940 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16941 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16942 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16943 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16944
16945
16946 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16947 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16948 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16949 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16950 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16951
16952 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16953 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16954 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16955 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16956 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16957
16958 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16959 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16960 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16961 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16962 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16963 contains the pipe command.
16964
16965
16966 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16967 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16968 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16969 is used in a system filter.
16970
16971
16972 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16973 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16974 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16975 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16976 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16977 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16978 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16979 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16980 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16981 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16982
16983 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16984 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16985 transport option overrides.
16986
16987
16988 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16989 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16990 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16991 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16992 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16993 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16994 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16995 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16996 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16997 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16998 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16999 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17000 TCP_NODELAY.
17001
17002
17003 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17004 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17005 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17006 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17007 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17008 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17009 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17010 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17011 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17012 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17013
17014 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17015 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17016 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17017
17018
17019 .option timezone main string unset
17020 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17021 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17022 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17023 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17024 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17025 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17026 .code
17027 timezone = UTC
17028 .endd
17029 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17030 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17031 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17032 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17033 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17034 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17035
17036
17037 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17038 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17039 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17040 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17041 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17042 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17043 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17044 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17045 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17046 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17047 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17048
17049
17050 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
17051 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17052 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17053 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
17054 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
17055 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17056 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17057
17058 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17059 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17060 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17061 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17062
17063 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17064 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17065 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17066 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17067
17068 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17069 generated for every connection.
17070
17071 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17072 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17073 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17074 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17075 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
17076
17077 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17078
17079
17080 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17081 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17082 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17083 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17084 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17085 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17086
17087 The value must be at least 1024.
17088
17089 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17090 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17091 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17092
17093 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17094 number.
17095
17096 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17097 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17098 larger prime than requested.
17099
17100
17101 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17102 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17103 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17104 to be used by Exim.
17105
17106 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17107 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17108 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17109 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17110
17111 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17112 then it names a file from which DH
17113 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17114 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17115 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17116 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17117 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17118 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17119
17120 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17121 loaded by Exim.
17122
17123 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17124 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17125 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17126 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17127
17128 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17129 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17130
17131 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17132 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17133 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17134
17135 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17136 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17137 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17138 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17139 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17140
17141 The available standard primes are:
17142 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17143 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17144 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17145 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17146
17147 The available additional primes are:
17148 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17149
17150 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17151 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17152 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17153 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17154 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17155
17156 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17157 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17158 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17159
17160 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17161 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17162 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17163 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17164 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17165 userbase.
17166
17167 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17168 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17169 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17170 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17171 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17172 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17173 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17174
17175
17176 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17177 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17178 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17179 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17180
17181 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17182 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17183 for valid selections.
17184
17185 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17186 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17187 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17188
17189 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17190
17191
17192 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17193 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17194 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17195 This option
17196 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17197 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17198 Certificate Authority.
17199
17200 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17201
17202
17203 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17204 .cindex SSMTP
17205 .cindex SMTPS
17206 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17207 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17208 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17209 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17210
17211
17212
17213 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
17214 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17215 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
17216 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
17217 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17218 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17219 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17220
17221 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17222
17223
17224 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17225 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17226 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17227 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17228 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17229 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17230 TLS session.
17231
17232
17233 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17234 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17235 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17236 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17237 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17238 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17239 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17240 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17241 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17242 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17243 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17244
17245
17246 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17247 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17248 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17249 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17250
17251
17252 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17253 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17254 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17255 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17256 word "system"
17257 or the absolute path to
17258 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17259 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17260
17261 The "system" value for the option will use a
17262 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17263 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17264 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17265 must be specified.
17266
17267 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17268 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17269
17270 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17271 explicitly
17272 either by file or directory
17273 are added to those given by the system default location.
17274
17275 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17276 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17277 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17278 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17279 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17280 use the explicit directory version.
17281
17282 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17283
17284 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17285 being unset.
17286
17287
17288 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17289 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17290 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17291 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17292 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17293 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17294 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17295 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17296
17297 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17298 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17299 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17300 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17301 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17302 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17303 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17304
17305 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17306 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17307 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17308 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17309 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17310 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17311 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17312 certificate"&.
17313
17314 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17315 certificates.
17316
17317
17318 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17319 .cindex "trusted groups"
17320 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17321 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17322 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17323 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17324 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17325 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17326 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17327 are trusted.
17328
17329 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17330 .cindex "trusted users"
17331 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17332 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17333 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17334 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17335 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17336 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17337 Exim user are trusted.
17338
17339 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17340 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17341 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17342 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17343 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17344 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17345 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17346 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17347 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17348 &%-F%& option.
17349
17350 .option unknown_username main string unset
17351 See &%unknown_login%&.
17352
17353 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17354 .cindex "trusted users"
17355 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17356 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17357 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17358 .cindex "envelope sender"
17359 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17360 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17361 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17362 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17363 is used) is ignored.
17364
17365 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17366 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17367 .code
17368 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17369 .endd
17370 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17371 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17372 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17373 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17374 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17375 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17376 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17377 followed by a hyphen
17378 by a setting like this:
17379 .code
17380 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17381 .endd
17382 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17383 restriction, you can use
17384 .code
17385 untrusted_set_sender = *
17386 .endd
17387 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17388 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17389 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17390 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17391 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17392 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17393 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17394 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17395
17396 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17397 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17398 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17399 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17400 sender address.
17401
17402
17403 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17404 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17405 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17406 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17407 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17408 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17409 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17410 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17411 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17412 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17413 .code
17414 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17415 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17416 .endd
17417 The pattern can be seen by running
17418 .code
17419 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17420 .endd
17421 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17422 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17423 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17424 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17425 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17426 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17427
17428
17429 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17430 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17431
17432
17433 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17434 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17435 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17436 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17437 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17438 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17439 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17440 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17441
17442
17443 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17444 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17445 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17446 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17447 .ecindex IIDconfima
17448 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17449
17450
17451
17452
17453 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17454 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17455
17456 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17457 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17458 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17459 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17460 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17461
17462 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17463 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17464 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17465 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17466 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17467
17468
17469
17470 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17471 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17472 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17473 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17474 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17475 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17476 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17477
17478 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17479 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17480 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17481 routers, and the eventual transport.
17482
17483 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17484 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17485 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17486 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17487 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17488
17489 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17490 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17491 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17492 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17493 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17494
17495 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17496 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17497 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17498 .code
17499 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17500 .endd
17501 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17502 .code
17503 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17504 .endd
17505 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17506 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17507
17508 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17509 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17510 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17511 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17512 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17513 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17514 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17515
17516
17517
17518 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17519 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17520 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17521 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17522 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17523 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17524 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17525 routing.
17526
17527
17528
17529 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17530 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17531 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17532 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17533 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17534 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17535 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17536 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17537 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17538 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17539 you could put:
17540 .code
17541 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17542 .endd
17543 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17544 and
17545 .code
17546 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17547 .endd
17548 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17549 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17550 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17551 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17552
17553
17554 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17555 .cindex "case of local parts"
17556 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17557 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17558 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17559 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17560 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17561 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17562 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17563 more details.
17564
17565 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17566 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17567 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17568 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17569 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17570 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17571 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17572 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17573 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17574
17575 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17576 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17577 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17578 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17579
17580
17581
17582 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17583 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17584 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17585 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17586 .vindex "&$home$&"
17587 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17588 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17589 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17590 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17591 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17592 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17593 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17594 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17595 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17596 the router is skipped.
17597
17598 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17599 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17600 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17601 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17602 setting to achieve this. For example:
17603 .code
17604 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17605 .endd
17606 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17607 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17608 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17609
17610
17611
17612 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17613 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17614 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17615 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17616 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17617 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17618 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17619 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17620
17621 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17622 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17623
17624 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17625 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17626
17627 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17628 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17629 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17630 .code
17631 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17632 .endd
17633 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17634 .code
17635 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17636 .endd
17637
17638 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17639 .code
17640 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17641 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17642 condition = foobar
17643 .endd
17644
17645 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17646 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17647 be specified using &%condition%&.
17648
17649 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17650 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17651 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17652 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17653 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17654 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17655 Router rules processing behavior.
17656
17657 This is best illustrated in an example:
17658 .code
17659 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17660 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17661
17662 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17663 true {yes} {no}}
17664
17665 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17666 {yes} {no}}
17667 .endd
17668 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17669 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17670 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17671 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17672 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17673 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17674 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17675 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17676
17677 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17678 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17679 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17680 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17681 string characters.
17682
17683 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17684 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17685 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17686 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17687 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17688
17689
17690 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17691 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17692 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17693 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17694 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17695 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17696 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17697 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17698 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17699 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17700 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17701 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17702 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17703 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17704
17705
17706
17707 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17708 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17709 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17710 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17711 transport option of the same name.
17712
17713 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17714 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17715 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17716 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17717 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17718 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17719 the dnssec request bit set.
17720 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17721
17722 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17723 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17724 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17725 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17726 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17727 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17728 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17729 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17730 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17731
17732
17733 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17734 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17735 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17736 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17737 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17738 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17739 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17740 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17741
17742
17743
17744 .option driver routers string unset
17745 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17746 to be used.
17747
17748
17749 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17750 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17751 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17752 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17753 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17754 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17755 Not effective on redirect routers.
17756
17757
17758
17759 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17760 .cindex "envelope sender"
17761 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17762 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17763 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17764 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17765 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17766 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17767 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17768
17769 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17770 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17771 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17772 setting.
17773
17774 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17775 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17776 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17777 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17778
17779 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17780 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17781 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17782 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17783 settings:
17784 .code
17785 errors_to =
17786 errors_to = ""
17787 .endd
17788 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17789 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17790 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17791 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17792 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17793
17794 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17795 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17796 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17797 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17798 setting &%return_path%&.
17799
17800 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17801 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17802 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17803
17804
17805
17806 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17807 .cindex "address" "testing"
17808 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17809 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17810 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17811 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17812 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17813 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17814 on for the system alias file.
17815 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17816 are evaluated.
17817
17818 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17819 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17820 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17821
17822
17823
17824 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17825 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17826 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17827 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17828
17829
17830
17831 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17832 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17833 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17834
17835
17836
17837 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17838 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17839 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17840
17841
17842
17843 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17844 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17845 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17846 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17847 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17848 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17849 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17850 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17851 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17852
17853 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17854 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17855 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17856 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17857 transport for further details.
17858
17859
17860 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17861 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17862 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17863 .cindex "transport" "local"
17864 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17865 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17866 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17867 process.
17868 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17869 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17870 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17871 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17872 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17873
17874
17875
17876 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17877 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17878 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17879 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17880 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17881 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17882 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17883 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17884 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17885 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17886 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17887 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17888 &"see"& the added header lines.
17889
17890 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17891 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17892 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17893 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17894
17895 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17896 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17897
17898 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17899 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17900
17901 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17902 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17903 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17904 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17905 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17906 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17907 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17908 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17909 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17910 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17911
17912
17913
17914 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17915 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17916 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17917 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17918 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17919 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17920 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17921 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17922 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17923 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17924 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17925 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17926 &"see"& the original header lines.
17927
17928 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17929 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17930 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17931 errors.
17932
17933 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17934 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17935
17936 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17937 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17938
17939 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17940 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17941 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17942 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17943
17944 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17945 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17946 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17947
17948
17949
17950 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17951 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17952 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17953 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17954 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17955 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17956 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17957 like
17958 .code
17959 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17960 .endd
17961 by setting
17962 .code
17963 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17964 .endd
17965 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17966 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17967 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17968 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17969 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17970 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17971
17972 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17973 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17974 .code
17975 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17976 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17977 .endd
17978 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17979 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17980
17981 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17982 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17983 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17984 domain that is being routed.
17985
17986 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17987 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17988 checked.
17989
17990 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17991 .cindex "additional groups"
17992 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17993 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17994 .cindex "transport" "local"
17995 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17996 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17997 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17998 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17999 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18000
18001
18002
18003 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18004 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18005 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18006 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18007 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18008 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18009 evaluated.
18010
18011 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18012 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18013 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18014 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18015 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18016 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18017 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18018 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18019 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18020
18021 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18022 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18023 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18024 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18025 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18026 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18027 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18028 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18029 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18030 the relevant transport.
18031
18032 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18033 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18034 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18035 callout.
18036
18037 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18038 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18039 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18040 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18041 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18042 .code
18043 real_localuser:
18044 driver = accept
18045 local_part_prefix = real-
18046 check_local_user
18047 transport = local_delivery
18048 .endd
18049 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18050 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18051 .code
18052 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18053 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18054 .endd
18055
18056 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18057 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18058 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18059 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18060
18061
18062 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18063 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18064
18065
18066
18067 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18068 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18069 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18070 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18071 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18072 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18073 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18074 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18075 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18076 &%username-foo%&.
18077
18078
18079 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18080 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18081
18082
18083
18084 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18085 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18086 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18087 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18088 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18089 are evaluated, and
18090 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18091 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18092 example:
18093 .code
18094 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18095 .endd
18096 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18097 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18098 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18099 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18100 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18101 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18102 each virtual domain:
18103 .code
18104 postmaster:
18105 driver = redirect
18106 local_parts = postmaster
18107 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18108 .endd
18109
18110
18111 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18112 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18113 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18114 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18115 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18116 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18117 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18118 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18119 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18120 redirect addresses.
18121
18122
18123
18124 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18125 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18126 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18127 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18128 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18129 delivery to be deferred.
18130
18131 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18132 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18133 .oindex "&%self%&"
18134 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18135 means of the setting
18136 .code
18137 self = pass
18138 .endd
18139 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18140 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18141 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18142
18143 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18144 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18145 controls what happens next.
18146
18147
18148 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18149 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18150 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18151 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18152 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18153 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18154 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18155 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18156
18157 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18158 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18159 applies to all of them.
18160
18161
18162
18163 .option pass_router routers string unset
18164 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18165 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18166 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18167 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18168 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18169 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18170 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18171 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18172 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18173 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18174
18175
18176
18177 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18178 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18179 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18180 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18181 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18182 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18183
18184 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18185 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18186 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18187 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18188
18189
18190
18191 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18192 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18193 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18194 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18195 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18196 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18197 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18198
18199 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18200 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18201 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18202 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18203
18204 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18205 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18206 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18207 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18208 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18209
18210 .cindex "NFS"
18211 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18212 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18213 unavailable.
18214
18215 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18216 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18217 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18218 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18219 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18220 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18221 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18222 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18223
18224 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18225 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18226 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18227 operates as follows:
18228
18229 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18230 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18231 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18232 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18233 used. For example:
18234 .code
18235 require_files = mail:/some/file
18236 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18237 .endd
18238 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18239 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18240
18241 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18242 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18243 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18244 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18245
18246 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18247 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18248 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18249 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18250 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18251
18252 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18253 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18254 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18255 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18256 check again in that process.
18257
18258 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18259 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18260 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18261 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18262 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18263 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18264 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18265 .code
18266 require_files = +/some/file
18267 .endd
18268 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18269 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18270 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18271
18272
18273
18274 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18275 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18276 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18277 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18278 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18279 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18280 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18281 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18282 latter kind.
18283
18284 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18285 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18286 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18287 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18288 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18289 same name.
18290
18291 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18292 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18293 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18294
18295
18296
18297 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18298 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18299 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18300 .vindex "&$home$&"
18301 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18302 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18303 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18304 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18305 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18306 cause the router to defer.
18307
18308 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18309 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18310 place.
18311 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18312 are evaluated.)
18313 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18314 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18315
18316 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18317 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18318 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18319 of these values that is set:
18320
18321 .ilist
18322 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18323 .next
18324 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18325 .next
18326 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18327 .next
18328 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18329 .endlist
18330
18331 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18332 router, but not for the transport.
18333
18334
18335
18336 .option self routers string freeze
18337 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18338 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18339 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18340 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18341 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18342 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18343 of remote hosts.
18344 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18345 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18346 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18347 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18348 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18349
18350 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18351 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18352 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18353 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18354 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18355 cases:
18356
18357 .vlist
18358 .vitem &%defer%&
18359 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18360
18361 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18362 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18363 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18364 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18365
18366 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18367 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18368 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18369 rewritten.
18370
18371 .vitem &%pass%&
18372 .oindex "&%more%&"
18373 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18374 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18375 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18376 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18377 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18378 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18379 combination
18380 .code
18381 self = pass
18382 no_more
18383 .endd
18384 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18385 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18386 be passed to the next router.
18387
18388 .vitem &%fail%&
18389 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18390
18391 .vitem &%send%&
18392 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18393 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18394 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18395 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18396 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18397 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18398 .endlist
18399
18400
18401
18402 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18403 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18404 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18405 address matches something on the list.
18406 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18407 are evaluated.
18408
18409 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18410 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18411 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18412 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18413 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18414 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18415 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18416 matters.
18417
18418
18419 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18420 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18421 .cindex "packet radio"
18422 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18423 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18424 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18425 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18426 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18427 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18428 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18429 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18430
18431 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18432 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18433 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18434 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18435 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18436 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18437 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18438 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18439 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18440 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18441 .code
18442 translate_ip_address = \
18443 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18444 {$value}fail}}
18445 .endd
18446 The file would contain lines like
18447 .code
18448 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18449 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18450 .endd
18451 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18452 are doing.
18453
18454
18455
18456 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18457 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18458 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18459 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18460 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18461 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18462 delivery is deferred.
18463
18464 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18465 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18466 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18467
18468
18469
18470 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18471 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18472 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18473 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18474 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18475 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18476 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18477 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18478 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18479 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18480 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18481 environment.
18482
18483
18484
18485
18486 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18487 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18488 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18489 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18490 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18491 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18492 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18493 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18494 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18495 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18496
18497 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18498 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18499 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18500 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18501 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18502
18503 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18504 environment.
18505
18506
18507
18508
18509 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18510 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18511 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18512 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18513 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18514 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18515 delivery to be deferred.
18516
18517 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18518 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18519 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18520 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18521 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18522 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18523
18524 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18525 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18526 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18527 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18528 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18529 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18530 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18531 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18532
18533 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18534 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18535 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18536 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18537 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18538 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18539 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18540 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18541 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18542 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18543
18544 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18545 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18546 subsequent routers.
18547
18548
18549 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18550 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18551 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18552 .cindex "transport" "local"
18553 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18554 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18555 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18556 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18557 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18558 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18559 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18560 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18561 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18562 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18563 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18564 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18565
18566
18567
18568 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18569 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18570 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18571
18572
18573 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18574 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18575 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18576 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18577 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18578 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18579 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18580 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18581 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18582 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18583
18584 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18585 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18586 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18587 user or group.
18588
18589
18590 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18591 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18592 addresses,
18593 delivering in cutthrough mode
18594 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18595 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18596 are evaluated.
18597 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18598
18599
18600 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18601 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18602 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18603 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18604 are evaluated.
18605 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18606 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18607 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18608
18609
18610
18611
18612
18613
18614 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18616
18617 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18618 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18619 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18620 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18621 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18622 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18623 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18624 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18625 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18626 .code
18627 localusers:
18628 driver = accept
18629 domains = mydomain.example
18630 check_local_user
18631 transport = local_delivery
18632 .endd
18633 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18634 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18635 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18636 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18637
18638
18639
18640
18641
18642
18643 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18644 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18645
18646 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18647 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18648 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18649 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18650 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18651 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18652
18653 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18654 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18655 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18656 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18657 records.
18658
18659 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18660 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18661 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18662 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18663 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18664 generic option, the router declines.
18665
18666 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18667 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18668 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18669
18670 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18671 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18672 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18673 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18674 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18675 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18676
18677
18678 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18679 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18680 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18681 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18682 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18683 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18684
18685 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18686 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18687 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18688 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18689 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18690 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18691 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18692 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18693 case routing fails.
18694
18695
18696 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18697 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18698 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18699 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18700 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18701
18702 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18703 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18704
18705 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18706 .ilist
18707 The domain does not exist in DNS
18708 .next
18709 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18710 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18711 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18712 .next
18713 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18714 .next
18715 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18716 .next
18717 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18718 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18719 .next
18720 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18721 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18722 .next
18723 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18724 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18725 .next
18726 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18727 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18728 .endlist
18729
18730
18731
18732
18733 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18734 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18735 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18736
18737 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18738 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18739 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18740 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18741 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18742 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18743 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18744
18745
18746 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18747 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18748 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18749 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18750 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18751 required. For example,
18752 .code
18753 check_srv = smtp
18754 .endd
18755 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18756 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18757 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18758 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18759 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18760 normal way.
18761
18762 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18763 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18764 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18765 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18766 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18767 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18768
18769 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18770 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18771 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18772 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18773 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18774 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18775 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18776 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18777
18778 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18779 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18780
18781
18782
18783
18784 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18785 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18786 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18787 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18788 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18789 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18790 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18791 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18792 also being queued.
18793
18794
18795 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18796 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18797 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18798 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18799 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18800 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18801 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18802 setting:
18803 .code
18804 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18805 .endd
18806 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18807 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18808 the address record.
18809
18810
18811 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18812 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18813 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18814 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18815
18816
18817
18818
18819 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18820 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18821 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18822 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18823 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18824 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18825 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18826 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18827 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18828 &'resolv.conf'&.
18829
18830
18831
18832 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18833 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18834 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18835 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18836 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18837 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18838 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18839 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18840 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18841 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18842 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18843
18844 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18845 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18846 sense.
18847
18848 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18849 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18850 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18851 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18852 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18853 header rewriting.
18854
18855
18856 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18857 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18858 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18859 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18860 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18861 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18862 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18863 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18864
18865 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18866 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18867 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18868 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18869 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18870 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18871 without processing them independently,
18872 provided the following conditions are met:
18873
18874 .ilist
18875 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18876 &%headers_remove%&.
18877 .next
18878 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18879 the domain.
18880 .endlist
18881
18882
18883
18884
18885 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18886 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18887 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18888 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18889 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18890 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18891 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18892 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18893 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18894 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18895
18896 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18897 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18898 local wildcard.
18899
18900
18901
18902 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18903 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18904 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18905 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18906
18907
18908
18909
18910 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18911 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18912 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18913 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18914 if
18915 .code
18916 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18917 .endd
18918 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18919 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18920 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18921 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18922 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18923 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18924
18925
18926 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18927 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18928 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18929 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18930 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18931
18932 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18933 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18934 such as that implied by
18935 .code
18936 domains = @mx_any
18937 .endd
18938 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18939 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18940 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18941 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18942
18943
18944
18945
18946
18947
18948
18949
18950
18951 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18952 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18953
18954 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18955 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18956 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18957 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18958 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18959 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18960 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18961 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18962 router handles the address
18963 .code
18964 root@[192.168.1.1]
18965 .endd
18966 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18967 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18968 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18969 .code
18970 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18971 .endd
18972 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18973 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18974
18975 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18976 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18977 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18978 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18979
18980 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18981 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18982 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18983 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18984
18985
18986
18987 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18988 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18989
18990 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18991 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18992 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18993 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18994 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18995 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18996 must set
18997 .code
18998 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18999 .endd
19000 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19001
19002 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19003 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19004 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19005 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19006 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19007 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19008 must not be specified for it.
19009
19010 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19011 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19012 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19013 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19014 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19015 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19016 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19017
19018
19019 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19020 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19021 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19022 delivery to the address is deferred.
19023
19024
19025 .option port iplookup integer 0
19026 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19027 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19028 call.
19029
19030
19031 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19032 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19033 protocols is to be used.
19034
19035
19036 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19037 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19038 default value is:
19039 .code
19040 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19041 .endd
19042 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19043 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19044
19045
19046 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19047 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19048 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19049 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19050 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19051 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19052 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19053 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19054
19055
19056 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19057 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19058 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19059 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19060 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19061 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19062 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19063 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19064 following could be used:
19065 .code
19066 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19067 reroute = $local_part@$1
19068 .endd
19069
19070 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19071 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19072 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19073 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19074
19075
19076
19077
19078 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19079 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19080
19081 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19082 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19083 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19084 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19085 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19086 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19087 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19088 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19089 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19090 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19091
19092 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19093 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19094 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19095 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19096 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19097 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19098 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19099
19100 .vindex "&$host$&"
19101 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19102 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19103 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19104 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19105 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19106 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19107 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19108 text string.
19109
19110 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19111 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19112 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19113 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19114 below, following the list of private options.
19115
19116
19117 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19118
19119 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19120 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19121
19122 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19123 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19124
19125 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19126 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19127 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19128 of the following values:
19129 .code
19130 decline
19131 defer
19132 fail
19133 freeze
19134 ignore
19135 pass
19136 .endd
19137 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19138 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19139 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19140 &%pass_router%&),
19141 .oindex "&%more%&"
19142 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19143 router only if &%more%& is true.
19144
19145 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19146 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19147 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19148 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19149
19150 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19151 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19152 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19153
19154
19155 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19156 .cindex "randomized host list"
19157 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19158 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19159 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19160 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19161 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19162 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19163 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19164 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19165
19166 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19167 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19168 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19169 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19170 .code
19171 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19172 .endd
19173 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19174 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19175 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19176 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19177 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19178
19179
19180 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19181 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19182 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19183 example:
19184 .code
19185 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19186 .endd
19187 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19188 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19189 deferred.
19190
19191
19192 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19193 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19194 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19195 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19196
19197
19198 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19199 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19200 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19201 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19202 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19203 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19204 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19205 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19206
19207 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19208 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19209 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19210 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19211 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19212 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19213 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19214 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19215
19216
19217
19218
19219 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19220 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19221 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19222 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19223 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19224 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19225 .display
19226 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19227 .endd
19228 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19229 no options:
19230 .code
19231 route_list = \
19232 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19233 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19234 .endd
19235 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19236 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19237 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19238 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19239 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19240 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19241 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19242 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19243 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19244 in a &%route_list%&).
19245
19246 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19247 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19248 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19249 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19250
19251
19252
19253 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19254 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19255 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19256 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19257 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19258 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19259 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19260 like this:
19261 .code
19262 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19263 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19264 .endd
19265 This data can be accessed by setting
19266 .code
19267 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19268 .endd
19269 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19270 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19271 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19272 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19273 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19274
19275
19276
19277
19278 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19279 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19280 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19281 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19282 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19283 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19284 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19285
19286 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19287 variables are set during its expansion:
19288
19289 .ilist
19290 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19291 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19292 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19293 .code
19294 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19295 .endd
19296 .next
19297 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19298 .next
19299 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19300
19301 .next
19302 .vindex "&$value$&"
19303 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19304 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19305 .code
19306 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19307 .endd
19308 .endlist
19309
19310 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19311 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19312
19313
19314
19315 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19316 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19317 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19318 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19319 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19320 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19321
19322 .ilist
19323 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19324 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19325 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19326 .code
19327 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19328 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19329 .endd
19330 .next
19331 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19332 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19333 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19334 number follows. For example:
19335 .code
19336 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19337 .endd
19338 .endlist
19339
19340 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19341 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19342 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19343 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19344 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19345 transport.
19346
19347 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19348 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19349 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19350 records in the DNS. For example:
19351 .code
19352 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19353 .endd
19354 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19355 example:
19356 .code
19357 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19358 .endd
19359 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19360 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19361 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19362 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19363 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19364 happens is controlled by the
19365 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19366 &%self%& option of the router.
19367
19368 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19369 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19370 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19371 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19372 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19373 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19374 defined by MX preferences.
19375
19376 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19377 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19378 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19379
19380 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19381 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19382 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19383 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19384
19385 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19386 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19387 router.
19388
19389 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19390 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19391 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19392
19393 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19394 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19395
19396
19397
19398 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19399 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
19400 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19401 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19402 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19403 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19404 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19405
19406 .ilist
19407 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19408 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19409 .next
19410 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19411 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19412 .next
19413 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19414 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19415 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19416 .next
19417 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19418 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19419 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19420 .endlist
19421
19422 For example:
19423 .code
19424 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19425 domain2 host4:host5
19426 .endd
19427 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19428 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19429 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19430 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19431 call.
19432
19433 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19434 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19435 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19436 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19437 function called.
19438
19439
19440
19441 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19442 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19443
19444 .vindex "&$host$&"
19445 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19446 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19447
19448
19449
19450 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19451 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19452 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19453
19454 .ilist
19455 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19456 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19457 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19458 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19459 .code
19460 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19461 .endd
19462 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19463 your first router something like this:
19464 .code
19465 smart_route:
19466 driver = manualroute
19467 domains = !+local_domains
19468 transport = remote_smtp
19469 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19470 .endd
19471 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19472 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19473 they are tried in order
19474 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19475 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19476 .code
19477 smart_route:
19478 driver = manualroute
19479 transport = remote_smtp
19480 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19481 .endd
19482 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19483 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19484 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19485 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19486 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19487 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19488 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19489 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19490
19491 .next
19492 .cindex "mail hub example"
19493 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19494 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19495 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19496 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19497 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19498 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19499 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19500 lookup is easier to manage.
19501
19502 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19503 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19504 example:
19505 .code
19506 hub_route:
19507 driver = manualroute
19508 transport = remote_smtp
19509 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19510 .endd
19511 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19512 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19513 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19514 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19515 domain can be used to find the host:
19516 .code
19517 through_firewall:
19518 driver = manualroute
19519 transport = remote_smtp
19520 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19521 .endd
19522 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19523 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19524 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19525 next router.
19526
19527 .next
19528 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19529 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19530 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19531 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19532 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19533 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19534 .code
19535 save_in_file:
19536 driver = manualroute
19537 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19538 route_list = saved.domain.example
19539 .endd
19540 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19541 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19542 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19543 .code
19544 save_in_file:
19545 driver = manualroute
19546 route_list = \
19547 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19548 *.saved.domain2.example \
19549 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19550 batch_pipe
19551 .endd
19552 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19553 .vindex "&$host$&"
19554 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19555 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19556 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19557 the address if the lookup fails.
19558
19559 .next
19560 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19561 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19562 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19563 one way it can be done:
19564 .code
19565 # Transport
19566 uucp:
19567 driver = pipe
19568 user = nobody
19569 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19570 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19571 return_fail_output = true
19572
19573 # Router
19574 uucphost:
19575 transport = uucp
19576 driver = manualroute
19577 route_data = \
19578 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19579 .endd
19580 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19581 .code
19582 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19583 .endd
19584 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19585 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19586 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19587 .endlist
19588 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19589 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19590
19591
19592
19593
19594
19595
19596
19597
19598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19599 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19600
19601 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19602 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19603 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19604 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19605 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19606 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19607 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19608 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19609 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19610 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19611 options:
19612 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19613
19614 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19615 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19616 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19617 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19618 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19619
19620
19621 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19622 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19623 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19624 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19625 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19626 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19627
19628
19629 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19630 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19631 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19632 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19633 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19634 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19635 not set, a value for the gid also.
19636
19637 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19638 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19639 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19640 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19641 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19642 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19643 gid.
19644
19645
19646 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19647 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19648 before running the command.
19649
19650
19651 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19652 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19653 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19654 timeout.
19655
19656
19657 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19658 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19659 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19660 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19661 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19662
19663 .ilist
19664 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19665 below).
19666 .next
19667 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19668 &%no_more%& is set.
19669 .next
19670 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19671 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19672 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19673 included in the SMTP response.
19674 .next
19675 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19676 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19677 included in any SMTP response.
19678 .next
19679 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19680 .next
19681 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19682 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19683 .next
19684 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19685 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19686 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19687 .endlist
19688
19689 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19690 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19691 the page):
19692 .code
19693 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19694 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19695 .endd
19696 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19697 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19698 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19699 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19700
19701 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19702 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19703 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19704 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19705 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19706
19707 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19708 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19709 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19710 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19711 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19712
19713 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19714 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19715 variable. For example, this return line
19716 .code
19717 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19718 .endd
19719 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19720 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19721 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19722 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19723
19724
19725
19726
19727 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19728 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19729
19730 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19731 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19732 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19733 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19734 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19735 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19736 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19737 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19738 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19739 redirected in several different ways:
19740
19741 .ilist
19742 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19743 independently.
19744 .next
19745 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19746 .next
19747 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19748 .next
19749 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19750 .next
19751 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19752 .next
19753 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19754 .next
19755 It can be discarded.
19756 .endlist
19757
19758 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19759 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19760 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19761 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19762
19763 If success DSNs have been requested
19764 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19765 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19766 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19767
19768
19769
19770 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19771 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19772 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19773 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19774 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19775 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19776 .code
19777 system_aliases:
19778 driver = redirect
19779 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19780 .endd
19781 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19782 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19783 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19784 cause delivery to be deferred.
19785
19786 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19787 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19788 .code
19789 userforward:
19790 driver = redirect
19791 check_local_user
19792 file = $home/.forward
19793 no_verify
19794 .endd
19795 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19796 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19797 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19798 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19799 comments.
19800
19801
19802
19803 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19804 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19805 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19806 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19807
19808 .ilist
19809 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19810 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19811 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19812 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19813 .next
19814 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19815 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19816 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19817 saves some resources.
19818 .endlist
19819
19820
19821
19822
19823
19824
19825 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19826 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19827 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19828 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19829 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19830
19831 .ilist
19832 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19833 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19834 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19835 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19836 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19837 document is intended for use by end users.
19838 .next
19839 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19840 described in the next section.
19841 .endlist
19842
19843 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19844 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19845 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19846 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19847 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19848
19849
19850
19851 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19852 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19853 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19854 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19855 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19856 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19857 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19858 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19859 commas or newlines.
19860 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19861 quotes.
19862
19863 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19864 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19865 next newline character is ignored.
19866
19867 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19868 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19869 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19870 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19871 removed.
19872
19873 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19874 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19875 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19876 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19877 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19878 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19879 setting:
19880 .code
19881 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19882 .endd
19883
19884
19885 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19886 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19887 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19888 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19889 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19890 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19891 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19892 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19893 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19894 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19895 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19896
19897 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19898 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19899 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19900 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19901 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19902 .code
19903 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19904 .endd
19905 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19906 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19907 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19908 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19909 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19910 synonymously.
19911
19912 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19913 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19914 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19915 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19916 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19917
19918 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19919 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19920 contains:
19921 .code
19922 Sam.Reman: spqr
19923 .endd
19924 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19925 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19926 this forward file:
19927 .code
19928 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19929 .endd
19930 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19931 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19932 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19933 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19934 should really contain
19935 .code
19936 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19937 .endd
19938 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19939 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19940 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19941
19942
19943
19944 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19945 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19946 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19947
19948 .ilist
19949 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19950 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19951 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19952 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19953 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19954 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19955 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19956
19957 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19958 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19959 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19960 in double quotes, for example:
19961 .code
19962 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19963 .endd
19964 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19965 quote just the command. An item such as
19966 .code
19967 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19968 .endd
19969 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19970
19971 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19972 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19973 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19974 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19975 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19976 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19977 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19978 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19979 an &%accept%& router.
19980
19981 .next
19982 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19983 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19984 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19985 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19986 .code
19987 /home/world/minbari
19988 .endd
19989 is treated as a file name, but
19990 .code
19991 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19992 .endd
19993 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19994 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19995 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19996 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19997
19998 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19999 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20000
20001 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20002 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20003 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20004 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20005
20006 .next
20007 .cindex "included address list"
20008 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20009 If an item is of the form
20010 .code
20011 :include:<path name>
20012 .endd
20013 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20014 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20015 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20016 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20017 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20018 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20019 .code
20020 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20021 .endd
20022 It must be given as
20023 .code
20024 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20025 .endd
20026 .next
20027 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20028 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20029 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20030 .cindex "black hole"
20031 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20032 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20033 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20034 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20035 .code
20036 :blackhole:
20037 .endd
20038 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20039 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20040 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20041
20042 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20043 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20044 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20045 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20046 &_/dev/null_&.
20047
20048 .next
20049 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20050 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20051 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20052 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20053 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20054 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20055 redirection items of the form
20056 .code
20057 :defer:
20058 :fail:
20059 .endd
20060 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20061 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20062 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20063 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20064 .code
20065 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20066 .endd
20067 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20068 of a
20069 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20070 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20071 default.
20072 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20073 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20074 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20075
20076 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20077 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20078 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20079 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20080 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20081 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20082 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20083 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20084 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20085 ignored.
20086
20087 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20088 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20089 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20090 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20091
20092 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20093 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20094 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20095 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20096 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20097
20098 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20099 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20100 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20101 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20102 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20103 rules still apply.
20104
20105 .next
20106 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20107 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20108 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20109 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20110 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20111 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20112 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20113 .endlist
20114
20115
20116 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20117 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20118 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20119 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20120 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20121 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20122 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20123 aliasing scheme of the type
20124 .code
20125 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20126 localpart1: pipe
20127 localpart2: pipe
20128 .endd
20129 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20130 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20131 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20132 such as
20133 .code
20134 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20135 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20136 .endd
20137 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20138 the pipes are distinct.
20139
20140
20141
20142 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20143 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20144 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20145 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20146 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20147 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20148 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20149 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20150 can be used to avoid this.
20151
20152
20153 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20154 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20155 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20156 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20157 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20158 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20159 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20160
20161
20162
20163 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20164
20165 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20166 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20167
20168
20169 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20170 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20171 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20172
20173
20174 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20175 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20176 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20177 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20178
20179
20180 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20181 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20182 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20183 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20184 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20185 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20186 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20187
20188 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20189 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20190
20191
20192 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20193 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20194 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20195 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20196 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20197
20198
20199
20200 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20201 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20202 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20203 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20204 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20205 let ordinary users do.
20206
20207
20208
20209 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20210 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20211 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20212 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20213 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20214 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20215
20216 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20217 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20218 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20219 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20220 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20221 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20222 .code
20223 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20224 .endd
20225 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20226 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20227 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20228 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20229 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20230 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20231 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20232 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20233
20234
20235 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20236 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20237 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20238 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20239 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20240 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20241 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20242 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20243
20244
20245
20246 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20247 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20248 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20249 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20250 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20251 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20252
20253
20254 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20255 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20256 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20257 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20258 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20259 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20260
20261 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20262 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20263 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20264 .code
20265 data = #Exim filter\n\
20266 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20267 .endd
20268 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20269 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20270 choice into a newline.
20271
20272
20273 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20274 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20275 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20276 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20277 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20278
20279
20280 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20281 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20282 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20283 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20284 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20285 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20286 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20287 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20288
20289 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20290 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20291 runs a check on the containing directory,
20292 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20293 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20294 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20295 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20296 not, the router declines.
20297
20298
20299 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20300 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20301 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20302 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20303 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20304 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20305 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20306
20307
20308 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20309 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20310 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20311 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20312 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20313
20314
20315 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20316 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20317 redirection list.
20318
20319
20320 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20321 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20322 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20323
20324
20325
20326
20327 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20328 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20329 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20330 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20331 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20332 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20333 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20334 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20335 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20336
20337
20338 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20339 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20340 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20341 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20342 functions.
20343
20344 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20345 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20346 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20347 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20348
20349 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20350 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20351 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20352 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20353 &_.forward_& files).
20354
20355
20356 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20357 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20358 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20359
20360
20361 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20362 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20363 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20364 of the embedded Perl support.
20365
20366
20367 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20368 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20369 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20370
20371
20372 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20373 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20374 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20375
20376
20377 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20378 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20379 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20380 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20381 &%one_time%& is set.
20382
20383
20384 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20385 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20386 to make use of &%run%& items.
20387
20388
20389 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20390 If this option is true, items of the form
20391 .code
20392 :include:<path name>
20393 .endd
20394 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20395
20396
20397 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20398 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20399 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20400 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20401 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20402
20403
20404 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20405 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20406 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20407
20408
20409 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20410 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20411 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20412 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20413 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20414
20415
20416
20417
20418 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20419 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20420 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20421 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20422 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20423 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20424 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20425
20426
20427 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20428 .cindex "EACCES"
20429 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20430 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20431 file did not exist.
20432
20433
20434 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20435 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
20436 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20437 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20438 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20439
20440 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20441 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20442 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20443 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20444 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20445 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20446 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20447 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20448
20449
20450
20451 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20452 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20453 redirection list must start with this directory.
20454
20455
20456 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20457 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20458 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20459
20460
20461 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20462 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20463 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20464 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20465 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20466 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20467 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20468 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20469 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20470 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20471 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20472 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20473 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20474 before they subscribed.
20475
20476 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20477 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20478 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20479 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20480 attempt.
20481
20482 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20483 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20484 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20485 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20486
20487 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20488 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20489 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20490
20491 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20492 &%one_time%&.
20493
20494 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20495 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20496 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20497 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20498 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20499 expansion.
20500
20501
20502 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20503 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20504 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20505 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20506 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20507 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20508 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20509 See &%check_owner%& above.
20510
20511
20512 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20513 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20514 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20515 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20516
20517
20518 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20519 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20520 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20521 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20522 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20523 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20524 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20525
20526
20527 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20528 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20529 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20530 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20531 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20532 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20533 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20534 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20535
20536 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20537 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20538 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20539 addresses.
20540
20541 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20542 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20543 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20544 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20545 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20546 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20547 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20548 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20549 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20550 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20551
20552
20553 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20554 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20555 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20556 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20557 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20558 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20559
20560
20561 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20562 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20563 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20564 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20565 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20566 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20567
20568
20569 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20570 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20571 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20572 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20573 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20574
20575
20576 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20577 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20578 :subaddress part of an address.
20579
20580 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20581 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20582 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20583 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20584
20585
20586 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20587 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20588 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20589 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20590 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20591 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20592 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20593
20594
20595
20596 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20597 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20598 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20599 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20600 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20601 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20602 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20603 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20604 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20605 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20606 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20607 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20608 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20609 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20610 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20611 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20612
20613 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20614 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20615 the following routers.
20616
20617 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20618 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20619 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20620 so it is passed to the following routers.
20621
20622 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20623 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20624 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20625 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20626
20627 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20628 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20629 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20630 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20631 .code
20632 userforward:
20633 driver = redirect
20634 allow_filter
20635 check_local_user
20636 file = $home/.forward
20637 file_transport = address_file
20638 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20639 reply_transport = address_reply
20640 no_verify
20641 skip_syntax_errors
20642 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20643 syntax_errors_text = \
20644 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20645 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20646 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20647 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20648 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20649 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20650 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20651 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20652 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20653 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20654 .endd
20655 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20656 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20657 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20658 .code
20659 real_localuser:
20660 driver = accept
20661 check_local_user
20662 local_part_prefix = real-
20663 transport = local_delivery
20664 .endd
20665 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20666 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20667 .code
20668 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20669 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20670 .endd
20671
20672
20673 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20674 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20675
20676
20677 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20678 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20679 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20680 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20681
20682
20683
20684
20685
20686
20687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20689
20690 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20691 "Environment for local transports"
20692 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20693 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
20694 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20695 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20696 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20697 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20698 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20699
20700 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20701 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20702 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20703 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20704
20705 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20706 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20707 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20708 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20709 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20710
20711
20712
20713 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20714 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20715 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20716 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20717 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20718 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20719 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20720 time.
20721
20722 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20723 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20724 .code
20725 my_transport:
20726 driver = pipe
20727 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20728 .endd
20729 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20730 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20731 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20732 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20733
20734
20735
20736
20737 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20738 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20739 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20740 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20741 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20742 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20743 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20744 group (set by the transport). For example:
20745 .code
20746 # Routers ...
20747 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20748 local_users:
20749 driver = accept
20750 check_local_user
20751 transport = group_delivery
20752
20753 # Transports ...
20754 # This transport overrides the group
20755 group_delivery:
20756 driver = appendfile
20757 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20758 group = mail
20759 .endd
20760 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20761 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20762 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20763 set.
20764
20765 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20766 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20767 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20768 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20769 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20770 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20771
20772 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20773 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20774 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20775 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20776 original gid is also used.
20777
20778 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20779 following that is set is used:
20780
20781 .ilist
20782 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20783 .next
20784 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20785 .next
20786 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20787 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20788 .next
20789 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20790 .next
20791 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20792 the uid is the creator's uid;
20793 .next
20794 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20795 .endlist
20796
20797 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20798 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20799 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20800 The first of the following that is set is used:
20801
20802 .ilist
20803 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20804 .next
20805 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20806 .next
20807 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20808 .next
20809 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20810 .next
20811 The Exim uid.
20812 .endlist
20813
20814 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20815 &%never_users%& list.
20816
20817
20818
20819
20820
20821 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20822 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20823 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20824 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20825 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20826 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20827 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20828 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20829 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20830 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20831
20832 .ilist
20833 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20834 .next
20835 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20836 .next
20837 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20838 .next
20839 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20840 .endlist
20841
20842 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20843
20844 .ilist
20845 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20846 .next
20847 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20848 .endlist
20849
20850
20851 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20852 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20853 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20854
20855
20856
20857 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20858 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20859 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20860 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20861 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20862 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20863 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20864 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20865 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20866 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20867 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20868 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20869 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20870 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20871
20872
20873
20874
20875
20876
20877
20878 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20880
20881 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20882 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20883 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20884 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20885 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20886
20887
20888 .option body_only transports boolean false
20889 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20890 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20891 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20892 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20893 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20894 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20895 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20896 automatically suppress them.
20897
20898
20899 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20900 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20901 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20902 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20903 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20904 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20905
20906
20907 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20908 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20909 deliveries by the transport or for any
20910 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20911 what you are doing.
20912
20913
20914 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20915 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20916 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20917 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20918 transport is run.
20919 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20920 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20921 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20922 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20923 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20924 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20925 one.
20926 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20927 transport and the router that called it.
20928
20929 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20930 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20931 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20932 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20933 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20934 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20935 safely be resent to other recipients.
20936
20937
20938 .option driver transports string unset
20939 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20940 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20941
20942
20943 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20944 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20945 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20946 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20947 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20948 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20949 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20950 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20951 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20952 resent to other recipients.
20953
20954
20955 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
20956 .cindex events
20957 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
20958 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
20959
20960
20961 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20962 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20963 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20964 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20965 &%user%& (see below).
20966
20967
20968 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20969 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20970 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20971 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20972 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20973 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20974 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20975 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20976 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20977 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20978 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20979
20980 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20981 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20982
20983
20984 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20985 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20986 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20987 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20988 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20989 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20990 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20991 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20992
20993
20994 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20995 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20996 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20997 This option specifies a list of header names,
20998 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20999 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21000 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21001 routers.
21002 Each list item is separately expanded.
21003 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21004 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21005 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21006
21007 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21008 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21009
21010 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21011 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21012 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21013
21014
21015
21016 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21017 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21018 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21019 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21020 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21021 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21022 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21023 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21024 example,
21025 .code
21026 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21027 x@y w@z
21028 .endd
21029 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21030 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21031 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21032 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21033 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21034 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21035 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21036 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21037 change envelope recipients at this time.
21038
21039
21040 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21041 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21042 .vindex "&$home$&"
21043 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21044 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21045 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21046 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21047 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21048 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21049 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21050 deferred.
21051
21052
21053 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21054 .cindex "additional groups"
21055 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21056 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21057 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21058 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21059 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21060
21061
21062 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21063 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21064 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21065 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21066 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21067 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21068 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21069 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21070
21071 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21072 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21073 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21074 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21075 Obviously there is scope for
21076 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21077 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21078
21079 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21080 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21081 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21082 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21083 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21084
21085
21086 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21087 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21088 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21089 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21090 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21091 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21092 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21093 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21094 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21095 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21096 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21097 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21098 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21099 delivered.
21100
21101
21102
21103 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21104 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21105 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21106 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21107 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21108 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21109 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21110 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21111 that contains
21112 .code
21113 local_part_prefix = *-
21114 .endd
21115 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21116 is delivered with
21117 .code
21118 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21119 .endd
21120 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21121 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21122 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21123 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21124 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21125
21126
21127 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21128 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21129 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21130 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21131 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21132 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21133 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21134 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21135 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21136
21137 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21138 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21139 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21140 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21141
21142 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21143 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21144 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21145
21146
21147 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21148 .cindex "envelope sender"
21149 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21150 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21151 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21152 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21153 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21154 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21155 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21156 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21157 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21158
21159 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21160 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21161
21162 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21163 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21164 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21165 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21166 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21167 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21168 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21169
21170 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21171 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21172 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21173 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21174 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21175
21176
21177
21178 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21179 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21180 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21181 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21182 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21183 have easy access to it.
21184
21185 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21186 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21187 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21188 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21189 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21190 recipients.
21191
21192
21193 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21194 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21195
21196
21197 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21198 .cindex "shadow transport"
21199 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21200 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21201 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21202
21203 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21204 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21205 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21206 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21207 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21208 cause a log line to be written.
21209
21210 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21211 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21212 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21213 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21214 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21215 of the form
21216 .code
21217 ST=<shadow transport name>
21218 .endd
21219 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21220 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21221 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21222 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21223 headers that some sites insist on.
21224
21225
21226 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21227 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21228 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21229 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21230 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21231 individual users or via a system filter.
21232 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21233
21234 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21235 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21236 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21237 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21238 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21239
21240 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21241 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21242 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21243 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21244 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21245 &(pipe)& transports.
21246
21247 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21248 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21249 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21250 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21251 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21252
21253 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21254 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21255 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21256 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21257
21258 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21259 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21260 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21261 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21262 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21263 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21264
21265 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21266 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21267 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21268 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21269 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21270 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21271 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21272 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21273
21274 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21275 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21276 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21277 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21278 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21279 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21280 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21281 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21282 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21283 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21284
21285 .vindex "&$host$&"
21286 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21287 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21288 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21289 which the message is being sent. For example:
21290 .code
21291 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21292 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21293 .endd
21294
21295 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21296 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21297 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21298 .ilist
21299 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21300 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21301 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21302 example:
21303 .code
21304 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21305 .endd
21306 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21307 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21308 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21309 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21310 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21311 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21312 .next
21313 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21314 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21315 arguments. Consider this example:
21316 .code
21317 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21318 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21319 .endd
21320 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21321 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21322 .code
21323 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21324 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21325 .endd
21326 .endlist
21327
21328 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21329 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21330 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21331 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21332 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21333 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21334 bounced from a transport filter.
21335
21336 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21337 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21338 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21339
21340
21341 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21342 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21343 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21344 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21345 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21346 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21347 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21348 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21349 becomes a temporary error.
21350
21351
21352 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21353 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21354 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21355 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21356 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21357 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21358 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21359 option is not set.
21360
21361 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21362 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21363 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21364
21365 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21366 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21367 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21368 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21369 retry data.
21370 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21371 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21372 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21373
21374
21375
21376
21377
21378
21379 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21380 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21381
21382 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21383 "Address batching"
21384 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21385 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21386 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21387 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21388 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21389 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21390 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21391
21392 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21393 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21394 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21395 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21396 local transport, for example:
21397
21398 .ilist
21399 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21400 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21401 recipients saves space.
21402 .next
21403 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21404 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21405 .next
21406 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21407 to a scanner program or
21408 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21409 acceptable.
21410 .endlist
21411
21412 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21413 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21414 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21415
21416 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21417 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21418 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21419 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21420 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21421 to certain conditions:
21422
21423 .ilist
21424 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21425 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21426 batching is possible.
21427 .next
21428 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21429 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21430 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21431 .next
21432 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21433 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21434 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21435 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21436 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21437 from taking place.
21438 .next
21439 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21440 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21441 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21442 be the same.
21443 .endlist
21444
21445 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21446 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21447 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21448 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21449 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21450 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21451 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21452 .code
21453 check_string = "."
21454 escape_string = ".."
21455 .endd
21456 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21457 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21458 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21459
21460 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21461 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21462 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21463 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21464 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21465 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21466
21467 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21468 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21469 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21470 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21471 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21472 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21473 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21474 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21475 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21476
21477
21478
21479
21480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21482
21483 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21484 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21485 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21486 .cindex "directory creation"
21487 .cindex "creating directories"
21488 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21489 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21490 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21491 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21492 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21493 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21494 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21495 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21496 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21497 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21498
21499 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21500 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21501 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21502 included.
21503
21504 .cindex "quota" "system"
21505 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21506 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21507 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21508
21509 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21510 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21511 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21512 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21513
21514 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21515 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21516 private options.
21517
21518 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21519 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21520 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21521 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21522 option).
21523
21524
21525
21526 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21527 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21528 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21529 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21530 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21531
21532 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21533 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21534 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21535 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21536 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21537 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21538 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21539 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21540 operation. There are two cases:
21541
21542 .ilist
21543 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21544 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21545 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21546 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21547 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21548 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21549 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21550 .next
21551 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21552 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21553 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21554 .endlist
21555
21556
21557 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21558 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21559 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21560 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21561 form:
21562 .code
21563 save folder23
21564 .endd
21565 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21566 .code
21567 require "fileinto";
21568 fileinto "folder23";
21569 .endd
21570 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21571 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21572 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21573 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21574 way of handling this requirement:
21575 .code
21576 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21577 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21578 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21579 {$address_file} \
21580 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21581 }} \
21582 }
21583 .endd
21584 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21585 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21586 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21587
21588 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21589 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21590 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21591 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21592 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21593 path to the transport.
21594
21595 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21596 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21597
21598
21599
21600
21601 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21602 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21603
21604
21605
21606 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21607 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21608 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21609 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21610 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21611 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21612 delivery is deferred.
21613
21614
21615 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21616 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21617 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21618 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21619 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21620 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21621 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21622 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21623
21624
21625 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21626 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21627 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21628 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21629 file.
21630
21631
21632 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21633 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21634
21635
21636 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21637 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21638 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21639 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21640 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21641
21642
21643 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21644 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21645 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21646 process is running.
21647
21648
21649 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21650 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21651 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21652 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21653 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21654 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21655 contains is significant.
21656
21657 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21658 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21659 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21660 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21661 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21662
21663 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21664 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21665 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21666 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21667 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21668 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21669 .code
21670 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21671 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21672 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21673 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21674 .endd
21675 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21676 .cindex "directory creation"
21677 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21678 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21679 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21680
21681 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21682 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21683 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21684 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21685 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21686
21687
21688
21689 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21690 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21691 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21692 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21693 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21694 beneath.
21695
21696 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21697 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21698 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21699 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21700 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21701 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21702 &%file_must_exist%&.
21703
21704
21705 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21706 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21707 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21708 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21709
21710 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21711 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21712 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21713 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21714 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21715
21716
21717 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21718 .cindex "base62"
21719 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21720 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21721 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21722 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21723 .code
21724 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21725 .endd
21726 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21727 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21728 option.
21729
21730
21731 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21732 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21733 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21734
21735
21736 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21737 See &%check_string%& above.
21738
21739
21740 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21741 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21742 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21743 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21744 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21745 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21746 &%file%&.
21747
21748 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21749 .cindex "locking files"
21750 .cindex "lock files"
21751 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21752 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21753
21754 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21755 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21756 examples:
21757 .code
21758 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21759 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21760 file = $home/inbox
21761 .endd
21762 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21763 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21764 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21765 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21766 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21767 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21768
21769
21770
21771 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21772 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21773 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21774 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21775 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21776 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21777 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21778 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21779 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21780 this added to it:
21781 .code
21782 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21783 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21784 .endd
21785 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21786 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21787 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21788 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21789 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21790 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21791 delivery is deferred.
21792
21793
21794 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21795 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21796 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21797 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21798
21799
21800 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21801 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21802 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21803 .cindex "locking files"
21804 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21805 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21806 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21807 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21808 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21809 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21810 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21811 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21812
21813 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21814 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21815 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21816 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21817
21818 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21819 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21820 retries is
21821 .code
21822 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21823 .endd
21824 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21825 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21826 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21827
21828 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21829 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21830 .code
21831 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21832 .endd
21833
21834 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21835 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21836 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21837 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21838
21839
21840 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21841 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21842 for details of locking.
21843
21844
21845 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21846 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21847 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21848
21849
21850 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21851 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21852 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21853
21854
21855 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21856 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21857 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21858 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21859 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21860
21861
21862 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21863 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21864 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21865 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21866 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21867 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21868 external source that maintains the data.
21869
21870
21871 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21872 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21873 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21874 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21875 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21876 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21877 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21878 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21879
21880
21881
21882 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21883 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21884 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21885 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21886 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21887 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21888 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21889 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21890 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21891 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21892
21893
21894 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21895 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21896 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21897 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21898 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21899 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21900 calculation. The default value is:
21901 .code
21902 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21903 .endd
21904 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21905 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21906 &_Trash_&
21907 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21908 .code
21909 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21910 .endd
21911 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21912 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21913 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21914 directly into that directory.
21915
21916
21917 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21918 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21919 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21920
21921
21922 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21923 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21924 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21925
21926
21927 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21928 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21929 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21930 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21931 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21932 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21933 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21934 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21935
21936 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21937 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21938 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21939 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21940 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21941 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21942 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21943 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21944 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21945 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21946
21947
21948 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21949 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21950 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21951 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21952 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21953 below for further details.
21954
21955
21956 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21957 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21958 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21959
21960
21961 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21962 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21963 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21964
21965
21966 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21967 .cindex "locking files"
21968 .cindex "file" "locking"
21969 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21970 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21971 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21972 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21973 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21974 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21975 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21976
21977 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21978 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21979 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21980 combination:
21981 .code
21982 mbx_format = true
21983 message_prefix =
21984 message_suffix =
21985 .endd
21986 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21987 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21988 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21989 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21990 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21991 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21992 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21993 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21994
21995 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21996 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21997 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21998 append messages to it.
21999
22000
22001 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22002 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22003 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22004 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22005 in which case it is:
22006 .code
22007 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22008 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22009 .endd
22010 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22011 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22012
22013 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22014 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22015 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22016 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22017 setting
22018 .code
22019 message_suffix =
22020 .endd
22021 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22022 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22023
22024 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22025 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22026 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22027 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22028 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22029 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22030 value, and this option is ignored.
22031
22032
22033 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22034 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22035 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22036 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22037 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22038
22039
22040 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22041 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22042 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22043 on users about incoming mail.
22044
22045
22046 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22047 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22048 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22049 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22050 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22051 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22052 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22053 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22054 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22055
22056 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22057 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22058 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22059
22060 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22061 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22062 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22063 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22064 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22065 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22066
22067 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22068 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22069 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
22070 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22071 be handled.
22072
22073 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22074
22075 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22076 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22077 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22078 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22079 system quota failures.
22080
22081 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22082 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22083 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22084 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22085 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22086 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22087 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22088 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22089 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22090 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22091
22092
22093 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22094 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22095 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22096 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22097 delivery directory.
22098
22099
22100 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22101 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22102 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22103 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22104 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22105 &"no quota"&.
22106
22107
22108 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22109 See &%quota%& above.
22110
22111
22112 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22113 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22114 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22115 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22116 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22117 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22118 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22119
22120 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22121 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22122 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22123 the file length to the file name. For example:
22124 .code
22125 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22126 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22127 .endd
22128 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22129 number of lines in the message.
22130
22131 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22132 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22133 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22134
22135 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22136
22137
22138 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22139 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22140 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22141 .code
22142 quota_warn_message = "\
22143 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22144 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22145 This message is automatically created \
22146 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22147 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22148 a warning threshold that is\n\
22149 set by the system administrator.\n"
22150 .endd
22151
22152
22153 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22154 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22155 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22156 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22157 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22158 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22159 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22160 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22161 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22162 sign. For example:
22163 .code
22164 quota = 10M
22165 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22166 .endd
22167 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22168 percent sign is ignored.
22169
22170 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22171 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22172 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22173 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22174 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22175 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22176 .code
22177 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22178 .endd
22179 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22180 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22181 option.
22182
22183 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22184 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22185 percentage.
22186
22187
22188 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22189 .cindex "envelope sender"
22190 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22191 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22192 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22193 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22194 for details of batch SMTP.
22195
22196
22197 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22198 .cindex "carriage return"
22199 .cindex "linefeed"
22200 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22201 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22202 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22203 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22204
22205 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22206 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22207 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22208 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22209 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22210 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22211
22212
22213 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22214 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22215 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22216 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22217 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22218 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22219
22220
22221 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22222 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22223 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22224 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22225 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22226
22227 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22228 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22229 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22230 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22231
22232 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22233 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22234 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22235 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22236 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22237 error.
22238
22239 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22240 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22241
22242
22243 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22244 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22245 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22246 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22247 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22248 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22249 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22250
22251 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22252 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22253 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22254 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22255 file corruption.
22256
22257 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22258 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22259 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22260
22261
22262 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22263 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22264 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22265 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22266 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22267 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22268 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22269 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22270 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22271
22272 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22273 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22274 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22275 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22276
22277
22278
22279
22280 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22281 .cindex "appending to a file"
22282 .cindex "file" "appending"
22283 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22284
22285 .ilist
22286 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22287 return is given.
22288
22289 .next
22290 .cindex "directory creation"
22291 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22292 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22293 &%directory_mode%& option.
22294
22295 .next
22296 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22297 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22298 transport.
22299
22300 .next
22301 .cindex "file" "locking"
22302 .cindex "locking files"
22303 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22304 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22305 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22306
22307 .olist
22308 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22309 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22310 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22311 .next
22312 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22313 .next
22314 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22315 Unlink the hitching post name.
22316 .next
22317 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22318 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22319 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22320 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22321 .next
22322 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22323 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22324 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22325 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22326 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22327 it before trying again.
22328 .endlist olist
22329
22330 .next
22331 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22332 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22333 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22334
22335 .next
22336 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22337 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22338 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22339 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22340 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22341 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22342 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22343 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22344 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22345 checked.
22346
22347 .next
22348 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22349 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22350 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22351 delivery is deferred.
22352
22353 .next
22354 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22355 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22356 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22357 permissions.
22358
22359 .next
22360 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22361 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22362 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22363
22364 .next
22365 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22366 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22367 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22368
22369 .next
22370 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22371 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22372 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22373 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22374 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22375 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22376 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22377 that prevents link following.
22378
22379 .next
22380 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22381 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22382 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22383 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22384 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22385
22386 .next
22387 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22388
22389 .next
22390 .cindex "file" "locking"
22391 .cindex "locking files"
22392 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22393 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22394 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22395 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22396 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22397 .code
22398 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22399 .endd
22400 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22401 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22402 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22403
22404 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22405 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22406 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22407
22408 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22409 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22410 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22411 delivery is deferred.
22412
22413 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22414 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22415 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22416 immediately. It retries up to
22417 .code
22418 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22419 .endd
22420 times (rounded up).
22421 .endlist
22422
22423 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22424 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22425
22426
22427 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22428 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22429 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22430 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22431 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22432 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22433 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22434 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22435 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22436 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22437
22438 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22439 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22440 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22441 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22442 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22443 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22444 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22445
22446 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22447 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22448 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22449 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22450
22451
22452 .cindex "maildir format"
22453 .cindex "mailstore format"
22454 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22455 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22456 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22457 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22458 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22459
22460 .cindex "directory creation"
22461 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22462 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22463 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22464 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22465 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22466 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22467 deferred.
22468
22469
22470
22471 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22472 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22473 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22474 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22475 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22476 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22477 &_new_& subdirectory.
22478
22479 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22480 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22481 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22482 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22483 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22484 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22485 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22486
22487 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22488 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22489 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22490 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22491 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22492 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22493 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22494 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22495
22496 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22497 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22498 folders. Consider this example:
22499 .code
22500 maildir_format = true
22501 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22502 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22503 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22504 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22505 .endd
22506 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22507 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22508 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22509 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22510 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22511 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22512
22513 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22514 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22515 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22516 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22517 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22518
22519 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22520 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22521 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22522
22523 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22524 .cindex "maildir++"
22525 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22526 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22527 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22528 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22529 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22530 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22531 amount of space used.
22532
22533 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22534 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22535 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22536 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22537 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22538 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22539
22540
22541
22542
22543 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22544 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22545 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22546 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22547 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22548 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22549
22550
22551 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22552 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22553 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22554 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22555 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22556 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22557 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22558 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22559 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22560 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22561 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22562 backwards compatibility).
22563
22564 For one common implementation, you might set:
22565 .code
22566 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22567 .endd
22568 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22569
22570 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22571 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22572 &[stat()]& each message file.
22573
22574
22575 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22576 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22577 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22578 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22579 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22580 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22581 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22582 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22583 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22584
22585 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22586 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22587 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22588 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22589 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22590 need to know the quota.
22591
22592 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22593 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22594
22595 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22596 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22597 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22598 details.
22599
22600
22601 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22602 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22603 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22604 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22605 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22606 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22607 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22608 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22609
22610 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22611 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22612 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22613 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22614 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22615 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22616
22617 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22618 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22619 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22620 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22621 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22622 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22623
22624 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22625 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22626 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22627 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22628
22629
22630 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22631 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22632 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22633 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22634 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22635 .code
22636 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22637 .endd
22638 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22639 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22640 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22641 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22642 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22643
22644
22645
22646
22647
22648
22649 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22651
22652 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22653 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22654 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22655 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22656 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22657 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22658 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22659 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22660
22661 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22662 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22663 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22664 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22665 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22666
22667
22668 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22669 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22670 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22671 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22672 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22673
22674 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22675 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22676 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22677 transport is run as a consequence of a
22678 &%mail%&
22679 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22680 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22681 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22682 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22683 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22684 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22685
22686 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22687 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22688 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22689 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22690
22691 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22692 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22693 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22694 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22695 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22696 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22697 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22698
22699 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22700 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22701 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22702 the transport defers.
22703 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22704 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22705
22706 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22707 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22708 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22709 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22710
22711 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22712 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22713 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22714 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22715 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22716 problems. They are just discarded.
22717
22718
22719
22720 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22721 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22722
22723 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22724 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22725 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22726
22727
22728 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22729 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22730 when the message is specified by the transport.
22731
22732
22733 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22734 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22735 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22736 string comes first.
22737
22738
22739 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22740 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22741 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22742
22743
22744 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22745 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22746 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22747
22748
22749 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22750 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22751 specified by the transport.
22752
22753
22754 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22755 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22756 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22757 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22758
22759
22760 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22761 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22762 the message is specified by the transport.
22763
22764
22765 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22766 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22767 used.
22768
22769
22770 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22771 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22772 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22773 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22774 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22775
22776
22777
22778 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22779 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22780 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22781 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22782
22783 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22784 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22785 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22786 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22787 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22788 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22789 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22790 infinity.
22791
22792 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22793 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22794 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22795 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22796 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22797
22798 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22799 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22800 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22801 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22802 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22803 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22804
22805
22806 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22807 See &%once%& above.
22808
22809
22810 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22811 See &%once%& above.
22812 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22813
22814
22815 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22816 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22817 specified by the transport.
22818
22819
22820 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22821 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22822 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22823 configuration option.
22824
22825
22826 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22827 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22828 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22829 automatic responses. For example:
22830 .code
22831 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22832 .endd
22833 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22834 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22835 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22836 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22837 small.
22838
22839
22840
22841 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22842 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22843 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22844 the text comes first.
22845
22846
22847 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22848 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22849 when the message is specified by the transport.
22850 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22851 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22852
22853
22854
22855
22856 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22857 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22858
22859 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22860 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22861 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22862 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22863 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22864 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22865 specified command
22866 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22867 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22868 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22869 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22870 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22871 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22872 .code
22873 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22874 .endd
22875 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22876 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22877 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22878 as follows:
22879
22880 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22881 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22882
22883
22884 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22885 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22886 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22887 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22888 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22889
22890
22891 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22892 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22893 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22894 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22895 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22896 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22897 LMTP protocol.
22898
22899 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22900 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22901 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22902 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22903 in its response to the LHLO command.
22904
22905 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22906 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22907 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22908 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22909
22910
22911 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22912 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22913 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22914 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22915 LMTP transport:
22916 .code
22917 lmtp:
22918 driver = lmtp
22919 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22920 batch_max = 20
22921 user = exim
22922 .endd
22923 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22924 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22925
22926
22927
22928 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22929 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22930
22931 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22932 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22933 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22934 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22935 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22936 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22937 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22938 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22939 following ways:
22940
22941 .ilist
22942 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22943 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22944 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22945 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22946 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22947 .next
22948 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22949 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22950 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22951 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22952 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22953 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22954 that are routed to the transport.
22955 .next
22956 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22957 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22958 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22959 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22960 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22961 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22962 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22963 .endlist
22964
22965
22966 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22967 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22968 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22969
22970 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22971 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22972 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22973 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22974 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22975 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22976 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22977
22978
22979 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22980 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22981 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22982 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22983 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22984 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22985 of "1" to enforce serialization.
22986
22987
22988
22989
22990 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22991 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22992 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22993 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22994 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22995 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22996 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22997 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22998 &"local delivery failed"&.
22999
23000 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23001 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23002 will be sent as normal.
23003
23004 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23005 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23006 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23007 apply in this case.
23008
23009 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23010 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23011 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23012 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23013
23014 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23015 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23016 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23017 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23018 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23019 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23020 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23021 &%temp_errors%&.
23022
23023
23024
23025 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23026 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23027 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23028 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23029 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23030 run.
23031
23032 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23033 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23034 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23035 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23036
23037 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23038 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23039 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23040 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23041 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23042 .code
23043 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23044 .endd
23045 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23046 arguments. You have to write
23047 .code
23048 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23049 .endd
23050 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23051 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23052 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23053 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23054 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23055 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23056 example:
23057 .code
23058 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23059 .endd
23060
23061 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23062 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23063 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23064 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23065 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23066 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23067 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23068 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23069 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23070 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23071
23072 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23073 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23074 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23075 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23076 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23077 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23078 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23079 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23080
23081 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23082 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23083 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23084 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23085 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23086 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23087 control what is done with it.
23088
23089 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23090 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23091 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23092 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23093 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23094 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23095 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23096 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23097 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23098 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23099 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23100
23101
23102
23103 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23104 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23105 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23106 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23107 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23108 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23109 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23110 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23111 .display
23112 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23113 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23114 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23115 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23116 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23117 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23118 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23119 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23120 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23121 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23122 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23123 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23124 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23125 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23126 &`USER `& see below
23127 .endd
23128 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23129 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23130 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23131 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23132 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23133 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23134 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23135
23136 .cindex "HOST"
23137 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23138 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23139 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23140 the router.
23141
23142 .cindex "HOME"
23143 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23144 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23145 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23146 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23147
23148
23149 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23150 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23151
23152
23153
23154 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23155 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23156 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23157 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23158 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23159 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23160 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23161 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23162 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23163 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23164 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23165 example, if
23166 .code
23167 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23168 .endd
23169 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23170 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23171 &%use_shell%& is set.
23172
23173
23174 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23175 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23176
23177
23178 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23179 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23180 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23181
23182
23183 .option check_string pipe string unset
23184 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23185 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23186 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23187 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23188 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23189 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23190 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23191 ignored.
23192
23193
23194 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23195 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23196 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23197 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23198 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23199 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23200 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23201
23202
23203 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23204 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23205 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23206 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23207 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23208 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23209 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23210
23211
23212 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23213 See &%check_string%& above.
23214
23215
23216 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23217 .cindex "exec failure"
23218 .cindex "failure of exec"
23219 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23220 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23221 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23222 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23223 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23224
23225
23226 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23227 .cindex "signal exit"
23228 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23229 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23230 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23231 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23232
23233
23234 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23235 .cindex "force command"
23236 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23237 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23238 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23239 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23240 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23241 command. For example:
23242 .code
23243 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23244 force_command
23245 .endd
23246
23247 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23248 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23249 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23250
23251
23252 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23253 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23254 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23255 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23256 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23257 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23258
23259 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23260 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23261
23262
23263 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23264 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23265 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23266 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23267 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23268 written to the main log.
23269
23270
23271 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23272 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23273 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23274 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23275 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23276 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23277 be set.
23278
23279
23280 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23281 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23282 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23283 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23284 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23285
23286
23287 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23288 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23289 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23290 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23291 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23292 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23293 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23294 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23295
23296
23297 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23298 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23299 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23300 .code
23301 message_prefix = \
23302 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23303 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23304 .endd
23305 .cindex "Cyrus"
23306 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23307 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23308 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23309 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23310 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23311 setting
23312 .code
23313 message_prefix =
23314 .endd
23315 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23316 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23317
23318
23319 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23320 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23321 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23322 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23323 .code
23324 message_suffix =
23325 .endd
23326 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23327 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23328
23329
23330 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23331 This option is expanded and
23332 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23333 variable of the subprocess.
23334 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23335 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23336 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23337
23338
23339 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23340 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23341 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23342 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23343 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23344 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23345 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23346 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23347 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23348
23349
23350 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23351 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23352 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23353 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23354 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23355 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23356 accept the message is used.
23357
23358
23359 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23360 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23361 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23362 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23363 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23364 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23365
23366
23367 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23368 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23369 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23370 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23371 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23372 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23373 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23374
23375
23376
23377 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23378 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23379 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23380 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23381 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23382 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23383 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23384 of them may be set.
23385
23386
23387
23388 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23389 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23390 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23391 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23392 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23393 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23394 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23395 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23396 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23397 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23398 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23399 and 73, respectively.
23400
23401
23402 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23403 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23404 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23405 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23406 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23407 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23408 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23409
23410 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23411 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23412 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23413 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23414 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23415 delivery to be deferred.
23416
23417 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23418 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23419
23420
23421 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23422 .cindex "envelope sender"
23423 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23424 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23425 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23426 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23427 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23428
23429 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23430 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23431 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23432 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23433 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23434 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23435 class database.
23436
23437
23438 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23439 .cindex "carriage return"
23440 .cindex "linefeed"
23441 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23442 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23443 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23444 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23445
23446 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23447 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23448 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23449 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23450 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23451
23452
23453 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23454 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23455 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23456 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23457 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23458 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23459 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23460 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23461 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23462 its &%-c%& option.
23463
23464
23465
23466 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23467 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23468 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23469 .cindex "external local delivery"
23470 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23471 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23472 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23473 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23474 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23475 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23476 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23477 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23478 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23479 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23480 .code
23481 # transport
23482 procmail_pipe:
23483 driver = pipe
23484 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23485 return_path_add
23486 delivery_date_add
23487 envelope_to_add
23488 check_string = "From "
23489 escape_string = ">From "
23490 umask = 077
23491 user = $local_part
23492 group = mail
23493
23494 # router
23495 procmail:
23496 driver = accept
23497 check_local_user
23498 transport = procmail_pipe
23499 .endd
23500 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23501 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23502 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23503 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23504 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23505 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23506
23507 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23508 .code
23509 IFS=" "
23510 .endd
23511 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23512 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23513
23514 .cindex "Cyrus"
23515 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23516 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23517 .code
23518 # transport
23519 local_delivery_cyrus:
23520 driver = pipe
23521 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23522 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23523 user = cyrus
23524 group = mail
23525 return_output
23526 log_output
23527 message_prefix =
23528 message_suffix =
23529
23530 # router
23531 local_user_cyrus:
23532 driver = accept
23533 check_local_user
23534 local_part_suffix = .*
23535 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23536 .endd
23537 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23538 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23539 sender.
23540 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23541 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23542
23543
23544 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23546
23547 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23548 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23549 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23550 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23551 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23552 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23553 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23554 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23555
23556
23557 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23558 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23559 two ways:
23560
23561 .ilist
23562 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23563 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23564 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23565 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23566 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23567 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23568 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23569 .next
23570 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23571 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23572 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23573 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23574 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23575 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23576 process.
23577 .endlist
23578
23579
23580 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23581 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23582 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23583
23584
23585
23586 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23587 .vindex "&$host$&"
23588 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23589 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23590 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23591 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23592 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23593 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23594 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23595 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23596
23597
23598 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23599 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23600 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23601 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23602 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23603 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23604 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23605 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23606 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23607 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23608 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23609 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23610 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23611 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23612
23613 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23614 and will be removed in a future release.
23615
23616
23617 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23618 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23619 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23620
23621
23622 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23623 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23624 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23625 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23626 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23627 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23628 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23629 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23630
23631 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23632 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23633 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23634 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23635 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23636 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23637 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23638 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23639 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23640
23641
23642 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23643 .cindex "Cyrus"
23644 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23645 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23646 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23647 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23648 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23649 ignored.
23650
23651 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23652 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23653 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23654 particular connection.
23655
23656 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23657 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23658 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23659 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23660
23661 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23662 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23663 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23664 .code
23665 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23666 .endd
23667 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23668 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23669
23670 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23671 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23672 value.
23673
23674
23675 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23676 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23677 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23678 authenticated as a client.
23679
23680
23681 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23682 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23683 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23684 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23685
23686
23687 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23688 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23689 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23690 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23691 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23692 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23693 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23694
23695
23696 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23697 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23698 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23699 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23700 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23701 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23702 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23703 option.
23704
23705
23706 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23707 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23708 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23709 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23710
23711
23712 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
23713 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
23714 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
23715 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
23716 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
23717 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
23718 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
23719
23720
23721 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23722 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23723 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23724 cutoff times.
23725
23726 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23727 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23728 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23729 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23730 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23731 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23732
23733 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23734 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23735 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23736 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23737 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23738 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23739 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23740 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23741 to them.
23742
23743
23744 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23745 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23746 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23747 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23748 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23749
23750
23751 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23752 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23753 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23754 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23755 details.
23756
23757
23758 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23759 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23760 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23761 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23762 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23763 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23764 the dnssec request bit set.
23765 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23766
23767
23768
23769 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23770 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23771 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23772 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23773 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23774 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
23775 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23776 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23777 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23778
23779
23780
23781 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23782 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23783 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23784 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23785 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23786 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23787 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23788
23789 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23790 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23791 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23792 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23793 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23794
23795
23796 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23797 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23798 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23799 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23800 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23801 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23802 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23803 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23804
23805 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23806 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23807 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23808 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23809 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23810 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23811
23812 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23813 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23814 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23815 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23816 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23817
23818 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23819 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23820 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23821 copy of the message is sent.
23822
23823 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23824 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23825 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23826 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23827 fails"& facility.
23828
23829
23830 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23831 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23832 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23833 zero.
23834
23835 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23836 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23837 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23838 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23839 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23840 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23841
23842 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23843 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23844 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23845 implementations of TLS.
23846
23847 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23848 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23849 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23850 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23851 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23852 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23853 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23854 option is:
23855 .code
23856 $primary_hostname
23857 .endd
23858 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23859 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23860 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23861 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23862 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23863 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23864 interface address, you could use this:
23865 .code
23866 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23867 {$primary_hostname}}
23868 .endd
23869 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23870 callouts.
23871
23872 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23873 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23874 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23875 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23876 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23877 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23878
23879 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23880 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23881 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23882 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23883
23884 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23885 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23886 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23887 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23888 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23889 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23890 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23891
23892 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23893 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23894 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23895 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23896 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23897 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23898 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23899 address are used.
23900
23901 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23902 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23903
23904
23905 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23906 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23907 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23908 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23909 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23910 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23911 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23912 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23913 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23914 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23915
23916
23917 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23918 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23919 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23920 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23921
23922
23923 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23924 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23925 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23926 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23927
23928 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23929 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23930 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23931 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23932 to any host that matches this list.
23933
23934
23935 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23936 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23937 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23938 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23939 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23940 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23941 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23942 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23943
23944
23945 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23946 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23947 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23948 why it exists.
23949
23950
23951
23952 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23953 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23954 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23955 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23956 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23957 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23958 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23959 explanation of when this might be needed.
23960
23961 .new
23962 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
23963 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23964 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23965 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23966 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
23967 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23968 message on the same session.
23969
23970 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
23971 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
23972 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
23973 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
23974 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
23975 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
23976 logging.
23977 .wen
23978
23979
23980
23981 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23982 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23983 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23984 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23985 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23986
23987
23988 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23989 .cindex "randomized host list"
23990 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23991 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23992 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23993 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23994 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23995 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23996 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23997 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23998
23999 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24000 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24001 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24002 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24003 .code
24004 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24005 .endd
24006 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24007 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24008 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24009
24010 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24011 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24012 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24013 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24014 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24015 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24016 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24017 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24018 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24019
24020
24021 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24022 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24023 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24024 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24025 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24026
24027 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24028 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24029 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24030 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24031 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24032
24033 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24034 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24035 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24036 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24037 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24038 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24039
24040 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24041 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24042 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24043 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24044 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24045 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24046 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24047
24048 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24049 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24050 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24051 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24052 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24053 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24054 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24055
24056 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list!!" unset
24057 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24058 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24059 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24060 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24061 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24062 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24063 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24064 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24065 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24066
24067 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24068 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24069
24070 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24071 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24072
24073 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24074 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24075 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24076 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24077 for multi-recipient messages.
24078 The option can usually be left as default.
24079
24080 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24081 .cindex "bind IP address"
24082 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24083 .vindex "&$host$&"
24084 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24085 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24086 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24087 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24088 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24089 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24090 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24091 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24092 unknown.
24093
24094 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24095 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24096 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24097 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24098 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24099 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24100 .code
24101 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24102 .endd
24103 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24104 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24105 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24106 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24107
24108
24109 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24110 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24111 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24112 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24113 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24114 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24115 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24116 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24117 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24118 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24119 unreachable hosts.
24120
24121
24122 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24123 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24124 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24125 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24126 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24127
24128 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24129 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24130 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24131 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24132 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24133 permits this.
24134
24135
24136 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24137 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24138 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24139 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24140 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24141 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24142 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24143 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24144
24145 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24146 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24147 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24148
24149 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24150 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24151 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24152 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24153 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24154 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24155 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24156 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24157
24158 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24159 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24160 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24161 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24162 is deferred.
24163
24164
24165
24166 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24167 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24168 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24169 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24170 .vindex "&$port$&"
24171 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24172 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24173 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24174 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24175 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24176
24177 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24178 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24179 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24180 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24181
24182
24183 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24184 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24185 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24186 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24187 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24188 addresses is not affected.
24189
24190 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24191 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24192 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24193 Exim to use only the host name.
24194 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24195
24196
24197 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24198 .cindex "serializing connections"
24199 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24200 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24201 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24202 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24203 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24204 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24205 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24206
24207 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24208 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24209 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24210 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24211 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24212 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24213
24214 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24215 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24216 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24217 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24218 are used for ETRN serialization.
24219
24220 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24221
24222
24223 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24224 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24225 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24226 .cindex "size" "of message"
24227 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24228 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24229 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24230 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24231 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24232 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24233 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24234 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24235
24236 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24237 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24238
24239
24240 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24241 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24242 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24243 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24244
24245
24246 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24247 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24248 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24249 .vindex "&$host$&"
24250 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24251 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24252 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24253 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24254 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24255 details of TLS.
24256
24257 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24258 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24259 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24260 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24261 client.
24262
24263
24264 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24265 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24266 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24267 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24268 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24269
24270
24271 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24272 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24273 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24274 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24275 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24276 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24277 will fail.
24278
24279 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24280
24281
24282 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24283 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24284 .vindex "&$host$&"
24285 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24286 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24287 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24288 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24289 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24290 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24291 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24292 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24293
24294
24295 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24296 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24297 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24298 .vindex "&$host$&"
24299 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24300 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24301 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24302 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24303 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24304 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24305 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24306 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24307 ciphers is a preference order.
24308
24309
24310
24311 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24312 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24313 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24314 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24315 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24316 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24317 certificate and private key for the session.
24318
24319 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24320
24321 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24322 TLS extensions.
24323
24324
24325
24326
24327 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24328 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24329 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24330 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24331 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24332 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24333 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24334 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24335 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24336 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24337 in clear.
24338
24339
24340 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24341 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24342 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24343 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24344 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24345 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24346 Note that unless the host is in this list
24347 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24348 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24349 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24350 certificate verification succeeds.
24351
24352
24353 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24354 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24355 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24356 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24357 while verifying the server certificate,
24358 checks will be included on the host name
24359 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24360 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24361 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24362
24363 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24364
24365
24366 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24367 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24368 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24369 .vindex "&$host$&"
24370 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24371 The value of this option must be either the
24372 word "system"
24373 or the absolute path to
24374 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24375 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24376
24377 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24378 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24379 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24380 must be specified.
24381
24382 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24383 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24384
24385 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24386 explicitly
24387 either by file or directory
24388 are added to those given by the system default location.
24389
24390 The values of &$host$& and
24391 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24392 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24393
24394 For back-compatibility,
24395 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24396 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24397 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24398
24399
24400 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24401 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24402 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24403 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24404 certificate verification must succeed.
24405 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24406 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24407 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24408
24409
24410
24411
24412 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24413 "SECTvalhosmax"
24414 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24415 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24416 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24417 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24418 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24419
24420
24421 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24422 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24423 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24424 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24425 retrying.
24426
24427 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24428 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24429 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24430
24431 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24432 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24433 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24434 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24435 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24436
24437 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24438 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24439 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24440 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24441 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24442 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24443 see below for an exception).
24444
24445 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24446 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24447 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24448 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24449 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24450
24451 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24452 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24453 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24454 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24455 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24456 reached their retry times.
24457
24458 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24459 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24460 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24461 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24462 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24463 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24464 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24465 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24466 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24467 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24468 reached.
24469
24470 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24471 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24472 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24473 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24474 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24475 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24476
24477 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24478 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24479 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24480 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24481 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24482 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24483
24484
24485
24486
24487
24488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24489 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24490
24491 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24492 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24493 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24494 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24495 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24496 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24497
24498 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24499 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24500 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24501 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24502 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24503 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24504 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24505
24506 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24507 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24508 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24509 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24510
24511
24512 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24513 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24514 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24515 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24516
24517 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24518 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24519 facility; you do not have to use it.
24520
24521 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24522 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24523 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24524 address to which it applies.
24525
24526 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24527 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24528 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24529 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24530 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24531 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24532 rules.
24533
24534 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24535 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24536 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24537 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24538
24539
24540 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24541 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24542 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24543 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24544 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24545 discouraged.
24546
24547 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24548 illustrated by these examples:
24549
24550 .ilist
24551 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24552 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24553 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24554 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24555 .next
24556 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24557 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24558 .endlist
24559
24560
24561
24562 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24563 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24564 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24565 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24566 message's processing.
24567
24568 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24569 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24570 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24571 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24572 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24573 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24574 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24575 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24576 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24577
24578 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24579 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24580 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24581 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24582 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24583 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24584 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24585 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24586 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24587 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24588
24589 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24590 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24591 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24592 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24593 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24594 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24595
24596 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24597 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24598 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24599
24600 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24601 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24602 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24603 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24604 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24605 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24606 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24607 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24608 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24609
24610 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24611 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24612 transport time.
24613
24614
24615
24616
24617 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24618 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24619 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24620 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24621 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24622 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24623 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24624 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24625 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24626 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24627 .code
24628 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24629 .endd
24630 might produce the output
24631 .code
24632 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24633 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24634 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24635 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24636 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24637 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24638 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24639 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24640 .endd
24641 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24642 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24643 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24644 set for a particular transport.
24645
24646
24647 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24648 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24649 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24650 rules in the form
24651 .display
24652 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24653 .endd
24654 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24655 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24656 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24657 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24658
24659 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24660 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24661 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24662 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24663 ignored.
24664
24665 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24666 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24667 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24668
24669 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24670 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24671 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24672 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24673 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24674 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24675 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24676
24677 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24678 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24679 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24680 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24681 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24682 .code
24683 *@* ${lookup ...
24684 .endd
24685 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24686 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24687
24688
24689 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24690 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24691 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24692 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24693 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24694 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24695 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24696 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24697 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24698
24699 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24700 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24701 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24702
24703 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24704 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24705 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24706 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24707 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24708 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24709 of pattern they are set as follows:
24710
24711 .ilist
24712 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24713 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24714 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24715 pattern
24716 .code
24717 *queen@*.fict.example
24718 .endd
24719 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24720 .code
24721 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24722 $1 = hearts-
24723 $2 = wonderland
24724 .endd
24725 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24726 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24727
24728 .next
24729 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24730 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24731 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24732 rewriting rule of the form
24733 .display
24734 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24735 .endd
24736 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24737 .code
24738 $1 = foo
24739 $2 = bar
24740 $3 = baz.example
24741 .endd
24742 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24743 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24744 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24745 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24746 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24747 .endlist
24748
24749
24750 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24751 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24752 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24753 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24754 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24755 .code
24756 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24757 .endd
24758 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24759 &'From:'& headers.
24760
24761 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24762 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24763 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24764 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24765 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24766 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24767 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24768 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24769 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24770 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24771 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24772 entry written to the panic log.
24773
24774
24775
24776 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24777 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24778
24779 .ilist
24780 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24781 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24782 .next
24783 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24784 .next
24785 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24786 .endlist
24787
24788 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24789 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24790
24791
24792
24793 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24794 "SECID154"
24795 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24796 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24797 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24798 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24799 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24800 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24801 .display
24802 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24803 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24804 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24805 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24806 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24807 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24808 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24809 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24810 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24811 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24812 .endd
24813 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24814 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24815 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24816
24817 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24818 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24819
24820
24821 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24822 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24823 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24824 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24825 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24826 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24827 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24828 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24829 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24830
24831 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24832 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24833 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24834 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24835 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24836 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24837 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24838 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24839
24840
24841 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24842 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24843 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24844 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24845
24846 .ilist
24847 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24848 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24849 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24850 .next
24851 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24852 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24853 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24854 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24855 .next
24856 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24857 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24858 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24859 .next
24860 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24861 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24862 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24863 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24864 .code
24865 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24866 .endd
24867 into
24868 .code
24869 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24870 .endd
24871 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24872 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24873 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24874 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24875 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24876 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24877 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24878 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24879 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
24880
24881 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24882 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24883 .endlist
24884
24885
24886 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24887 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24888 .code
24889 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24890 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24891 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24892 .endd
24893 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24894 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24895 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24896 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24897 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24898 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24899 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24900 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24901
24902 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24903 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24904 .code
24905 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24906 .endd
24907 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24908 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24909
24910 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24911 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24912 messages that originate outside the local host:
24913 .code
24914 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24915 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24916 .endd
24917 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24918 space.
24919
24920 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24921 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24922 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24923 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24924 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24925 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24926 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24927 components. For example, the rule
24928 .code
24929 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24930 .endd
24931 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24932 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24933 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24934 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24935 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24936 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24937 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24938 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24939
24940
24941
24942
24943
24944 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24945 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24946
24947 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24948 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24949 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24950 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24951 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24952 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24953 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24954 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24955 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24956 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24957 address, domain and error.
24958
24959 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24960 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24961 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24962 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24963 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24964 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24965 log selector is set, the message
24966 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24967 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24968 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24969 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24970
24971 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24972 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24973 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24974 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24975 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24976 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24977 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24978 domain are maintained independently.
24979
24980 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24981 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24982 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24983 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24984 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24985 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24986 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24987 the local address is reached.
24988
24989 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24990 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24991 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24992 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24993 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24994
24995 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24996 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24997 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24998 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24999 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25000 messages that it should now be retaining.
25001
25002
25003
25004 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25005 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25006 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25007 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25008 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25009 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25010 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25011 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25012 message's sender, respectively.
25013
25014
25015 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25016 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25017 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25018 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25019 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25020 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25021 example,
25022 .code
25023 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25024 .endd
25025 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25026 whereas
25027 .code
25028 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25029 .endd
25030 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25031 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25032 part.
25033
25034 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25035 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25036 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25037 expressions work in address lists.
25038 .display
25039 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25040 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25041 .endd
25042
25043
25044 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25045 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25046 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25047 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25048 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25049 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25050 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25051 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25052 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25053
25054 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25055 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25056 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25057 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25058 local transports).
25059
25060 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25061 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25062 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25063 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25064 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25065 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25066 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25067 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25068 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25069 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25070 commands.
25071
25072
25073
25074 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25075 "SECID160"
25076 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25077 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25078 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25079 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25080 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25081 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25082 .code
25083 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25084 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25085 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25086 .endd
25087 and the retry rules are
25088 .code
25089 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25090 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25091 .endd
25092 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25093 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25094 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25095 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25096 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25097 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25098
25099 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25100 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25101 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25102 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25103
25104 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25105 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25106 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25107 .code
25108 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25109 .endd
25110 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25111 textual form of the IP address.
25112
25113 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25114 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25115 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25116 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25117
25118 .vlist
25119 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25120 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25121 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25122
25123 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25124 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25125 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25126
25127 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25128 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25129
25130 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25131 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25132 .endlist
25133
25134 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25135 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25136 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25137 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25138 retry rule of this form:
25139 .code
25140 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25141 .endd
25142 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25143 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25144
25145 .vlist
25146 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25147 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25148 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25149 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25150
25151 .vitem &%lookup%&
25152 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25153 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25154 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25155 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25156 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25157
25158 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25159 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25160
25161 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25162 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25163
25164 .vitem &%refused%&
25165 A connection was refused.
25166
25167 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25168 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25169
25170 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25171 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25172
25173 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25174 A connection attempt timed out.
25175
25176 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25177 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25178 obtained from an MX record.
25179
25180 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25181 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25182 obtained from an MX record.
25183
25184 .vitem &%timeout%&
25185 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25186
25187 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25188 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25189 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25190 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25191
25192 .vitem &%quota%&
25193 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25194 transport.
25195
25196 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25197 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25198 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25199 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25200 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25201 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25202 for four days.
25203 .endlist
25204
25205 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25206 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25207 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25208 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25209 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25210 heuristic rules:
25211
25212 .ilist
25213 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25214 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25215 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25216 .next
25217 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25218 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25219 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25220 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25221 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25222 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25223 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25224 .next
25225 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25226 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25227 .endlist
25228
25229 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25230 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25231 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25232 error).
25233
25234
25235
25236 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25237 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25238 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25239 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25240 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25241 form:
25242 .display
25243 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25244 .endd
25245 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25246 .code
25247 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25248 .endd
25249 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25250 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25251 For example:
25252 .code
25253 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25254 .endd
25255 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25256 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25257 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25258 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25259 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25260
25261 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25262 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25263 .code
25264 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25265 .endd
25266 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25267 list is never matched.
25268
25269
25270
25271
25272
25273 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25274 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25275 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25276 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25277 .display
25278 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25279 .endd
25280 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25281 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25282 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25283 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25284 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25285
25286 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25287 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25288 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25289 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25290 The available algorithms are:
25291
25292 .ilist
25293 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25294 the interval.
25295 .next
25296 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25297 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25298 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25299 .next
25300 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25301 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25302 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25303 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25304 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25305 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25306 queue processing times.
25307 .endlist
25308
25309 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25310 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25311 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25312 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25313 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25314 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25315 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25316 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25317 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25318 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25319 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25320 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25321
25322 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25323 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25324 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25325 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25326 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25327 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25328 time.
25329
25330 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25331 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25332 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25333 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25334 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25335 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25336 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25337 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25338 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25339 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25340 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25341 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25342
25343 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25344 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25345 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25346 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25347 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25348 deliveries that have been deferred.
25349
25350
25351 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25352 Here are some example retry rules:
25353 .code
25354 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25355 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25356 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25357 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25358 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25359 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25360 .endd
25361 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25362 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25363 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25364 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25365 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25366 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25367 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25368 days.
25369
25370 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25371 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25372 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25373 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25374 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25375
25376 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25377 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25378 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25379 were not obtained from an MX record.
25380
25381 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25382 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25383 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25384 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25385 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25386
25387
25388
25389 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25390 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25391 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25392 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25393 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25394 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25395 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25396 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25397 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25398 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25399 failing for the first time.
25400
25401 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25402 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25403 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25404 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25405
25406 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25407 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25408 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25409
25410
25411
25412
25413 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25414 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25415 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25416 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25417 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25418 default retry rule:
25419 .code
25420 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25421 .endd
25422 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25423 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25424 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25425
25426 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25427 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25428 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25429 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25430 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25431
25432 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25433 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25434 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25435
25436 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25437 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25438 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25439 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25440 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25441 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25442 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25443 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25444
25445 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25446 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25447 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25448 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25449 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25450 notice.
25451
25452 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25453 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25454 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25455 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25456 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25457 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25458 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25459 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25460 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25461 true.
25462
25463 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25464 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25465 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25466 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25467 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25468 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25469 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25470 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25471 reached.
25472
25473 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25474 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25475 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25476 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25477 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25478 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25479 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25480 time out the address.
25481
25482 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25483 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25484 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25485 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25486 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25487 considered immediately.
25488 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25489 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25490
25491
25492
25493
25494
25495
25496 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25497 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25498
25499 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25500 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25501 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25502 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25503 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25504 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25505 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25506 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25507 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25508 other.
25509
25510 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25511 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25512
25513 .ilist
25514 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25515 the client's EHLO command.
25516 .next
25517 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25518 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25519 .next
25520 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25521 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25522 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25523 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25524 with the AUTH command.
25525 .next
25526 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25527 .next
25528 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25529 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25530 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25531 connection.
25532 .next
25533 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25534 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25535 unauthenticated connection.
25536 .endlist
25537
25538 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25539 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25540 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25541 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25542 .display
25543 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25544 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25545 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25546 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25547 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25548 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25549 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25550 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25551 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25552 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25553 &`250 HELP`&
25554 .endd
25555 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25556 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25557 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25558 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25559 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25560 included by setting
25561 .code
25562 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25563 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25564 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25565 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25566 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25567 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25568 AUTH_SPA=yes
25569 AUTH_TLS=yes
25570 .endd
25571 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25572 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25573 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25574 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25575 work via a socket interface.
25576 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25577 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25578 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25579 supporting setting a server keytab.
25580 The sixth can be configured to support
25581 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25582 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25583 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25584 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25585 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25586
25587 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25588 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25589 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25590 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25591 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25592 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25593 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25594
25595 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25596 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25597 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25598 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25599 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25600 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25601 .code
25602 cram:
25603 driver = cram_md5
25604 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25605 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25606 client_name = ph10
25607 client_secret = secret2
25608 .endd
25609 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25610 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25611
25612 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25613 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25614 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25615 in Exim.
25616
25617 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25618 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25619 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25620 authenticating data.
25621
25622 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25623 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25624 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25625 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25626 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25627 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25628 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25629 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25630 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25631 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25632 choose to honour.
25633
25634 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25635 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25636 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25637 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25638
25639
25640
25641 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25642 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25643 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25644
25645 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25646 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25647 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25648 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25649 encrypted by a setting such as:
25650 .code
25651 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25652 .endd
25653
25654
25655 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25656 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25657 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25658 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25659
25660
25661 .option driver authenticators string unset
25662 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25663 authenticators is to be used.
25664
25665
25666 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25667 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25668 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25669 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25670 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25671 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25672
25673
25674 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25675 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25676 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25677 mechanism is not advertised.
25678 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25679 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25680 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25681
25682
25683 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25684 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25685 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25686 for details.
25687
25688 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25689 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25690
25691 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25692 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25693 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25694 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25695 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25696 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25697 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25698 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25699 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25700 the error text.
25701
25702
25703 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25704 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25705 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25706 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25707 out the values of variables.
25708 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25709 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25710
25711
25712 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25713 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25714 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25715 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25716 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25717 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25718 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25719 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25720 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25721
25722
25723 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25724 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25725 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25726 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25727 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25728 remembered for later use.
25729 How it is used is described in the following section.
25730
25731
25732
25733
25734
25735 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25736 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25737 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25738 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25739 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25740 message:
25741
25742 .ilist
25743 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25744 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25745 .next
25746 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25747 .next
25748 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25749 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25750 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25751 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25752 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25753 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25754 given for the MAIL command.
25755 .next
25756 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25757 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25758 authenticated.
25759 .next
25760 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25761 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25762 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25763 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25764 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25765 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25766 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25767 message.
25768 .endlist
25769
25770
25771 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25772 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25773 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25774 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25775
25776 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25777 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25778 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25779 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25780 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25781 ACL is run.
25782
25783
25784
25785 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25786 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25787 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25788 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25789 conditions:
25790
25791 .ilist
25792 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25793 .next
25794 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25795 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25796 .endlist
25797
25798 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25799 the mechanisms are advertised.
25800
25801 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25802 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25803 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25804 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25805 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25806 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25807 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25808 .code
25809 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25810 .endd
25811 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25812
25813 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25814 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25815 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25816 such as:
25817 .code
25818 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25819 .endd
25820 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25821 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25822 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25823
25824 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25825 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25826 command. This is the case if
25827
25828 .ilist
25829 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25830 .next
25831 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25832 .next
25833 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25834 server authenticators.
25835 .endlist
25836
25837
25838 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25839 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25840 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25841
25842 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25843 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25844 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25845 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25846 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25847 rejected with a 504 error.
25848
25849 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25850 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25851 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25852 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25853 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25854 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25855 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25856 no successful authentication.
25857
25858
25859
25860
25861 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25862 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25863 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25864 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25865 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25866 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25867 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25868 script:
25869 .code
25870 use MIME::Base64;
25871 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25872 .endd
25873 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25874 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25875 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25876 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25877 command line to run this script on such data might be
25878 .code
25879 encode '\0user\0password'
25880 .endd
25881 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25882 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25883 whose code value is zero.
25884
25885 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25886 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25887 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25888 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25889
25890 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25891 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25892 example, a command such as
25893 .code
25894 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25895 .endd
25896 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25897
25898 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25899 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25900 .code
25901 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25902 .endd
25903 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25904 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25905 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25906 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25907
25908
25909
25910 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25911 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25912 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25913 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25914 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25915 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25916
25917 .ilist
25918 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25919 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25920 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25921 of the authenticator.
25922 .next
25923 .vindex "&$host$&"
25924 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25925 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25926 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25927 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25928 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25929 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25930 delivery to be deferred.
25931 .next
25932 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25933 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25934 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25935 usual way.
25936 .next
25937 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25938 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25939 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25940 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25941 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25942 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25943 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25944 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25945 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25946 .endlist
25947
25948 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
25949 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
25950 on and the transport running. For example, with a manualroute
25951 router given a host name, and DNS "round-robin" use by that name: if
25952 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
25953 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
25954 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
25955 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
25956
25957 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
25958
25959 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25960 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25961 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25962 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25963 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25964 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25965 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25966 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25967 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25968 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25969 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25970 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25971 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25972
25973
25974
25975
25976
25977
25978 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25979 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25980
25981 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25982 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25983 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25984 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25985 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25986 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25987 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25988 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25989 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25990 connections as you do for login accounts.
25991
25992 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25993 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25994 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25995
25996 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25997 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25998 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25999
26000 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26001 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26002 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26003 given.
26004
26005 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26006 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26007 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26008 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26009 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26010 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26011 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26012
26013 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26014 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26015 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26016 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26017 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26018 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26019 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26020
26021 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26022 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26023 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26024 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26025
26026 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26027 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26028 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26029
26030 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26031 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26032 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26033 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26034 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26035 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26036 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26037 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26038 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26039 string as the error text
26040
26041 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26042 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26043 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26044
26045
26046
26047 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26048 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26049 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26050 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26051 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26052 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26053 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26054 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26055
26056 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26057 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26058 configured as follows:
26059 .code
26060 fixed_plain:
26061 driver = plaintext
26062 public_name = PLAIN
26063 server_prompts = :
26064 server_condition = \
26065 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26066 server_set_id = $auth2
26067 .endd
26068 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26069 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26070 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26071 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26072
26073 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26074 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26075 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26076 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26077 .code
26078 250-AUTH PLAIN
26079 .endd
26080 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26081 .code
26082 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26083 .endd
26084 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26085 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26086 .code
26087 AUTH PLAIN
26088 .endd
26089 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26090 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26091
26092 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26093 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26094 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26095 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26096 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26097
26098 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26099 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26100 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26101
26102 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26103 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26104 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26105 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26106 This is an incorrect example:
26107 .code
26108 server_condition = \
26109 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26110 .endd
26111 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26112 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26113 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26114 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26115 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26116 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26117 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26118 .code
26119 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26120 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26121 .endd
26122 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26123 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26124 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26125 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26126 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26127
26128
26129 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26130 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26131 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26132 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26133 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26134 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26135 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26136 .code
26137 fixed_login:
26138 driver = plaintext
26139 public_name = LOGIN
26140 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26141 server_condition = \
26142 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26143 server_set_id = $auth1
26144 .endd
26145 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26146 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26147 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26148 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26149
26150 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26151 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26152 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26153 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26154 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26155 .code
26156 login:
26157 driver = plaintext
26158 public_name = LOGIN
26159 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26160 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26161 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26162 ldapauth{\
26163 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26164 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26165 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26166 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26167 .endd
26168 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26169 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26170 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26171 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26172 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26173 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26174 uninterpreted string.
26175
26176
26177 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26178 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26179 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26180 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26181 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26182 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26183
26184
26185
26186
26187 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26188 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26189 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26190
26191 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26192 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26193 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26194 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26195 usual.
26196
26197 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26198 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26199 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26200 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26201 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26202 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26203 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26204 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26205 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26206 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26207 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26208 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26209
26210 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26211 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26212
26213 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26214 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26215 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26216 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26217 the string.
26218
26219 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26220 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26221 .code
26222 fixed_plain:
26223 driver = plaintext
26224 public_name = PLAIN
26225 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26226 .endd
26227 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26228 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26229 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26230 .code
26231 fixed_login:
26232 driver = plaintext
26233 public_name = LOGIN
26234 client_send = : username : mysecret
26235 .endd
26236 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26237 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26238 prompts.
26239 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26240 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26241
26242
26243
26244
26245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26247
26248 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26249 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26250 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26251 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26252 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26253 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26254 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26255 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26256 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26257 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26258 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26259 available in plain text at either end.
26260
26261
26262 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26263 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26264 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26265 authenticator as a server:
26266
26267 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26268 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26269 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26270 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26271 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26272 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26273 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26274 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26275 returned to the client.
26276
26277 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26278 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26279 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26280 numeric variables for other things.
26281
26282 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26283 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26284 user name, authentication fails.
26285 .code
26286 fixed_cram:
26287 driver = cram_md5
26288 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26289 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26290 server_set_id = $auth1
26291 .endd
26292 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26293 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26294 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26295 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26296 .code
26297 lookup_cram:
26298 driver = cram_md5
26299 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26300 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26301 {$value}fail}
26302 server_set_id = $auth1
26303 .endd
26304 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26305 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26306
26307 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26308 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26309 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26310 realm, with:
26311 .code
26312 cyrusless_crammd5:
26313 driver = cram_md5
26314 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26315 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26316 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26317 server_set_id = $auth1
26318 .endd
26319
26320 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26321 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26322 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26323
26324
26325
26326 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26327 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26328 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26329
26330
26331 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26332 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26333 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26334
26335
26336 .vindex "&$host$&"
26337 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26338 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26339 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26340 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26341 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26342 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26343 send the message to the current server.
26344
26345 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26346 strings, is:
26347 .code
26348 fixed_cram:
26349 driver = cram_md5
26350 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26351 client_name = ph10
26352 client_secret = secret
26353 .endd
26354 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26355 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26356
26357
26358
26359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26360 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26361
26362 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26363 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26364 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26365 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26366 .cindex "Kerberos"
26367 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
26368 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
26369
26370 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26371 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26372 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26373 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26374 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26375
26376 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26377 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26378 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26379 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26380
26381 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26382 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26383 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26384 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26385 depending on the driver you are using.
26386
26387 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26388 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26389 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26390 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26391 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26392 implementation.
26393
26394 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26395 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26396 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26397 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26398 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26399 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26400 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26401 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26402
26403
26404 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26405 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26406 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26407 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26408 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26409 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26410 things.
26411
26412
26413 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26414 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26415 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26416 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26417
26418
26419 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26420 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26421 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26422 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26423 example:
26424 .code
26425 sasl:
26426 driver = cyrus_sasl
26427 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26428 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26429 server_set_id = $auth1
26430 .endd
26431
26432 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26433 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26434
26435
26436 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26437 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26438
26439
26440 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26441 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26442 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26443 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26444 .code
26445 sasl_cram_md5:
26446 driver = cyrus_sasl
26447 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26448 server_set_id = $auth1
26449
26450 sasl_plain:
26451 driver = cyrus_sasl
26452 public_name = PLAIN
26453 server_set_id = $auth2
26454 .endd
26455 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26456 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26457 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26458 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26459 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26460
26461
26462
26463
26464 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26465 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26466 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26467 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26468 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26469 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26470 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26471 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26472 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26473 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26474 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26475
26476 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26477
26478 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26479 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26480 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26481 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26482 .code
26483 dovecot_plain:
26484 driver = dovecot
26485 public_name = PLAIN
26486 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26487 server_set_id = $auth1
26488
26489 dovecot_ntlm:
26490 driver = dovecot
26491 public_name = NTLM
26492 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26493 server_set_id = $auth1
26494 .endd
26495 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26496 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26497 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26498 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26499 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26500 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26501 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26502 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26503
26504
26505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26507 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26508 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26509 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26510 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26511 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26512 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26513 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26514 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26515 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26516 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26517 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26518 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26519 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26520 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26521 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26522 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26523 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26524 without code changes in Exim.
26525
26526
26527 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26528 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26529 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26530 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26531 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26532 context.
26533
26534 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26535 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26536 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26537
26538 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26539 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26540 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26541
26542 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26543 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26544 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26545
26546
26547 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26548 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26549 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26550 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26551
26552
26553 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26554 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26555 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26556 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26557 example:
26558 .code
26559 sasl:
26560 driver = gsasl
26561 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26562 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26563 server_set_id = $auth1
26564 .endd
26565
26566
26567 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26568 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26569 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26570 the password itself.
26571
26572 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26573 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26574 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26575 if available, else the empty string.
26576 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26577 else the empty string.
26578
26579 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26580
26581 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26582 option to be simply "true".
26583
26584
26585 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26586 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26587 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26588
26589
26590 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26591 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26592 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26593 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26594
26595
26596 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26597 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26598 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26599 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26600
26601
26602 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26603 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26604 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26605
26606
26607 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26608 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26609 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26610 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26611
26612 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26613 meanings for these variables:
26614
26615 .ilist
26616 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26617 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26618 .next
26619 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26620 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26621 .next
26622 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26623 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26624 .endlist
26625
26626 On a per-mechanism basis:
26627
26628 .ilist
26629 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26630 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26631 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26632 .next
26633 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26634 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26635 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26636 .next
26637 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26638 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26639 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26640 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26641 .endlist
26642
26643 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26644 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26645 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26646
26647
26648 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26649 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26650 .code
26651 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26652 driver = gsasl
26653 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26654 server_realm = imap.example.org
26655 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26656 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26657 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26658 server_condition = yes
26659 .endd
26660
26661
26662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26664
26665 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26666 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26667 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26668 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26669 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26670 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26671 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26672 reliably.
26673
26674 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26675 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26676 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26677 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26678
26679 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26680 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26681 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26682 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26683
26684 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26685 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26686 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26687 from the keytab.
26688
26689
26690 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26691 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26692 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26693 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26694
26695 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26696 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26697 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26698 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26699
26700 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26701 .ilist
26702 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26703 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26704 .next
26705 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26706 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26707 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26708 GSS Display Name.
26709 .endlist
26710
26711
26712 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26714
26715 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26716 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26717 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26718 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26719 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26720 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26721 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26722 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26723 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26724 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26725 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26726 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26727 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26728 follows:
26729
26730 .ilist
26731 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26732 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26733 .next
26734 The server sends back a challenge.
26735 .next
26736 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26737 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26738 .endlist
26739
26740 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26741
26742
26743
26744 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26745 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26746 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26747
26748 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26749 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26750 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26751 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26752 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26753 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26754 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26755 for other things. For example:
26756 .code
26757 spa:
26758 driver = spa
26759 public_name = NTLM
26760 server_password = \
26761 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26762 .endd
26763 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26764 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26765
26766
26767
26768
26769
26770 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26771 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26772 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26773
26774
26775
26776 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26777 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26778
26779
26780 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26781 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26782
26783
26784 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26785 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26786 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26787 &'msn.com'&:
26788 .code
26789 msn:
26790 driver = spa
26791 public_name = MSN
26792 client_username = msn/msn_username
26793 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26794 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26795 .endd
26796 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26797 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26798
26799
26800
26801
26802
26803 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26804 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26805
26806 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26807 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26808 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26809 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26810 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26811 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26812 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26813 authentication based on client certificates.
26814
26815 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26816 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26817 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26818 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26819 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26820 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26821
26822 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26823 for which it must have been requested via the
26824 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26825 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26826
26827 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26828 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26829 and can authenticate the connection.
26830 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26831
26832 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26833
26834
26835 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26836 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26837
26838 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26839 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26840 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26841 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26842 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26843 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26844
26845 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26846 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26847 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26848
26849 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26850
26851
26852 Example:
26853 .code
26854 tls:
26855 driver = tls
26856 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26857 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26858 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26859 {!= {0} \
26860 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26861 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26862 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26863 } } } }
26864 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26865 .endd
26866 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
26867 of your configured trust-anchors
26868 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
26869 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
26870 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
26871 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
26872
26873 . An alternative might use
26874 . .code
26875 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
26876 . .endd
26877 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
26878 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
26879 . This would help for per-device use.
26880 .
26881 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
26882 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
26883
26884 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26885 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26886
26887
26888 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26889 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26890 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26891
26892
26893
26894 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26896
26897 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26898 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26899 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26900 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26901 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26902 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26903 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26904 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26905 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26906 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26907 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26908 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26909 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26910 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26911 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26912 certificates are used.
26913
26914 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26915 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26916 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26917 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26918 between them is encrypted.
26919
26920 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26921 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26922 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26923 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26924 encryption state.
26925
26926 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26927 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26928 in order to get TLS to work.
26929
26930
26931
26932 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26933 "SECID284"
26934 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26935 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26936 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26937 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26938 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26939 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26940 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26941 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26942 allocated for this purpose.
26943
26944 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26945 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26946 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26947 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26948 .code
26949 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26950 .endd
26951 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26952 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26953 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26954 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26955 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26956 defined elsewhere.
26957
26958 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26959 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26960
26961
26962
26963
26964
26965
26966 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26967 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26968 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26969 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26970 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26971 .code
26972 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26973 .endd
26974 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26975 .code
26976 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26977 .endd
26978 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26979 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26980
26981 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26982
26983 .ilist
26984 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26985 cannot be the path of a directory
26986 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26987 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26988 .next
26989 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26990 .next
26991 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26992 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26993 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26994 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26995 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26996 .next
26997 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26998 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26999 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27000 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27001 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27002 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27003 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27004 option).
27005 .next
27006 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27007 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27008 .next
27009 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27010 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27011 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27012 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27013 .next
27014 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27015 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27016 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27017 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27018 .endlist
27019
27020
27021 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27022 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27023 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27024 but not the chosen filename.
27025 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27026 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27027
27028 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27029 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27030 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27031 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27032 of bits requested.
27033 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27034 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27035 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27036 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27037 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27038 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27039 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27040
27041 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27042 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27043 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27044 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27045 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27046
27047 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27048 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27049 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27050 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27051 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27052 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27053
27054 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27055 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27056 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27057
27058 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27059 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27060 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27061 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27062 .code
27063 # ls
27064 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27065 # rm -f new-params
27066 # touch new-params
27067 # chown exim:exim new-params
27068 # chmod 0600 new-params
27069 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27070 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27071 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27072 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27073 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27074 # chmod 0400 new-params
27075 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27076 .endd
27077 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27078 stalling is removed.
27079
27080 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27081 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27082 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27083 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27084 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27085 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27086 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27087 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27088 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27089 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27090 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27091
27092 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27093 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27094 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27095 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27096
27097 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27098 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27099 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27100 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27101 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27102
27103
27104 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27105 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27106 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27107 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27108 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27109 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27110 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27111 directly to this function call.
27112 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27113 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27114 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27115 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27116
27117 .ilist
27118 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27119 .next
27120 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27121 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27122 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27123 SSL v3 algorithms.
27124 .next
27125 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27126 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27127 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27128 algorithms.
27129 .endlist
27130
27131 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27132 &`-`& or &`+`&.
27133 .ilist
27134 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27135 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27136 stated.
27137 .next
27138 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27139 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27140 .next
27141 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27142 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27143 .endlist
27144
27145 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27146 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27147 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27148 not be moved to the end of the list.
27149 .endlist
27150
27151 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27152 string:
27153 .code
27154 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27155 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27156 .endd
27157
27158 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27159 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27160 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27161 choice of clients used:
27162 .code
27163 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27164 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27165 {DEFAULT}\
27166 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27167 .endd
27168
27169
27170
27171 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27172 "SECTreqciphgnu"
27173 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27174 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27175 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27176 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27177 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27178 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27179 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27180 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27181 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27182 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27183
27184 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27185 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27186
27187 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27188 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27189 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27190 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27191 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27192 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27193
27194 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27195 "Priority strings". This is online as
27196 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27197 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27198 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27199 then the example code
27200 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27201 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27202
27203 For example:
27204 .code
27205 # Disable older versions of protocols
27206 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27207 .endd
27208
27209 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27210 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27211 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27212
27213 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27214 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27215 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27216 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27217 used:
27218 .code
27219 # GnuTLS variant
27220 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27221 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
27222 {SECURE128}}
27223 .endd
27224
27225
27226 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27227 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27228 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27229 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27230 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27231 that STARTTLS is alway advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27232 this is reasonble for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27233
27234 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27235 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27236
27237 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27238 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27239 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27240 with the error
27241 .code
27242 554 Security failure
27243 .endd
27244 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27245 rejected with a 554 error code.
27246
27247 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27248 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27249
27250 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27251 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27252 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27253 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27254
27255 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27256
27257 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
27258 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
27259 .code
27260 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27261 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27262 .endd
27263 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27264 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27265 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27266 that goes with it. These files need to be
27267 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27268 always be given as full path names.
27269 The key must not be password-protected.
27270 They can be the same file if both the
27271 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27272 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27273 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27274 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27275 the server's certificate.
27276
27277 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27278 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27279 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27280
27281 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27282 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27283 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27284 transport.
27285
27286 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27287 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27288 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27289 .code
27290 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27291 .endd
27292 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27293 with the parameters contained in the file.
27294 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27295 available:
27296 .code
27297 tls_dhparam = none
27298 .endd
27299 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27300 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27301 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27302 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27303
27304 See the command
27305 .code
27306 openssl dhparam
27307 .endd
27308 for a way of generating file data.
27309
27310 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27311 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27312 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27313 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27314 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27315
27316 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27317 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27318 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27319 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27320 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27321 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27322 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27323 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27324 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27325
27326 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27327 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27328 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27329 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27330 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27331 documentation for more details.
27332
27333 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27334 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27335
27336
27337 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27338 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27339 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27340 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27341 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27342 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27343 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27344 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27345 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27346 expected certificates.
27347 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27348 an explicit file or,
27349 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27350 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27351
27352 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27353 directory is used
27354 (OpenSSL only),
27355 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27356 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27357 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27358 .code
27359 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27360 .endd
27361 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27362
27363 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27364 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27365 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27366 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27367 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27368 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27369 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27370 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27371 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27372 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27373
27374 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27375 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27376 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27377 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27378
27379 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27380 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27381 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27382 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27383 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27384 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27385
27386
27387 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27388 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27389 .cindex "revocation list"
27390 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27391 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27392 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27393 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27394 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27395 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27396 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27397 CRL in PEM format.
27398 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27399 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27400
27401 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27402 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27403 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27404 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27405 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27406 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27407
27408 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27409 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27410 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27411 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27412
27413 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27414 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27415 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27416 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27417 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27418 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27419 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27420 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27421
27422 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27423 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27424 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27425
27426 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27427 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27428 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27429 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27430 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27431
27432 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27433 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27434 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27435 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27436 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27437 next connection.
27438
27439 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27440 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27441 ignored.
27442
27443 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27444 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27445 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27446 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27447 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27448 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27449
27450 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27451 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27452
27453 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27454
27455 .code
27456 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27457 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27458 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27459
27460 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27461 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27462 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27463 .endd
27464
27465
27466
27467
27468 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27469 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27470 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27471 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27472 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27473 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27474 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27475 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27476 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27477
27478 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27479 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27480 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27481 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27482 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27483
27484 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27485 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27486 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27487 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27488 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27489 usual way.
27490
27491 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27492 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27493 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27494 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27495 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27496 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27497 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27498 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27499 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27500 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27501 unencrypted.
27502
27503 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27504 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27505 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27506 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27507
27508 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27509 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27510 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27511 a file or,
27512 depending on library version, a directory,
27513 must name a file or,
27514 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
27515 The client verifies the server's certificate
27516 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27517 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27518 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27519 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27520
27521 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27522 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27523 or need not succeed respectively.
27524
27525 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27526 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27527 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27528 value is empty.
27529 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27530 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27531 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27532 otherwise.
27533
27534 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27535 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27536 for OCSP to be relevant.
27537
27538 If
27539 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27540 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27541 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27542 alternative hosts, if any.
27543
27544 &*Note*&:
27545 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27546 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27547 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27548 client.
27549
27550 .vindex "&$host$&"
27551 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27552 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27553 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27554 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27555 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27556
27557 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27558 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27559 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27560 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27561 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27562 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27563 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27564 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27565 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27566 outgoing connection.
27567
27568
27569
27570 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27571 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27572 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27573 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27574 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27575 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27576 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27577 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27578 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27579 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27580 for this session.
27581
27582 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27583 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27584 address.
27585
27586 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27587 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27588 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27589 be of limited use in that environment.
27590
27591 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27592 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27593 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27594 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27595 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27596
27597 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27598 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27599 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27600 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27601 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27602
27603 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27604 received from a client.
27605 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27606
27607 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27608 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27609 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27610
27611 .ilist
27612 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27613 &%tls_certificate%&
27614 .next
27615 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27616 &%tls_crl%&
27617 .next
27618 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27619 &%tls_privatekey%&
27620 .next
27621 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27622 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27623 .next
27624 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27625 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27626 .endlist
27627
27628 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27629 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27630 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
27631 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27632 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
27633 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
27634 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
27635
27636 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27637 are re-expanded.
27638
27639 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27640 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27641 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27642 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27643
27644 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27645 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27646 built, then you have SNI support).
27647
27648
27649
27650 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27651 "SECTmulmessam"
27652 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27653 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27654 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27655 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27656 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27657 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27658 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27659 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27660 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27661 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27662 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27663
27664 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27665 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27666 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27667 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27668 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27669 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27670 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27671 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27672 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27673
27674 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27675 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27676 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27677 information is recorded.
27678
27679 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27680 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27681 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27682
27683
27684
27685
27686 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27687 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27688 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27689 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27690 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27691 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27692 to Apache, currently at
27693 .display
27694 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27695 .endd
27696 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27697 links to further files.
27698 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27699 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27700 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27701 .display
27702 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27703 .endd
27704
27705
27706 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27707 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27708 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27709 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27710 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27711 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27712 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27713 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27714 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27715 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27716 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27717 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27718 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27719
27720 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27721 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27722 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27723 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27724
27725
27726
27727 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27728 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27729 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27730 with OpenSSL, like this:
27731 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27732 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27733 .code
27734 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27735 -days 9999 -nodes
27736 .endd
27737 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27738 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27739 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27740 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27741 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27742 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27743 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27744
27745 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27746 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27747 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27748 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27749 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27750 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27751 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27752 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27753 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27754 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27755 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27756 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27757 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27758 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27759 be a sensible resolution).
27760
27761 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27762 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27763 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27764
27765 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27766 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27767 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27768 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27769 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27770 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27771
27772 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27773 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27774 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27775 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27776 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27777 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27778
27779
27780
27781 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27782 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27783
27784 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27785 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27786 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27787 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27788 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27789 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27790 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27791 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27792 one very small ACL:
27793 .code
27794 begin acl
27795 small_acl:
27796 accept hosts = one.host.only
27797 .endd
27798 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27799 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27800
27801 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27802 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27803 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27804 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27805 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27806 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27807 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27808 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27809
27810
27811 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27812 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27813 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27814
27815
27816 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27817 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27818 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27819 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27820 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27821 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27822 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27823 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27824 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27825 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27826 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27827 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27828 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27829 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27830 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27831 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27832 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27833 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27834 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27835 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27836
27837 .table2 140pt
27838 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27839 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27840 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27841 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27842 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27843 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27844 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27845 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27846 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27847 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27848 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27849 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27850 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27851 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27852 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27853 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27854 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27855 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27856 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27857 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27858 .endtable
27859
27860 For example, if you set
27861 .code
27862 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27863 .endd
27864 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27865 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27866 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27867 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27868 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27869 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27870 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27871
27872
27873 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27874 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27875 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27876 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27877 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27878 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27879 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27880 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27881 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27882 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27883 in any of these ACLs.
27884
27885 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27886 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27887 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27888 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27889 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27890 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27891 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27892 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27893 .code
27894 control = suppress_local_fixups
27895 .endd
27896 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27897 run, it is too late.
27898
27899 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27900 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27901
27902 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27903 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27904 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27905
27906
27907 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27908 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27909 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27910 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27911 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27912 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27913 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27914 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27915 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27916
27917
27918 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27919 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27920 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27921 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27922 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27923 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27924 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27925 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27926 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27927
27928 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
27929 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
27930 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
27931
27932 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27933 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27934 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27935 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27936 an EHLO response.
27937
27938
27939 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27940 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27941 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27942 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27943 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27944 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27945 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27946 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27947 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27948 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27949
27950 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27951 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27952 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27953 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27954 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27955 associated with the DATA command.
27956
27957 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
27958 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
27959 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
27960 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
27961 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
27962 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
27963 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
27964 the data specified is received.
27965
27966 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27967 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27968 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27969 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27970 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27971 your resources.
27972
27973 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27974 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27975 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27976 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27977
27978 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27979 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27980 enabled (which is the default).
27981
27982 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27983 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27984 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27985
27986 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27987
27988 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27989
27990
27991 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27992 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27993 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27994
27995 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27996
27997
27998 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27999 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28000 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28001 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28002 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28003 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28004 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28005 has been accepted.
28006
28007 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28008 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28009 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28010 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28011 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28012 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28013 for some or all recipients.
28014
28015 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28016 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28017 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28018 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28019 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28020 is &"yes"&.
28021 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28022 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28023 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28024
28025 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28026 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28027
28028 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28029 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28030 the feature was not requested by the client.
28031
28032 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28033 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28034 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28035 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28036 does not in fact control any access.
28037 For this reason, it may only accept
28038 or warn as its final result.
28039
28040 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28041 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28042 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28043 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28044
28045 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28046 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28047
28048 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28049 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28050 response to QUIT.
28051
28052 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28053 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28054 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28055 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28056 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28057
28058
28059 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28060 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28061 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28062 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28063 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28064 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28065 situation even worse.
28066
28067 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28068 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28069 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28070 and &%warn%&.
28071
28072 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28073 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28074 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28075 connection. The possible values are:
28076 .table2
28077 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28078 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28079 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28080 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28081 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28082 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28083 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28084 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28085 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28086 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28087 .endtable
28088 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28089 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28090 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28091 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28092 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28093 used.
28094
28095
28096 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28097 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28098 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28099 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28100 .code
28101 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28102 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28103 .endd
28104 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28105 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
28106 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28107 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28108 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28109
28110 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28111 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28112 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28113
28114 .ilist
28115 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28116 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28117 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28118 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28119 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28120 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28121 .code
28122 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28123 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28124 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28125 .endd
28126 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28127 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28128 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28129 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28130 .next
28131 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28132 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28133 matches the string.
28134 .next
28135 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28136 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28137 want to have something like
28138 .code
28139 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28140 .endd
28141 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28142 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28143 .endlist
28144
28145
28146
28147
28148 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28149 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28150 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28151 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28152 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28153 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28154 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28155 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28156 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28157
28158 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28159 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28160 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28161
28162
28163 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28164 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28165 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28166 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28167
28168 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28169 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28170 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28171 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28172 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28173 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28174 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28175
28176 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28177 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28178
28179
28180 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28181 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28182 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28183
28184
28185
28186 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28187 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28188 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28189 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28190 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28191 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28192
28193 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28194 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28195 used to accept or reject anything.
28196
28197 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28198 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28199 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28200 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28201
28202 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28203 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28204 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28205 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28206 configuration file.
28207
28208
28209
28210
28211 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28212 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28213 .vindex &$domain$&
28214 .vindex &$local_part$&
28215 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28216 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28217 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28218 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28219 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28220 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28221 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28222 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28223 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28224
28225 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28226 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28227 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28228 how it is used.
28229
28230 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28231 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28232 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28233 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28234 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28235 received).
28236
28237 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28238 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28239 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28240 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28241 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28242 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28243 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28244 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28245
28246
28247
28248
28249
28250 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28251 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28252 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28253 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28254 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28255 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28256 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28257 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28258 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28259 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28260 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28261 unencrypted connections.
28262 .code
28263 acl_check_auth:
28264 accept encrypted = *
28265 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28266 {CRAM-MD5}}
28267 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28268 .endd
28269 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28270 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28271 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28272 option to do this.)
28273
28274
28275
28276 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28277 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28278 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28279 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28280 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28281 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28282 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28283
28284 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28285 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28286 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28287 example:
28288 .code
28289 deny dnslists = list1.example
28290 dnslists = list2.example
28291 .endd
28292 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28293 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28294 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28295 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28296 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28297
28298
28299 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28300 The ACL verbs are as follows:
28301
28302 .ilist
28303 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28304 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28305 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28306 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28307 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28308 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28309 check a RCPT command:
28310 .code
28311 accept domains = +local_domains
28312 endpass
28313 verify = recipient
28314 .endd
28315 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28316 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28317 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28318 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28319 &%endpass%&.
28320
28321 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28322 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28323 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28324 configuration.
28325
28326 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28327 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28328 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28329 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28330 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28331 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28332 .display
28333 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28334 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28335 .endd
28336 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28337 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28338 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28339
28340 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28341 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28342 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28343 of &%endpass%&.
28344
28345
28346 .next
28347 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28348 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28349 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28350 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28351 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28352 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28353 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28354
28355
28356 .next
28357 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28358 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28359 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28360 example,
28361 .code
28362 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28363 .endd
28364 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28365
28366
28367 .next
28368 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
28369 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
28370 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
28371 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
28372 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
28373 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
28374 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
28375 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
28376 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
28377
28378 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
28379 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
28380 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
28381
28382
28383 .next
28384 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28385 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28386 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28387 .code
28388 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28389 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28390 .endd
28391 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28392 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28393
28394 .next
28395 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28396 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28397 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28398 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28399 .code
28400 require message = Sender did not verify
28401 verify = sender
28402 .endd
28403 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28404 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28405 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28406 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28407
28408 .next
28409 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28410 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28411 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28412 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28413 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28414 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28415 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28416
28417 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28418 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28419 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28420 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28421 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28422
28423 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28424 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28425 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28426 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28427 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28428 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28429 onwards.
28430
28431
28432 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28433 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28434 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28435 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28436 .code
28437 warn !verify = sender
28438 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28439 .endd
28440 .endlist
28441
28442 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28443
28444 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28445 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28446 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28447 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28448 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28449
28450
28451
28452 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28453 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28454 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28455 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28456 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28457 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28458 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28459 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28460 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28461 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28462 .ilist
28463 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28464 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28465 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28466 on the same SMTP connection.
28467 .next
28468 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28469 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28470 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28471 .endlist
28472
28473 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28474 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28475 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28476 .code
28477 accept hosts = whatever
28478 set acl_m4 = some value
28479 accept authenticated = *
28480 set acl_c_auth = yes
28481 .endd
28482 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28483 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28484 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28485
28486 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28487 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28488 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28489 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28490 error is generated.
28491
28492 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28493 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28494
28495
28496 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28497 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28498 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28499 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28500 .code
28501 deny domains = *.dom.example
28502 !verify = recipient
28503 .endd
28504 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28505 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28506 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28507 two statements are equivalent:
28508 .code
28509 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28510 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28511 .endd
28512 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28513 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28514
28515 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28516 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28517 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28518 .code
28519 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28520 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28521 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28522 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28523 .endd
28524 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28525 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28526 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28527 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28528 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28529 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28530 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28531
28532 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28533 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28534 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28535 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28536 message is handled.
28537
28538 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28539 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28540 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28541 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28542 .code
28543 require message = Can't verify sender
28544 verify = sender
28545 message = Can't verify recipient
28546 verify = recipient
28547 message = This message cannot be used
28548 .endd
28549 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28550 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28551 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28552 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28553 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28554 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28555
28556 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28557 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28558 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28559 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28560 .code
28561 deny hosts = ...
28562 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28563 message = Invalid sender from client host
28564 .endd
28565 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28566 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28567
28568
28569
28570 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28571 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28572 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28573
28574 .vlist
28575 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28576 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28577 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28578 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28579
28580 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28581 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28582 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28583 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28584 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28585 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28586 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28587 write rather ugly lines like this:
28588 .display
28589 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28590 .endd
28591 Instead, all you need is
28592 .display
28593 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28594 .endd
28595
28596 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28597 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28598 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28599 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28600 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28601 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28602 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28603 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28604
28605 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28606 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28607 in several different ways. For example:
28608
28609 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28610 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28611 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28612 . ==== way.
28613
28614 .ilist
28615 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28616 .code
28617 accept ...some conditions
28618 control = queue_only
28619 .endd
28620 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28621 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28622
28623 .next
28624 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28625 .code
28626 accept ...some conditions...
28627 control = queue_only
28628 ...some more conditions...
28629 .endd
28630 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28631 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28632 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28633 to be relevant.
28634
28635 .next
28636 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28637 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28638 example:
28639 .code
28640 warn ...some conditions...
28641 control = freeze
28642 accept ...
28643 .endd
28644 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28645 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28646 log entry.
28647
28648 .next
28649 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28650 &%require%& verb. For example:
28651 .code
28652 require control = no_multiline_responses
28653 .endd
28654 .endlist
28655
28656 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28657 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28658 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28659 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28660 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28661 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28662 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28663 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28664 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28665
28666 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28667 example:
28668 .code
28669 deny ...some conditions...
28670 delay = 30s
28671 .endd
28672 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28673 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28674 .code
28675 deny delay = 30s
28676 ...some conditions...
28677 .endd
28678 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28679 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28680 .code
28681 warn ...some conditions...
28682 delay = 2m
28683 control = freeze
28684 accept ...
28685 .endd
28686
28687 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28688 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28689 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28690 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28691 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28692 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28693 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28694
28695
28696 .vitem &*endpass*&
28697 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28698 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28699 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28700 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28701 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28702 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28703 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28704
28705
28706 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28707 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28708 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28709 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28710 .code
28711 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28712 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28713 .endd
28714 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28715 example:
28716 .display
28717 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28718 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28719 .endd
28720 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28721 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28722 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28723 message.
28724
28725 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28726 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28727 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28728 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28729 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28730 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28731 ignored.
28732
28733 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28734 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28735 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28736 error message.
28737
28738 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28739 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28740 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28741 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28742 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28743 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28744
28745 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28746 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28747 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28748 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28749 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28750 logging rejections.
28751
28752
28753 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28754 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28755 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28756 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28757 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28758 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28759 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28760 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28761 .display
28762 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28763 &` log_reject_target =`&
28764 .endd
28765 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28766 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28767 current ACL.
28768
28769
28770 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28771 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28772 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28773 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28774 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28775 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28776 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28777 ACLs. For example:
28778 .display
28779 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28780 &` control = freeze`&
28781 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28782 .endd
28783 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28784 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28785 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28786 example:
28787 .code
28788 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28789 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28790 .endd
28791
28792
28793 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28794 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28795 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28796 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28797 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28798 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28799 &%accept%& for details.)
28800
28801 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28802 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28803 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28804 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28805 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28806 .code
28807 require message = Host not recognized
28808 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28809 .endd
28810 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28811 processed.)
28812
28813 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28814 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28815 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28816 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28817 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28818 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28819 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28820 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28821 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28822 EHLO options.
28823
28824 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28825 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28826 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28827 .code
28828 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28829 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28830 .endd
28831 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28832 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28833 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28834 2&'xx'&.
28835
28836 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28837 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28838
28839 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28840 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28841 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28842 response.
28843
28844 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28845 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28846 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28847
28848 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28849 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28850 However, the original message is available in the variable
28851 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28852 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28853 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28854 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28855
28856 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28857 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28858 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28859 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28860 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28861 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28862 effect.
28863
28864
28865 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28866 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
28867 for the message.
28868 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
28869 the DATA ACL).
28870 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
28871 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
28872 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
28873 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
28874
28875
28876 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28877 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28878 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28879 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28880
28881
28882 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28883 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28884 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28885 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28886
28887
28888 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28889 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28890 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28891 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28892 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28893 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28894 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28895 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28896 when:
28897 .code
28898 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28899 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28900 .endd
28901 .endlist
28902
28903
28904
28905
28906 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28907 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28908 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28909
28910 .vlist
28911 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28912 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28913 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28914 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28915 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28916 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28917 not work without it. For example:
28918 .code
28919 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28920 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28921 .endd
28922 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28923 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28924 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28925 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28926 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28927
28928
28929 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28930 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28931 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28932 .cindex "case of local parts"
28933 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28934 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28935 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28936 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28937 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28938 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28939 is encountered.
28940
28941 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28942 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28943 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28944 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28945 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28946
28947 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28948 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28949 spam score:
28950 .code
28951 warn control = caseful_local_part
28952 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28953 $acl_m4 + \
28954 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28955 }
28956 control = caselower_local_part
28957 .endd
28958 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28959 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28960
28961
28962 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
28963 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28964 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28965 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28966
28967 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28968 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28969 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28970 is used for all recipients of the message,
28971 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28972 and data is copied from one to the other.
28973
28974 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28975 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28976 If a recipient-verify callout
28977 (with use_sender)
28978 connection is subsequently
28979 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28980 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28981 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28982
28983 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28984 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28985 Note also that headers cannot be
28986 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28987 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28988
28989 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
28990 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
28991 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
28992 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
28993 message body.
28994
28995 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28996 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28997 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28998 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
28999 or CHUNKING
29000 options in use.
29001
29002 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29003 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29004 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29005 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29006 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29007
29008 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29009 usual fashion.
29010 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29011 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29012 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29013 and does not queue the message.
29014 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29015
29016 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29017 (possibly faked)
29018 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29019
29020
29021 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29022 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29023 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29024 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29025 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29026 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29027 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29028 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29029 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29030 option.
29031 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29032 with the &'kill'& option.
29033 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29034 contexts):
29035 .code
29036 control = debug
29037 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29038 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29039 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29040 control = debug/kill
29041 .endd
29042
29043
29044 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29045 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29046 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29047 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29048 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
29049
29050
29051 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29052 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29053 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29054 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29055 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29056 strings or to numeric value.
29057 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29058 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29059 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29060
29061 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29062 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29063 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29064 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29065 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29066
29067
29068 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29069 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29070 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29071 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29072 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29073 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29074 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29075 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29076
29077 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29078 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29079 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29080 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29081 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29082 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29083 work with.
29084
29085
29086 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29087 .cindex "fake defer"
29088 .cindex "defer, fake"
29089 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29090 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29091 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29092 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29093 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29094
29095 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29096 .cindex "fake rejection"
29097 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29098 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29099 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29100 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29101 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29102 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29103 the same SMTP connection.
29104
29105 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29106 message is supplied, the following is used:
29107 .code
29108 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29109 550-kept for evaluation.
29110 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29111 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29112 .endd
29113 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29114
29115 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29116 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29117 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29118 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29119 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29120 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29121 SMTP connection.
29122
29123 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29124 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29125 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29126 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29127
29128 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29129 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29130 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29131 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29132 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29133 disables such output flushing.
29134
29135 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29136 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29137 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29138 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29139 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29140 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29141
29142 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29143 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29144 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29145 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29146 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29147 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29148 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29149 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29150 to be useful in production.
29151
29152 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29153 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29154 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29155 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29156 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29157
29158 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29159 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29160 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29161 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29162 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29163 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29164
29165 .ilist
29166 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29167 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29168 verification failed"&) is sent.
29169 .next
29170 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29171 line is output.
29172 .endlist
29173
29174 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29175 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29176
29177 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29178 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29179 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29180 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29181 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29182 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29183 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29184
29185 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29186 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29187 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29188 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29189 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29190 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29191 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29192 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29193 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29194 same SMTP connection.
29195
29196 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29197 .cindex "message" "submission"
29198 .cindex "submission mode"
29199 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29200 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29201 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29202 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29203 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29204 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29205 late (the message has already been created).
29206
29207 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29208 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29209 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29210 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29211 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29212
29213 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29214 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29215 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29216 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29217 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29218
29219 .ilist
29220 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29221 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29222 .next
29223 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29224 .next
29225 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29226 .endlist ilist
29227
29228 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29229 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29230 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29231 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29232 data is read.
29233
29234 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29235 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29236
29237 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29238 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29239 to a-label form.
29240 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29241 .endlist vlist
29242
29243
29244 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29245 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29246
29247 .ilist
29248 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29249 .next
29250 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29251 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29252 .next
29253 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29254 .next
29255 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29256 .endlist
29257
29258
29259
29260 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29261 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29262 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29263 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29264 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29265 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29266 .code
29267 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29268 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29269 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29270 .endd
29271 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29272 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29273 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29274 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29275 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29276 RCPT ACL).
29277
29278 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29279 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29280
29281 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29282 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29283 contains one or more newlines that
29284 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29285 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29286 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29287
29288 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29289 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29290 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29291 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29292 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29293 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29294 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29295 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29296 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29297 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29298 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29299
29300 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29301 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29302 of message headers
29303 until they are added to the
29304 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29305 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29306 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29307 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29308 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29309 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29310 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29311
29312 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29313
29314 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29315 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29316 .display
29317 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29318 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29319
29320 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29321 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29322 .endd
29323 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29324 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29325 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29326 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29327 honoured.
29328
29329 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29330 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29331 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29332 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29333 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29334 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29335 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29336 specifications.
29337
29338 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29339 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29340 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29341 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29342 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29343
29344 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29345 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29346 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29347 to be a header name first.) For example:
29348 .code
29349 warn add_header = \
29350 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29351 .endd
29352 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29353 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29354 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29355 up in reverse order.
29356
29357 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29358 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29359 system filter or in a router or transport.
29360
29361
29362
29363 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
29364 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
29365 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
29366 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
29367 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
29368 from an incoming message, as in this example:
29369 .code
29370 warn message = Remove internal headers
29371 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29372 .endd
29373 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29374 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29375 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29376 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
29377 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
29378 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
29379
29380 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
29381 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29382
29383 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
29384 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
29385 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
29386 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
29387 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
29388 .code
29389 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
29390 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
29391 warn message = Remove internal headers
29392 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
29393 .endd
29394 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29395 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29396 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
29397 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
29398 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
29399 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
29400 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
29401 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
29402 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
29403 would have been removed.
29404
29405 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
29406 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
29407 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
29408 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
29409 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
29410 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
29411 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
29412 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
29413 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29414
29415 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29416 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29417 .display
29418 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29419 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29420
29421 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29422 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29423 .endd
29424 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29425 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29426 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29427 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29428 are honoured.
29429
29430 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29431 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29432 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29433
29434
29435
29436
29437 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29438 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29439 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29440 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29441 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29442 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29443
29444 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29445 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29446 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29447 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29448 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29449 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29450 The conditions are as follows:
29451
29452
29453 .vlist
29454 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29455 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29456 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29457 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29458 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29459 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29460 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29461 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29462 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29463 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29464 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29465 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29466
29467 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29468 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29469 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29470 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29471 The name and values are expanded separately.
29472 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29473 will act as argument separators.
29474
29475 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29476 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29477 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29478 conditions are tested.
29479
29480 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29481 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29482 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29483 for different local users or different local domains.
29484
29485 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29486 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29487 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29488 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29489 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29490 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29491 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29492 .code
29493 authenticated = *
29494 .endd
29495
29496 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29497 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29498 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29499 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29500 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29501 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29502 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29503 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29504 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29505 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29506 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29507 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29508 negative.
29509
29510 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29511 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29512 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29513 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29514 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29515 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29516 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29517 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29518
29519 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29520 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29521 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29522 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29523 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29524 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29525 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29526 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29527 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29528 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29529
29530 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29531 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29532 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29533 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29534 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29535 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29536 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29537 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29538 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29539 &%domains%& test.
29540
29541 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29542 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29543
29544
29545 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29546 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29547 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29548 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29549 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29550 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29551 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29552 .code
29553 encrypted = *
29554 .endd
29555
29556
29557 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29558 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29559 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29560 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29561 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29562 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29563 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29564 .code
29565 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29566 .endd
29567 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29568 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29569 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29570
29571 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29572 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29573 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29574 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29575 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29576 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29577
29578 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29579 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29580 .code
29581 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29582 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29583 .endd
29584 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29585 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29586 statement can then check the IP address.
29587
29588 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
29589 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29590 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29591 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29592 .code
29593 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29594 message = $host_data
29595 .endd
29596 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29597
29598 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29599 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29600 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29601 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29602 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
29603 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29604 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29605 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29606 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29607 the next &%local_parts%& test.
29608
29609 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29610 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29611 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29612 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29613 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29614 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29615 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29616
29617 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29618 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29619 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29620 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29621 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29622 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29623 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29624 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29625
29626 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29627 .cindex "rate limiting"
29628 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29629 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29630
29631 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29632 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29633 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29634 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29635 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29636 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29637
29638 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29639 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29640 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29641 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29642 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29643 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29644 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29645
29646 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29647 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29648 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29649 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29650 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29651 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29652 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29653 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29654 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29655 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29656 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29657 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29658 influence the sender checking.
29659
29660 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29661 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29662
29663 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29664 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29665 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29666 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29667 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29668 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29669 .code
29670 senders = :
29671 .endd
29672 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29673 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29674
29675 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29676 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29677 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29678 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29679 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29680 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29681
29682 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29683 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29684 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29685 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29686 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29687 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29688 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29689 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29690 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29691 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29692
29693 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29694 .cindex "CSA verification"
29695 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29696 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29697 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29698
29699 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29700 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29701 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29702 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29703 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29704 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29705 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29706 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29707 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29708 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29709
29710 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29711 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29712 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29713
29714 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29715 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29716 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29717 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29718 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29719 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29720 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29721 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29722 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29723 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29724 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29725 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29726 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29727 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29728 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29729
29730 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29731 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29732 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29733 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29734 .code
29735 deny senders = :
29736 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29737 !verify = header_sender
29738 .endd
29739
29740 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29741 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29742 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29743 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29744 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29745 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29746 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29747 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29748 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29749 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29750 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29751 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29752 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29753 appropriate.
29754
29755 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29756 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29757 .code
29758 To: @
29759 .endd
29760 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29761 common as they used to be.
29762
29763 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29764 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29765 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29766 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29767 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29768 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29769 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29770 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29771 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29772 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29773 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29774 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29775 independently of this condition.
29776
29777 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29778 option), this condition is always true.
29779
29780
29781 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29782 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29783 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29784 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29785 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29786 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29787 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29788 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29789 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29790
29791 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29792 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29793
29794
29795 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29796 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29797 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29798 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29799 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29800 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29801 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29802 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29803 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29804 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29805 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29806 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29807 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29808 value for the child address.
29809
29810 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29811 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29812 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29813 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29814 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29815 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29816 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29817 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29818 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29819 original IP address.
29820
29821 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29822 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29823
29824 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29825 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29826
29827 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29828 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29829 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29830 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29831 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29832 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29833 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29834 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29835 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29836
29837 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29838 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29839 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29840 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29841 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29842 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29843 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29844
29845 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29846 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29847 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29848
29849 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29850 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29851 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29852 verified as a sender.
29853
29854 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
29855 (eg. is generated from the received message)
29856 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
29857 .code
29858 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
29859 .endd
29860 .endlist
29861
29862
29863
29864 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29865 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29866 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29867 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29868 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29869 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29870 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29871 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29872 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29873 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29874 .code
29875 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29876 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29877 .endd
29878 the following records are looked up:
29879 .code
29880 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29881 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29882 .endd
29883 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29884 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29885 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29886 use two separate conditions:
29887 .code
29888 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29889 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29890 .endd
29891 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29892 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29893 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29894 processed.
29895
29896 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29897 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29898 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29899 following special items in the list:
29900 .display
29901 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29902 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29903 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29904 .endd
29905 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29906 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29907 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29908 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29909 .code
29910 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29911 .endd
29912 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29913 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29914 .code
29915 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29916 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29917 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29918 .endd
29919 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
29920 .cindex DNS TTL
29921 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29922 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29923 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29924 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29925 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29926 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29927
29928
29929
29930 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29931 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29932 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29933 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29934 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29935 .code
29936 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29937 .endd
29938 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29939 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29940 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29941 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29942
29943
29944
29945
29946 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29947 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29948 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29949 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29950 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29951 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29952 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29953 .code
29954 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29955 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29956 .endd
29957 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29958 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29959 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29960 up by this example is
29961 .code
29962 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29963 .endd
29964 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29965 addresses. For example:
29966 .code
29967 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29968 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29969 .endd
29970 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29971 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29972
29973
29974
29975
29976 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29977 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29978 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29979 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29980 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29981 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29982 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29983 either to double the separators like this:
29984 .code
29985 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29986 .endd
29987 or to change the separator character, like this:
29988 .code
29989 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29990 .endd
29991 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29992 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29993 occurs. Consider this condition:
29994 .code
29995 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29996 .endd
29997 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29998 .code
29999 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30000 a.domain.black.list.tld
30001 .endd
30002 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30003 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30004 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30005 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30006 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30007 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30008 error for a previous item.
30009
30010 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30011 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30012 .code
30013 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30014 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30015 .endd
30016 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30017 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30018 .code
30019 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30020 $sender_address_domain \
30021 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30022 see $dnslist_text.
30023 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30024 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30025 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30026 .endd
30027 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30028 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30029 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30030 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30031 .code
30032 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30033 .endd
30034 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30035 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30036
30037 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30038 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30039
30040
30041
30042
30043 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30044 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30045 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30046 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30047 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30048 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30049 .display
30050 127.1.0.1 RBL
30051 127.1.0.2 DUL
30052 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30053 127.1.0.4 RSS
30054 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30055 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30056 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30057 .endd
30058 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30059 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30060 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30061
30062
30063 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30064 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30065 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30066 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30067 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30068 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30069 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30070 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30071 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30072 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30073 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30074 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30075 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30076 cases, for example:
30077 .code
30078 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30079 .endd
30080 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30081 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30082 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30083 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30084 .code
30085 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30086 .endd
30087 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30088 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30089
30090 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30091 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30092 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30093 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30094 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30095 information.
30096
30097 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30098 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30099 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30100 .code
30101 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30102 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30103 at $dnslist_domain
30104 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30105 .endd
30106
30107
30108
30109 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30110 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30111 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30112 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30113 For example,
30114 .code
30115 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30116 .endd
30117 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30118 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30119 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30120 describes how multiple records are handled.
30121
30122 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30123 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30124 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30125 .code
30126 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30127 .endd
30128 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30129 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30130 first. For example:
30131 .code
30132 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30133 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30134 .endd
30135
30136 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30137 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30138 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30139 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30140 tested. For example:
30141 .code
30142 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30143 .endd
30144 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30145 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30146 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30147 .code
30148 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30149 .endd
30150 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30151 an odd number.
30152
30153
30154
30155 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30156 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30157 condition. Whereas
30158 .code
30159 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30160 .endd
30161 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30162 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30163 .code
30164 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30165 .endd
30166 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30167 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30168 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30169 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30170
30171 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30172 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30173
30174 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30175 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30176 .code
30177 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30178 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30179 .endd
30180 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30181 Consider this example:
30182 .code
30183 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30184 list.dsbl.org : \
30185 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30186 relays.ordb.org
30187 .endd
30188 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30189 .code
30190 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30191 list.dsbl.org
30192 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30193 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30194 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30195 .endd
30196 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30197
30198
30199
30200
30201 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30202 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30203 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30204 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30205 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30206 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30207 .code
30208 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30209 .endd
30210 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30211 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30212 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30213 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30214 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30215 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30216
30217 .ilist
30218 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30219 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30220 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30221 .next
30222 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30223 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30224 changed to:
30225 .code
30226 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30227 .endd
30228 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30229 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30230 .code
30231 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30232 .endd
30233 for the condition to be true.
30234 .endlist
30235
30236 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30237 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30238 .ilist
30239 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30240 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30241 .code
30242 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30243 .endd
30244 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30245 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30246 .next
30247 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30248 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30249 .code
30250 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30251 .endd
30252 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30253 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30254 .code
30255 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30256 .endd
30257 for the condition to be false.
30258 .endlist
30259 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30260 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30261
30262
30263
30264
30265 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30266 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30267 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30268 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30269 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30270 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30271 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30272 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30273 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30274 lists.
30275
30276 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30277 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30278 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30279 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30280 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30281 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30282 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30283 .code
30284 reject message = \
30285 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30286 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30287 dnslists = \
30288 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30289 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30290 .endd
30291 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30292 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30293 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30294 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30295 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30296 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30297
30298 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30299 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30300 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30301 .code
30302 reject dnslists = \
30303 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30304 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30305 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30306 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30307 .endd
30308 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30309 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30310 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30311
30312
30313
30314 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30315 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30316 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30317 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30318 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
30319 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30320 .code
30321 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30322 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30323 .endd
30324 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30325 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30326 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30327 .code
30328 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30329 .endd
30330 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30331 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30332
30333 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30334 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30335 .code
30336 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30337 dnslists = some.list.example
30338 .endd
30339
30340 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30341 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30342 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30343 .code
30344 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30345 .endd
30346
30347 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30348 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30349 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30350 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30351 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30352 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30353 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30354 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30355 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
30356 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
30357 .display
30358 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
30359 .endd
30360 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
30361 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
30362
30363 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
30364 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
30365 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
30366 of &'p'&.
30367
30368 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
30369 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
30370 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
30371 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
30372 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
30373 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
30374 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
30375 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
30376 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
30377
30378 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
30379 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
30380 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
30381 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
30382
30383 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
30384 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
30385 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
30386 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
30387 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
30388 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
30389 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
30390 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
30391 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
30392 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
30393
30394 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
30395 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
30396 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
30397 ACL.
30398
30399 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
30400 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
30401 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
30402 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
30403 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
30404 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
30405
30406 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
30407 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
30408 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
30409 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
30410 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
30411 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
30412 the &%count=%& option.
30413
30414
30415 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30416 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30417 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30418 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30419 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30420
30421 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30422 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30423 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30424 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30425
30426 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30427 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30428 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30429 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30430 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30431 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30432 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30433
30434 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30435 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30436 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30437 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30438 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30439 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30440 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30441
30442 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30443 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30444 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30445 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30446 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30447
30448 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30449 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30450 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30451 multiple different commands.
30452
30453 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30454 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30455 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30456 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30457 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30458
30459 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30460
30461
30462 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30463 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30464 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30465 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30466 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30467
30468 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30469 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30470
30471 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30472 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30473 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30474 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30475 new rate.
30476 .code
30477 acl_check_connect:
30478 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30479 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30480 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30481 # ...
30482 acl_check_mail:
30483 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30484 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30485 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30486 .endd
30487
30488 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30489 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30490 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30491 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30492 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30493 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30494 checks.
30495
30496 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30497 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30498 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30499 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30500 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30501
30502
30503 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30504 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30505 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30506 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30507 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30508 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30509 rest of the ACL.
30510
30511 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30512 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30513 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30514 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30515 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30516 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30517 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30518 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30519 from getting any email through.
30520
30521 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30522 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30523 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30524 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30525 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30526 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30527 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30528 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30529 .code
30530 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30531 .endd
30532
30533
30534 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30535 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30536 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30537 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30538 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30539 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30540 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30541 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30542 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30543
30544 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30545 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30546 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30547 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30548 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30549 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30550
30551 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30552 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30553 rate.
30554
30555 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30556 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30557 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30558 required increases with larger limits.
30559
30560 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30561 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30562 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30563 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30564 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30565 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30566 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30567 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30568 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30569 as intended.
30570
30571
30572 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30573 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30574 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30575 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30576 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30577 message. For example:
30578 .code
30579 # Log all senders' rates
30580 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30581 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30582
30583 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30584 # at the decimal point.
30585 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30586 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30587 $sender_rate_limit }s
30588
30589 # Keep authenticated users under control
30590 deny authenticated = *
30591 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30592
30593 # System-wide rate limit
30594 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30595 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30596
30597 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30598 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30599 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30600 messages per $sender_rate_period
30601 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30602 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
30603 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
30604 .endd
30605 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
30606 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
30607 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
30608 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
30609 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
30610 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30611 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30612
30613
30614
30615 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30616 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30617 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30618 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30619 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30620 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30621 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30622 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30623 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30624 .code
30625 verify = sender/callout
30626 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30627 .endd
30628 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30629 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30630 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30631 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30632 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30633 The available options are as follows:
30634
30635 .ilist
30636 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30637 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30638 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30639 .next
30640 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30641 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30642 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30643 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30644 .next
30645 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30646 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30647 .next
30648 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30649 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30650 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30651 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30652 .endlist
30653
30654 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30655 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30656 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30657 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30658 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30659 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30660 coding like this:
30661 .code
30662 warn !verify = sender
30663 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30664 .endd
30665 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30666 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30667 verification failure.
30668
30669 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30670 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30671
30672 .ilist
30673 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30674 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30675 .next
30676 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30677 .next
30678 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30679 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30680 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30681 .next
30682 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30683 .next
30684 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30685 .endlist
30686
30687 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30688 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30689
30690
30691
30692
30693 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30694 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30695 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30696 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30697 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30698 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30699 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30700 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30701 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30702 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30703 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30704 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30705 sender's domain.
30706
30707 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30708 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30709 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30710 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30711 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30712 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30713
30714 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30715 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30716 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30717 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30718 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30719
30720 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30721 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30722 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30723 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30724 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30725 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30726 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30727 supplies a host list.
30728 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30729
30730 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30731 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30732 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30733 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30734 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30735 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30736 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30737
30738 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30739 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30740 following SMTP commands are sent:
30741 .display
30742 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30743 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30744 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30745 &`QUIT`&
30746 .endd
30747 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30748 set to &"lmtp"&.
30749
30750 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30751 settings.
30752
30753 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30754 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30755 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30756 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30757 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30758 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30759
30760 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30761 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30762 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30763 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30764 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30765
30766 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30767 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30768 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30769 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30770 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30771
30772
30773
30774
30775 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30776 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30777 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30778 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30779 .code
30780 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30781 .endd
30782 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30783 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30784 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30785
30786
30787 .vlist
30788 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30789 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30790 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30791 For example:
30792 .code
30793 verify = sender/callout=5s
30794 .endd
30795 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30796 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30797 the &%connect%& parameter.
30798
30799
30800 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30801 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30802 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30803 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30804 .code
30805 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30806 .endd
30807 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30808
30809 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30810 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30811 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30812 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30813 updated in this circumstance.
30814
30815 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30816 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30817 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30818 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30819 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30820 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30821
30822
30823 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30824 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30825 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30826 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30827 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30828 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30829 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30830 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30831 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30832 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30833 .code
30834 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30835 .endd
30836 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30837
30838
30839 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30840 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30841 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30842 For example:
30843 .code
30844 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30845 .endd
30846 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30847 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30848 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30849 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30850 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30851
30852
30853 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30854 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30855 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30856 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30857
30858 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30859 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30860 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30861 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30862 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30863 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30864 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30865 made, until the cache record expires.
30866
30867 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30868 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30869 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30870 For example:
30871 .code
30872 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30873 .endd
30874 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30875 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30876 .code
30877 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30878 .endd
30879 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30880 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30881 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30882 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30883
30884
30885 .vitem &*random*&
30886 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30887 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30888 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30889 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30890 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30891 .code
30892 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30893 .endd
30894 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30895 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30896 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30897 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30898 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30899
30900 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30901 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30902 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30903 .code
30904 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30905 .endd
30906 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30907 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30908 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30909 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30910 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30911
30912 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30913 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30914 .code
30915 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30916 .endd
30917 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30918 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30919 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30920 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30921 usefulness of callout caching.
30922
30923 .new
30924 .vitem &*hold*&
30925 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30926 .code
30927 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
30928 .endd
30929 It causes the connection to be helod open and used for any further recipients
30930 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
30931 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
30932 when that is used for the connections.
30933 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
30934 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
30935 if the use_sender option is used,
30936 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
30937 and if no other callouts intervene.
30938 .wen
30939 .endlist
30940
30941 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30942 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30943 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30944 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30945 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30946 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30947 these circumstances.
30948
30949 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30950 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30951 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30952 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30953 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30954 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30955 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30956
30957 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30958 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30959 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30960 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30961
30962
30963
30964
30965 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30966 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30967 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30968 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30969 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30970 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30971 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30972 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30973 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30974 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30975
30976 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30977 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30978 is not available.
30979
30980 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30981 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30982 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30983
30984 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30985 commands up to and including
30986 .code
30987 MAIL FROM:<>
30988 .endd
30989 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30990 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30991 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30992 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30993 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30994 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30995 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30996
30997 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30998 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30999 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31000 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31001 will eventually be noticed.
31002
31003 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31004 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31005 behaviour will be the same.
31006
31007
31008
31009 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31010 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31011 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31012 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31013 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31014 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31015 you might see:
31016 .code
31017 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31018 250 OK
31019 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31020 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31021 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31022 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31023 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31024 550 Sender verification failed
31025 .endd
31026 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31027 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31028 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31029 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31030 example:
31031 .code
31032 verify = sender/no_details
31033 .endd
31034
31035 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31036 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31037 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31038 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31039 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31040 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31041 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31042
31043 .ilist
31044 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31045 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31046 verification also fails.
31047 .next
31048 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31049 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31050 .endlist
31051
31052 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31053 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31054 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31055 .code
31056 A.Wol: aw123
31057 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31058 .endd
31059 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31060 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31061 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31062 verification to succeed.
31063
31064 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31065 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31066 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31067 option. For example:
31068 .code
31069 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31070 .endd
31071 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31072 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31073
31074 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31075 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31076 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31077 address and a report is output for each of them.
31078
31079
31080
31081 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31082 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31083 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31084 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31085 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31086 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31087 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31088 .code
31089 verify = csa
31090 .endd
31091 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31092 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31093 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31094 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31095 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31096 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31097
31098 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31099 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31100 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31101 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31102
31103 .ilist
31104 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31105 .next
31106 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31107 .next
31108 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31109 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31110 .next
31111 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31112 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31113 .endlist
31114
31115 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31116 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31117 .code
31118 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31119 .endd
31120 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31121 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31122 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31123 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31124 meaningful to say:
31125 .code
31126 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31127 .endd
31128 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31129 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31130 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31131
31132 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31133 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31134 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31135 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31136 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31137 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31138 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31139 of legitimate HELO domains.
31140
31141 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31142 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31143 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31144 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31145 lookup such as:
31146 .code
31147 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31148 .endd
31149 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31150 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31151 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31152
31153
31154
31155
31156 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31157 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31158 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31159 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31160 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31161 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31162 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31163 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31164
31165 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31166 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31167 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31168 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31169 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31170 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31171 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31172
31173 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31174 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31175 like this:
31176 .code
31177 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31178 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31179 }{$value}}
31180 .endd
31181 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31182 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31183 use this:
31184 .code
31185 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31186 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31187 senders = :
31188 recipients = +batv_senders
31189
31190 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31191 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31192 senders = :
31193 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31194 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31195 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31196 .endd
31197 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31198 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31199 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31200 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31201 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31202
31203 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31204 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31205 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31206 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31207 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31208 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31209 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31210
31211 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31212 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31213 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31214 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31215 .code
31216 batv_redirect:
31217 driver = redirect
31218 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31219 .endd
31220 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31221 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31222 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31223 local addresses.
31224
31225 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31226 can be used:
31227 .code
31228 external_smtp_batv:
31229 driver = smtp
31230 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31231 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31232 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31233 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31234 {$value}fail}}}
31235 .endd
31236 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31237
31238
31239
31240 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31241 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31242 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31243 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31244 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31245 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31246 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31247 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31248 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31249 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31250
31251 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31252 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31253 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31254 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31255 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31256 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31257 . ///
31258 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31259 . ///
31260 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31261 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31262 system to arbitrary domains.
31263
31264
31265 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31266 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31267 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31268 example, suppose you want to do the following:
31269
31270 .ilist
31271 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31272 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31273 &'my.dom2.example'&.
31274 .next
31275 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31276 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31277 .next
31278 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31279 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31280 .endlist
31281
31282
31283 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31284 .code
31285 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31286 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31287 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31288 .endd
31289 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31290 command:
31291 .code
31292 acl_check_rcpt:
31293 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31294 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31295 .endd
31296 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31297 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31298 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31299 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31300 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31301 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31302 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31303
31304
31305
31306 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31307 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31308 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31309 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31310 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31311 .ecindex IIDacl
31312
31313
31314
31315 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31316 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31317
31318 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31319 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31320 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31321 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31322 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31323 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31324 specification.
31325
31326 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31327 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31328 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31329 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31330 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31331
31332 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31333 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31334 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31335
31336 .ilist
31337 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31338 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31339 .next
31340 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31341 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31342 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31343 .next
31344 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31345 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
31346 .next
31347 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
31348 conditions.
31349 .next
31350 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
31351 .endlist
31352
31353 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
31354 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
31355 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
31356 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
31357 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
31358 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
31359
31360 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
31361 temporarily created in a file called:
31362 .display
31363 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
31364 .endd
31365 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
31366 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
31367 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
31368 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
31369 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
31370 .code
31371 control = no_mbox_unspool
31372 .endd
31373 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
31374 same directory by default.
31375
31376
31377
31378 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
31379 .cindex "virus scanning"
31380 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
31381 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
31382 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
31383 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
31384 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
31385 in memory and thus are much faster.
31386
31387 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
31388 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
31389
31390 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
31391 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
31392 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
31393 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
31394 .display
31395 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
31396 .endd
31397 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
31398 .code
31399 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
31400 .endd
31401 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
31402 before use.
31403 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
31404 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
31405
31406 .vlist
31407 .vitem &%avast%&
31408 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
31409 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
31410 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
31411 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
31412 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
31413 This scanner type takes one option,
31414 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31415 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31416 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31417 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31418 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
31419 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31420 For example:
31421 .code
31422 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31423 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31424 .endd
31425 If you omit the argument, the default path
31426 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31427 is used.
31428 If you use a remote host,
31429 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31430 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31431 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31432 .code
31433 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31434 FLAGS
31435 SENSITIVITY
31436 PACK
31437 .endd
31438
31439
31440 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31441 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31442 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31443 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31444 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31445 example:
31446 .code
31447 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31448 .endd
31449
31450
31451 .vitem &%clamd%&
31452 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31453 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31454 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31455 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31456 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31457
31458 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31459 a UNIX socket specification,
31460 a TCP socket specification,
31461 or a (global) option.
31462
31463 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31464 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31465 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31466 and the second a port number,
31467 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31468 These per-server options are supported:
31469 .code
31470 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31471 .endd
31472
31473 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31474 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31475
31476 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31477
31478 Examples:
31479 .code
31480 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31481 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31482 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31483 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31484 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31485 .endd
31486 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31487 &`local`&
31488 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31489 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31490 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31491 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31492 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
31493 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
31494
31495 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31496 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31497 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31498 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31499 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31500 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31501 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31502 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31503 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31504 .code
31505 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31506 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31507 (Connection refused)
31508 .endd
31509
31510 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31511 contributing the code for this scanner.
31512
31513 .vitem &%cmdline%&
31514 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31515 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31516 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31517 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31518
31519 .olist
31520 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31521 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31522
31523 .next
31524 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31525 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31526 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31527 the &"trigger"& expression.
31528
31529 .next
31530 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31531 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31532 &"name"& expression.
31533 .endlist olist
31534
31535 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31536 .code
31537 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31538 .endd
31539 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31540 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31541 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31542 configuration setting:
31543 .code
31544 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31545 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31546 found in file:'(.+)'
31547 .endd
31548 .vitem &%drweb%&
31549 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31550 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31551 takes one option,
31552 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31553 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31554 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31555 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31556 For example:
31557 .code
31558 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31559 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31560 .endd
31561 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31562 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31563
31564 .vitem &%f-protd%&
31565 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31566 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31567 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31568 (or port-range).
31569 For example:
31570 .code
31571 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31572 .endd
31573 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31574
31575 .new
31576 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
31577 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
31578 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
31579 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
31580 For example:
31581 .code
31582 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
31583 .endd
31584 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31585 .wen
31586
31587 .vitem &%fsecure%&
31588 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31589 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31590 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31591 .code
31592 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31593 .endd
31594 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31595 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31596
31597 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31598 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31599 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31600 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31601 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
31602 For example:
31603 .code
31604 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
31605 .endd
31606 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
31607
31608 .vitem &%mksd%&
31609 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
31610 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
31611 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
31612 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
31613 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
31614 provided that mksd has
31615 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
31616 .code
31617 av_scanner = mksd:2
31618 .endd
31619 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
31620
31621 .vitem &%sock%&
31622 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
31623 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
31624 running on the local machine.
31625 There are four options:
31626 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31627 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31628 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31629 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31630 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31631 For example:
31632 .code
31633 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31634 .endd
31635 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31636 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31637 Both regular-expressions are required.
31638
31639 .vitem &%sophie%&
31640 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31641 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31642 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31643 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31644 client communication. For example:
31645 .code
31646 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31647 .endd
31648 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31649 the option.
31650 .endlist
31651
31652 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31653 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31654 ACL.
31655
31656 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31657 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31658 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31659 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31660 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31661 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31662 message.
31663
31664 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31665 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31666 The first element can then be one of
31667
31668 .ilist
31669 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31670 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31671 recommended usage.
31672 .next
31673 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31674 the condition fails immediately.
31675 .next
31676 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31677 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31678 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31679 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31680 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31681 .endlist
31682
31683 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31684 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31685 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31686
31687 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31688 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31689 For example:
31690 .code
31691 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31692 .endd
31693 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31694
31695 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31696 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31697 is set to record the actual address used.
31698
31699 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31700 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31701 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31702 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31703 logging data.
31704
31705 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31706 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31707
31708 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31709 .code
31710 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31711 malware = *
31712 .endd
31713 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31714 .code
31715 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31716 malware = */defer_ok
31717 .endd
31718 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31719 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31720 .code
31721 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31722 .endd
31723 in the main Exim configuration.
31724 .code
31725 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31726 set acl_m0 = sophie
31727 malware = *
31728
31729 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31730 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31731 malware = *
31732 .endd
31733
31734
31735 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31736 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31737 .cindex "spam scanning"
31738 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31739 .cindex "Rspamd"
31740 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31741 score and a report for the message.
31742 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31743
31744 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31745 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31746 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31747
31748 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31749 .code
31750 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31751 .endd
31752 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31753 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31754 nicely, however.
31755
31756 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31757 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31758 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31759 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31760 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31761 configuration as follows (example):
31762 .code
31763 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31764 .endd
31765 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
31766 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
31767 iptables firewall, consider setting
31768 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
31769 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
31770 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
31771 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
31772 soon.
31773
31774
31775 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31776 on TCP port 11333)
31777 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31778 .code
31779 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31780 .endd
31781
31782 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31783 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31784 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31785 .code
31786 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31787 .endd
31788 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31789 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31790 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31791 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31792 .code
31793 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31794 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31795 192.168.2.12 783
31796 .endd
31797 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31798 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31799 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31800 condition defers.
31801
31802 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31803 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31804 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
31805
31806 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31807 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31808 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31809 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31810
31811 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31812 are options.
31813 The supported options are:
31814 .code
31815 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31816 weight=<value> Selection bias
31817 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31818 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31819 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31820 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31821 .endd
31822
31823 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31824 higher values being tried first.
31825 The default priority is 1.
31826
31827 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31828 Within a priority set
31829 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31830 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31831
31832 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31833 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31834 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31835 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31836
31837 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31838 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31839
31840 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31841 The default value is two minutes.
31842
31843 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31844 a failed connect is made.
31845 The default is to not retry.
31846
31847 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31848 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31849 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31850 expansion.
31851
31852 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31853 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31854 is set to record the actual address used.
31855
31856 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31857 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31858 .code
31859 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31860 spam = joe
31861 .endd
31862 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31863 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31864 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31865 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31866 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31867 right-hand side.
31868
31869 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31870 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31871 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31872 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31873 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31874 are not set.
31875 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31876 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31877 after the first),
31878 or the use of PRDR,
31879 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31880 are needed to use this feature.
31881
31882 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31883 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31884 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31885
31886
31887 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31888 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31889 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31890 example:
31891 .code
31892 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31893 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31894 spam = nobody
31895 .endd
31896
31897 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31898 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31899 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31900 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31901
31902 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31903 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31904 variables.
31905 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31906 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31907 available for use at delivery time.
31908
31909 .vlist
31910 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31911 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31912 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31913
31914 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31915 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31916 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31917 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31918 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31919
31920 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31921 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31922 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31923 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31924 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31925 spam bar is 50 characters.
31926
31927 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31928 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31929 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31930 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31931 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
31932 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
31933 unencoded in headers.
31934
31935 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31936 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31937 spam score versus threshold.
31938 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31939
31940 .endlist
31941
31942 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31943 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31944 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31945
31946 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31947 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31948 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31949 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31950 spam condition, like this:
31951 .code
31952 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31953 spam = joe/defer_ok
31954 .endd
31955 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31956
31957 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31958 condition:
31959 .code
31960 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31961 warn spam = nobody:true
31962 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31963 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31964
31965 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31966 # is over threshold
31967 warn spam = nobody
31968 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31969
31970 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31971 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31972 spam = nobody:true
31973 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31974 .endd
31975
31976
31977
31978 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31979 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31980 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31981 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31982 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31983 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31984 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31985 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31986 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31987 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31988 cases.
31989
31990 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31991 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31992 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31993 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31994 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31995 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31996 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31997
31998 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31999 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32000 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32001 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32002 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32003
32004 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32005 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32006 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32007 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32008 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32009 syntax is:
32010 .display
32011 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32012 .endd
32013 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32014 the value can be:
32015
32016 .olist
32017 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32018 .next
32019 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32020 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32021 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32022 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32023 .next
32024 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32025 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32026 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32027 the full path and file name.
32028 .next
32029 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32030 filename, and the default path is then used.
32031 .endlist
32032 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32033 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32034 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32035 .code
32036 decode = $mime_filename
32037 .endd
32038 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32039 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32040 automatically unlinked.
32041
32042 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32043 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32044 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32045 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32046 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32047
32048 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32049 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32050 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32051
32052 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32053 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32054 available in the MIME ACL:
32055
32056 .vlist
32057 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32058 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32059 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32060 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32061 contains the empty string.
32062
32063 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32064 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32065 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32066 .code
32067 us-ascii
32068 gb2312 (Chinese)
32069 iso-8859-1
32070 .endd
32071 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32072 case-insensitively.
32073
32074 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32075 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32076 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32077 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32078 only used for display purposes.
32079
32080 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32081 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32082 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32083
32084 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32085 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32086 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32087
32088 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32089 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32090 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32091 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32092 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32093
32094 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32095 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32096 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32097 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32098
32099 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32100 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32101 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32102 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32103 .code
32104 text/plain
32105 text/html
32106 application/octet-stream
32107 image/jpeg
32108 audio/midi
32109 .endd
32110 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32111 empty string.
32112
32113 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32114 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32115 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32116 containing the decoded data.
32117 .endlist
32118
32119 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32120 .vlist
32121 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32122 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32123 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32124 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32125 RFC2047
32126 or RFC2231
32127 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32128 If no filename was
32129 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32130
32131 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32132 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32133 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32134 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32135
32136 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32137 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32138 follows:
32139
32140 .olist
32141 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32142
32143 .next
32144 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32145 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32146
32147 .next
32148 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32149 and the rest are attachments.
32150
32151 .next
32152 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32153 .endlist olist
32154
32155 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32156 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32157 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32158 .code
32159 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32160 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32161 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32162 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32163 .endd
32164 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32165 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32166 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32167 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32168 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32169
32170 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32171 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32172 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32173 decoding is fully recursive.
32174
32175 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32176 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32177 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32178 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32179 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32180 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32181 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32182 .endlist
32183
32184
32185
32186 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32187 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32188 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32189 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32190 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32191
32192 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32193 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32194 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32195 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32196 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32197
32198 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32199 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32200 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32201 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32202 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32203 32K characters are checked.
32204
32205 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32206 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32207 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32208 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32209 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32210 .code
32211 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32212 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32213 .endd
32214 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32215 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32216 matching regular expression.
32217 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32218 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32219
32220 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32221 CPU-intensive.
32222
32223 .ecindex IIDcosca
32224
32225
32226
32227
32228 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32229 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32230
32231 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32232 "Local scan function"
32233 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32234 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32235 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32236 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32237 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32238
32239 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32240 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32241 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32242 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32243 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32244
32245 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32246 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32247 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32248 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32249
32250 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32251 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32252 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32253 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32254
32255 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32256 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32257 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32258 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32259 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32260 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32261 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32262 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32263 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32264
32265
32266
32267 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32268 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32269 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32270 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32271 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32272 directory, so you might set
32273 .code
32274 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32275 .endd
32276 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32277 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32278 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32279 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32280 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32281 _src/local_scan.c_.
32282
32283 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32284 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32285 .code
32286 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32287 .endd
32288 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32289
32290
32291
32292
32293 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32294 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32295 You must include this line near the start of your code:
32296 .code
32297 #include "local_scan.h"
32298 .endd
32299 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32300 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32301 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32302 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32303 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32304 strings and pointers to character strings:
32305 .code
32306 #define CS (char *)
32307 #define CCS (const char *)
32308 #define CSS (char **)
32309 #define US (unsigned char *)
32310 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32311 #define USS (unsigned char **)
32312 .endd
32313 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32314 .code
32315 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32316 .endd
32317 The arguments are as follows:
32318
32319 .ilist
32320 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32321 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32322 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32323
32324 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32325 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
32326 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
32327 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
32328 case this changes in some future version.
32329 .next
32330 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
32331 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
32332 .endlist
32333
32334 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
32335
32336 .vlist
32337 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
32338 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
32339 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
32340 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
32341 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
32342 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
32343
32344 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
32345 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32346 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
32347
32348 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
32349 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
32350 queued without immediate delivery.
32351
32352 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
32353 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32354 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32355 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32356 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32357 used.
32358
32359 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32360 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32361 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32362 problem"& is used.
32363
32364 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32365 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32366 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32367 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32368 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32369 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32370 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32371
32372 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32373 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32374 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32375 .endlist
32376
32377 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32378 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32379 &%-oe%& command line options.
32380
32381
32382
32383 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32384 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32385 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32386 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32387 want to do this, you must have the line
32388 .code
32389 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32390 .endd
32391 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32392 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32393 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32394 to define them.
32395
32396 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32397 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32398 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32399 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32400 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32401 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32402 .code
32403 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32404 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32405
32406 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32407 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32408 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32409 };
32410
32411 int local_scan_options_count =
32412 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32413 .endd
32414 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32415 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32416 .code
32417 begin local_scan
32418 my_integer = 99
32419 my_string = some string of text...
32420 .endd
32421 The available types of option data are as follows:
32422
32423 .vlist
32424 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32425 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32426 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32427 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32428 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32429 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32430 values.)
32431
32432 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32433 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32434 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32435 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32436
32437 .vitem &*opt_int*&
32438 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32439 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32440 Exim.
32441
32442 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32443 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32444 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32445 printed with the suffix K or M.
32446
32447 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32448 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32449 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32450 always output in octal.
32451
32452 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32453 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32454 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32455
32456 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32457 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32458 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32459 .endlist
32460
32461 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32462 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32463
32464
32465
32466 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32467 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32468 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32469 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32470 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32471 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32472 C variables are as follows:
32473
32474 .vlist
32475 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32476 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32477
32478 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32479 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32480
32481 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32482 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32483 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32484 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32485
32486 .ilist
32487 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32488 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32489 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32490
32491 .next
32492 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32493 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32494 of debugging bits.
32495 .endlist ilist
32496
32497 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32498 selected, you should use code like this:
32499 .code
32500 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32501 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32502 .endd
32503 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32504 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32505 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32506
32507 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32508 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32509 discussed below.
32510
32511 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32512 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32513
32514 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32515 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32516
32517 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32518 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32519 &%-bh%& command line option.
32520
32521 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32522 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32523 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32524
32525 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32526 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32527 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32528 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32529
32530 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32531 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32532 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32533
32534 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32535 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32536
32537 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32538 The number of accepted recipients.
32539
32540 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32541 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32542 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32543 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32544 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32545 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32546 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32547 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32548 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32549 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32550 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32551 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32552
32553 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32554 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32555
32556 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32557 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32558 locally-submitted messages.
32559
32560 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32561 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32562 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32563
32564 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32565 The name of the sending host, if known.
32566
32567 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32568 The port on the sending host.
32569
32570 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32571 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32572
32573 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32574 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32575
32576 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32577 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32578 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32579 .endlist
32580
32581
32582 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32583 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32584 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32585 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32586 their type to *.
32587
32588
32589 .vlist
32590 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32591 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32592
32593 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32594 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32595 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32596 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32597 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32598 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32599 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32600
32601 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32602 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32603 internal newlines.
32604
32605 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32606 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32607 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32608 .endlist
32609
32610
32611
32612 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32613 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32614
32615 .vlist
32616 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32617 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32618
32619 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32620 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32621 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32622 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32623
32624 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32625 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32626 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32627 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32628 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32629 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32630 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32631 is NULL for all recipients.
32632 .endlist
32633
32634
32635
32636 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32637 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32638 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32639 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32640 release:
32641
32642 .vlist
32643 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32644 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32645
32646 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32647 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32648 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32649 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32650
32651 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32652 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32653 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32654 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32655 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32656
32657 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32658
32659 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32660 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32661 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32662 return value is as follows:
32663
32664 .ilist
32665 >= 0
32666
32667 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32668 ending status.
32669
32670 .next
32671 < 0 and > &--256
32672
32673 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32674 signal number.
32675
32676 .next
32677 &--256
32678
32679 The process timed out.
32680 .next
32681 &--257
32682
32683 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32684 .endlist
32685
32686 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32687 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32688 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32689 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32690 forks a subprocess that is running
32691 .code
32692 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32693 .endd
32694 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32695 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32696 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32697 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32698
32699 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32700 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32701 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32702 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32703
32704
32705 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32706 *sender_authentication)*&
32707 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32708 that it runs is:
32709 .display
32710 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32711 .endd
32712 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32713
32714
32715 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32716 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32717 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32718 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32719 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32720 .code
32721 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32722 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32723 .endd
32724
32725 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32726 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32727 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32728 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32729 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32730 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32731 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32732 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32733
32734 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32735 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32736 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32737 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32738 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32739 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32740
32741 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32742 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32743 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32744 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32745
32746 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32747 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32748 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32749 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32750 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32751 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32752 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32753 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32754 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32755 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32756 .code
32757 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32758 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32759 .endd
32760 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32761 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32762
32763
32764 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32765 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32766 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32767 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32768 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32769
32770
32771 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32772 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32773 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32774 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32775 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32776 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32777 .code
32778 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32779 .endd
32780 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32781 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32782 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32783 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32784 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32785 zero-terminated.
32786
32787 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32788 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32789 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32790 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32791 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32792 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32793 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32794 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32795
32796 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32797 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32798 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32799 .display
32800 &`OK `& match succeeded
32801 &`FAIL `& match failed
32802 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32803 .endd
32804 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32805 inability to contact a database.
32806
32807 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32808 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32809 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32810 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32811 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32812
32813 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32814 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32815 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32816 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32817 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32818
32819 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32820 uschar&~*list)*&"
32821 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32822 expected to be
32823 .code
32824 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32825 .endd
32826 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32827 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32828 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32829 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32830 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32831 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32832 failed.
32833
32834 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32835 *format,&~...)*&"
32836 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32837 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32838 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32839 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32840 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32841 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32842
32843
32844 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32845 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32846 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32847 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32848
32849 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32850 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32851 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32852 value afterwards. For example:
32853 .code
32854 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32855 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32856 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32857 .endd
32858
32859 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32860 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32861 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32862 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32863 address.
32864 .endlist
32865
32866
32867 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32868 .vlist
32869 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32870 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32871 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32872 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32873 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32874 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32875 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32876 binary string is returned with an error message.
32877
32878 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32879 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32880 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32881
32882 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32883 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32884 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32885 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32886 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32887
32888 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32889 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32890 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32891
32892 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32893 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32894 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32895 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32896 with translation.
32897
32898
32899 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32900 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32901 below.
32902
32903 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32904 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32905 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32906 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32907 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32908 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32909 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32910 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32911 is involved.
32912
32913 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32914 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32915
32916 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32917 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32918 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32919 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32920 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32921 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32922 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32923 .code
32924 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32925 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32926 .endd
32927 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32928 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32929 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32930 multiple output lines.
32931
32932 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32933 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32934 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32935 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32936 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32937 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32938 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32939 is an error.
32940
32941 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32942 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32943 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32944 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32945
32946 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32947 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32948 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32949
32950 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32951 See below.
32952
32953 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32954 See below.
32955
32956 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32957 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32958 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32959 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32960 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32961 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32962 more discussion.
32963 .endlist
32964
32965
32966
32967 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32968 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32969 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32970 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32971 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32972 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32973 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32974 terminates.
32975
32976 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32977 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32978 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32979 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32980
32981 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32982 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32983 .code
32984 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32985 .endd
32986 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32987 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32988 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32989 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32990
32991 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32992 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32993 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32994 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32995 &%store_pool%&.
32996 .ecindex IIDlosca
32997
32998
32999
33000
33001 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33002 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33003
33004 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33005 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33006 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33007 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33008 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33009 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33010 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33011 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33012
33013 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33014 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33015 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33016 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33017 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33018
33019 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33020 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33021 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33022 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33023 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33024 prevent it happening on retries.
33025
33026 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33027 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33028 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33029 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33030 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33031 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33032 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33033 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33034
33035
33036 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33037 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33038 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33039 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33040 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33041 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33042 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33043 .code
33044 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33045 system_filter_user = exim
33046 .endd
33047 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33048 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33049 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33050 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33051 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33052 by the &%reply%& command.
33053
33054
33055 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33056 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33057 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33058 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33059
33060 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33061 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33062
33063
33064
33065 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33066 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33067 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33068 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33069 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33070 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33071 they cause errors.
33072
33073 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33074 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33075 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33076 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33077 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33078 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33079 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33080
33081 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33082 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33083 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33084 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33085 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33086
33087 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33088 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33089 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33090 to which users' filter files can refer.
33091
33092
33093
33094 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33095 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33096 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33097 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33098 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33099
33100
33101
33102 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33103 .cindex "freezing messages"
33104 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33105 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33106 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33107 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33108 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33109 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33110 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33111 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33112 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33113 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33114 .code
33115 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33116 .endd
33117 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33118
33119 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33120 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33121 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33122 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33123 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33124 run.
33125
33126 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33127 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33128 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33129 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33130
33131 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33132 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33133 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33134 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33135 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33136 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33137 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33138 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33139 message. For example:
33140 .code
33141 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33142 because it contains attachments that we are \
33143 not prepared to receive."
33144 .endd
33145
33146 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33147 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33148 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33149 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33150 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33151 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33152 use, for example
33153 .code
33154 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33155 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33156 .endd
33157 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33158 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33159 generated by the filter.
33160
33161 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33162 &%defer%&,
33163 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33164 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33165 as
33166 .code
33167 mail ...
33168 freeze
33169 .endd
33170 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33171 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33172 take place.
33173
33174
33175
33176 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33177 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33178 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33179 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33180 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33181 .code
33182 headers add <string>
33183 headers remove <string>
33184 .endd
33185 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33186 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33187 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33188 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33189 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33190
33191 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33192 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33193 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33194 example:
33195 .code
33196 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33197 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33198 X-header-2: ...."
33199 .endd
33200 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33201 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33202 space after input continuations is ignored.
33203
33204 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33205 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33206 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33207 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33208 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33209
33210 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33211 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33212 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33213 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33214 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33215 used for all recipients of the message.
33216
33217 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33218 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33219 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33220 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33221 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33222 until the message is actually being written (see section
33223 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33224
33225 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33226 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33227 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33228 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33229 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33230 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33231 modified more than once.
33232
33233 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33234 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33235 For example:
33236 .code
33237 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33238 headers remove "Subject"
33239 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33240 headers remove "Old-Subject"
33241 .endd
33242
33243
33244
33245 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33246 .cindex "envelope sender"
33247 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33248 .code
33249 errors_to <some address>
33250 .endd
33251 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33252 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33253 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33254 might use
33255 .code
33256 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33257 .endd
33258 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33259 address if its delivery failed.
33260
33261
33262
33263 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33264 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33265 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33266 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33267 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33268 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33269 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33270 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33271 which implements such a filter:
33272 .code
33273 central_filter:
33274 check_local_user
33275 driver = redirect
33276 domains = +local_domains
33277 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33278 no_verify
33279 allow_filter
33280 allow_freeze
33281 .endd
33282 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33283 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33284 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33285 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33286
33287 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33288 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33289 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33290 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33291 normal way.
33292 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
33293 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
33294 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
33295
33296
33297
33298
33299
33300
33301 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33302 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33303
33304 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33305 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33306 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33307 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33308 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33309 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33310 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33311 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33312
33313 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33314 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33315 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33316 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33317 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33318
33319 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33320 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33321 loopback interface specially in any way.
33322
33323 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
33324 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
33325
33326
33327
33328
33329 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
33330 .cindex "message" "submission"
33331 .cindex "submission mode"
33332 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
33333 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
33334 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
33335 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
33336 .code
33337 control = submission
33338 .endd
33339 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
33340 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
33341 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
33342 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
33343 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
33344 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
33345 .code
33346 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
33347 control = submission
33348 .endd
33349 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
33350 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
33351 is used to separate options. For example:
33352 .code
33353 control = submission/sender_retain
33354 .endd
33355 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33356 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33357 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33358 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33359 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33360 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33361 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33362
33363 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33364 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33365 example:
33366 .code
33367 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33368 .endd
33369 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33370 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33371 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33372 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33373 .code
33374 accept authenticated = *
33375 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33376 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33377 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33378 .endd
33379 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33380 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33381 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33382 .code
33383 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33384 .endd
33385 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33386 line would be:
33387 .code
33388 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33389 .endd
33390 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33391 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33392 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33393 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33394
33395 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33396 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33397 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33398 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33399 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33400 spoof another's address.
33401
33402 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33403 .cindex "line endings"
33404 .cindex "carriage return"
33405 .cindex "linefeed"
33406 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33407 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33408 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33409 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33410 use CRLF or just CR.
33411
33412 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33413 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33414 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33415 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33416 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33417 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33418 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33419 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33420 follows:
33421
33422 .ilist
33423 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33424 .next
33425 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33426 is ignored.
33427 .next
33428 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33429 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33430 terminator.
33431 .next
33432 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33433 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33434 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33435 people trying to play silly games.
33436 .next
33437 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33438 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33439 line.
33440 .endlist
33441
33442
33443
33444
33445
33446 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33447 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33448 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33449 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33450 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33451 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33452 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33453 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33454
33455 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33456 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33457 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33458 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33459 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33460
33461 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33462 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33463 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33464 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33465 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33466 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33467 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33468 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33469
33470
33471
33472
33473 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33474 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33475 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33476 .cindex "sender" "address"
33477 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33478 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33479 .cindex "envelope sender"
33480 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33481 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33482 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33483 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33484 .code
33485 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33486 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33487 .endd
33488 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33489 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33490 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33491 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33492 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33493 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33494 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33495 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33496 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33497
33498 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33499 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33500 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33501 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33502 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33503 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33504 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33505
33506 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33507 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33508 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33509
33510 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33511 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33512 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33513 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33514
33515
33516
33517 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33518 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33519 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
33520 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33521 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33522 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33523 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33524 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33525
33526 .blockquote
33527 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33528 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33529 .endblockquote
33530
33531 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33532 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33533 follows:
33534
33535 .ilist
33536 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33537 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33538 .next
33539 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33540 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33541 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33542 .next
33543 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33544 also removed.
33545 .next
33546 For a locally-submitted message,
33547 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33548 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33549 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33550 included in log lines in this case.
33551 .next
33552 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33553 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33554 .endlist
33555
33556
33557
33558
33559 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33560 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33561 includes the header line:
33562 .code
33563 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33564 .endd
33565
33566 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33567 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33568 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33569 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33570 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33571 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33572
33573
33574 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33575 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33576 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
33577 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33578 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33579 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33580
33581 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33582 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33583 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33584 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33585 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33586 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33587 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33588 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33589 messages.
33590
33591
33592 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33593 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33594 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
33595 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33596 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33597 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33598 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33599 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33600 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33601 messages.
33602
33603
33604 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33605 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33606 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
33607 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33608 .cindex "message" "submission"
33609 .cindex "submission mode"
33610 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33611 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33612
33613 .ilist
33614 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33615 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33616 .next
33617 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33618 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33619 .olist
33620 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33621 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33622 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33623 .next
33624 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33625 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33626 .next
33627 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33628 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33629 .endlist
33630 .endlist
33631
33632 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33633
33634 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33635 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33636 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33637 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33638 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33639 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33640 &%qualify_domain%&.
33641
33642 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33643 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33644 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33645 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33646
33647
33648 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33649 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33650 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
33651 .cindex "message" "submission"
33652 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33653 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33654 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33655 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33656 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33657 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33658 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33659 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33660 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33661 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33662
33663
33664 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33665 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33666 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
33667 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33668 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33669 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33670
33671 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33672 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33673 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33674 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33675
33676 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33677 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33678 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33679
33680
33681 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33682 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33683 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
33684 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33685 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33686 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33687 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33688 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33689 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33690 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33691 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33692 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33693
33694
33695
33696 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33697 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33698 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
33699 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33700 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33701 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33702 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33703 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33704 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33705
33706
33707
33708 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33709 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33710 .cindex "message" "submission"
33711 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
33712 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33713 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33714 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33715 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33716 control setting.
33717
33718 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33719 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33720 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33721 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33722 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33723 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33724 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33725 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33726 line is added to the message.
33727
33728 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33729 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33730 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33731 options true at the same time.
33732
33733 .cindex "submission mode"
33734 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33735 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33736 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33737 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33738
33739 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33740 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33741 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33742 created as follows:
33743
33744 .ilist
33745 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33746 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33747 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33748 .next
33749 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33750 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33751 .next
33752 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33753 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33754 .endlist
33755
33756 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33757 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33758 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33759 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33760
33761 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33762 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33763 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33764 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33765
33766
33767
33768 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33769 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33770 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33771 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33772 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33773 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33774 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33775 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33776 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33777
33778 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33779 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33780 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33781 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33782 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33783 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33784
33785 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33786 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33787 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33788
33789 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33790 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33791 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33792 .code
33793 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33794 X-added-second: another added header line
33795 .endd
33796 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33797
33798 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33799 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33800 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33801
33802 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33803 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33804 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33805 not part of the names. For example:
33806 .code
33807 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33808 .endd
33809
33810 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33811 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33812 Each item is separately expanded.
33813 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33814 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33815 will act as list separators.
33816
33817 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33818 items are expanded at routing time,
33819 and then associated with all addresses that are
33820 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33821 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33822 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33823
33824 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33825 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33826 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33827 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33828
33829 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33830 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33831 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33832 requirements.
33833
33834 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33835 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33836 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33837 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33838 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33839 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33840 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33841
33842 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33843 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33844 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33845 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33846
33847 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33848 the following consequences:
33849
33850 .ilist
33851 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33852 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33853 to it, at all times.
33854 .next
33855 Header lines that are added by a router's
33856 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33857 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33858 .next
33859 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33860 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33861 .next
33862 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33863 a later router or by a transport.
33864 .next
33865 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33866 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33867 .code
33868 headers_remove = subject
33869 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33870 .endd
33871 .endlist
33872
33873 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33874 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33875
33876
33877
33878
33879
33880 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33881 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33882 .cindex "constructed address"
33883 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33884 the form
33885 .display
33886 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33887 .endd
33888 For example:
33889 .code
33890 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33891 .endd
33892 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33893 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33894 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33895 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33896 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33897 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33898 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33899 there is no password file entry.
33900
33901 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33902 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33903 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33904 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33905 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33906 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33907 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33908 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33909 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33910
33911
33912
33913 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33914 .cindex "case of local parts"
33915 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33916 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33917 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33918 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33919 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33920 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33921 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33922 router option.
33923
33924 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33925 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33926 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33927 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33928 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33929 .code
33930 correct_case:
33931 driver = redirect
33932 domains = +local_domains
33933 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33934 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33935 @$domain
33936 .endd
33937 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33938 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33939 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33940 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33941 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33942
33943
33944
33945 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33946 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33947 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33948 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33949 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33950 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33951 empty components for compatibility.
33952
33953
33954
33955 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33956 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33957 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33958 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33959 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33960 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33961
33962 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33963 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33964 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33965 example, a header such as
33966 .code
33967 To: hare@teaparty
33968 .endd
33969 might get rewritten as
33970 .code
33971 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33972 .endd
33973 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33974 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33975 been routed.
33976
33977 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33978 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33979 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33980 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33981 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33982 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33983 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33984
33985
33986
33987 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33988 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33989
33990 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33991 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33992 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33993 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33994 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33995 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33996 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33997
33998 .ilist
33999 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34000 .next
34001 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34002 .next
34003 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34004 .endlist
34005
34006 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34007
34008 .ilist
34009 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34010 .next
34011 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34012 &"lmtp"&);
34013 .next
34014 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34015 transport);
34016 .next
34017 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34018 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34019 .endlist
34020
34021 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34022 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34023 used to contain the envelope information.
34024
34025
34026
34027 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34028 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34029 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34030 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34031 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34032 .cindex "EHLO"
34033 .cindex "HELO"
34034 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34035 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34036 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34037 processing is the same in both cases.
34038
34039 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34040 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34041 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34042 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34043 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34044 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34045 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34046 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34047 suppressed.
34048
34049 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34050 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34051 required for the transaction.
34052
34053 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34054 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34055 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34056 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34057 is called for verification.
34058
34059 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34060 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34061 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34062
34063 .cindex "carriage return"
34064 .cindex "linefeed"
34065 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34066 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34067 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34068 line terminator.
34069
34070 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34071 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34072 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34073 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34074 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34075 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34076 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34077 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34078 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34079
34080 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34081 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34082 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34083 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34084
34085 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34086 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34087 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34088 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34089
34090 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34091 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34092 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34093 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34094 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34095 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34096 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34097 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34098 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34099 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34100
34101 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34102 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34103
34104 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34105 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34106 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34107 square bracket of the IP address.
34108
34109
34110
34111
34112 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34113 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34114 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34115 .cindex "host" "error"
34116 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34117 message errors, and recipient errors.
34118
34119 .vlist
34120 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34121 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34122 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34123
34124 .ilist
34125 Connection refused or timed out,
34126 .next
34127 Any error response code on connection,
34128 .next
34129 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34130 .next
34131 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34132 .next
34133 I/O errors at any time,
34134 .next
34135 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34136 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34137 .endlist ilist
34138
34139 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34140 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34141 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34142 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34143 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34144 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34145 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34146 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34147
34148 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34149 .cindex "message" "error"
34150 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34151 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34152 message errors are:
34153
34154 .ilist
34155 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34156 the data,
34157 .next
34158 Timeout after MAIL,
34159 .next
34160 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34161 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34162 connection at any other time.
34163 .endlist ilist
34164
34165 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34166 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34167 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34168 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34169 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34170 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34171 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34172 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34173 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34174 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34175
34176 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34177 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34178 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34179 response to MAIL.
34180
34181 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34182 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34183 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34184 recipient errors are:
34185
34186 .ilist
34187 Any error response to RCPT,
34188 .next
34189 Timeout after RCPT.
34190 .endlist
34191
34192 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34193 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34194 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34195 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34196 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34197 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34198 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34199 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34200 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34201 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34202 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34203 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34204 the retry clock is reset.
34205
34206 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34207 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34208 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34209 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34210 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34211 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34212 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34213 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34214 recipient's retry time.
34215 .endlist
34216
34217 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34218 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34219 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34220 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34221 until the next delivery attempt.
34222
34223 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34224 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34225 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34226 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34227 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34228 is created.
34229
34230 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34231 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34232 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34233 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34234 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34235 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34236 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34237
34238 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34239 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34240 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34241 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34242 then to be treated as a host error.
34243
34244 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34245 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34246 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34247 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34248 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34249
34250
34251
34252
34253 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34254 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34255 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34256 .cindex "inetd"
34257 .cindex "daemon"
34258 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34259 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34260 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34261 .code
34262 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34263 .endd
34264 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34265 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34266 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34267 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34268 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34269 stream and exits with an error code.
34270
34271 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34272 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34273 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34274 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34275
34276 .cindex "carriage return"
34277 .cindex "linefeed"
34278 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34279 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34280 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34281 line terminator.
34282 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34283 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34284 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34285
34286 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34287 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34288 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34289 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34290 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34291 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34292 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34293 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34294
34295 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34296 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34297 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34298 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34299 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34300 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34301 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34302 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34303 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34304
34305 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34306 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34307 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34308
34309 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34310 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34311 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34312 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34313 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34314
34315 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34316 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34317 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34318 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34319 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34320 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34321 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34322
34323 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
34324 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
34325 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
34326 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
34327 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
34328
34329 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
34330 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
34331 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
34332 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
34333 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
34334 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
34335 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
34336 a delivery process.
34337
34338 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
34339 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
34340 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
34341 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
34342 however, available with &'inetd'&.
34343
34344 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
34345 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
34346 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
34347 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
34348
34349 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
34350 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
34351 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
34352
34353
34354
34355 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
34356 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
34357 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
34358 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
34359 the error response to the last command. The default value for
34360 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
34361 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
34362 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34363
34364
34365 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34366 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34367 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34368 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34369 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34370 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34371 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34372 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34373 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34374 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34375 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34376
34377
34378
34379 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34380 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34381 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34382 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34383 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34384 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34385 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34386 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34387
34388 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34389 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34390 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34391 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34392 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34393 counted.
34394
34395 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34396 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34397 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34398
34399 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34400 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34401 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34402 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34403 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34404
34405
34406
34407
34408 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34409 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34410 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34411 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34412
34413 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34414 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
34415 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
34416 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
34417 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
34418 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34419 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
34420 SMTP response codes.
34421
34422 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34423 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
34424 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34425 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34426 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34427 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34428 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34429 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34430 RCPT failures.
34431
34432
34433
34434 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34435 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34436 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34437 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34438 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34439 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34440 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34441
34442 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34443 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34444 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34445 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34446 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34447 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34448 argument. For example,
34449 .code
34450 ETRN #brigadoon
34451 .endd
34452 runs the command
34453 .code
34454 exim -R brigadoon
34455 .endd
34456 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34457 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34458 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34459 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34460 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34461
34462 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34463 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34464 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34465 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34466 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34467 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34468 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34469 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34470
34471 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34472 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34473 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34474 whatever the form of its argument. For
34475 example:
34476 .code
34477 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34478 $sender_host_address
34479 .endd
34480 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34481 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34482 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34483 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34484 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34485 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34486 for it to change them before running the command.
34487
34488
34489
34490 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34491 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34492 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34493 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34494 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34495 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34496 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34497 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34498 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34499 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34500 runs for RCPT commands:
34501 .code
34502 accept hosts = :
34503 .endd
34504 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34505
34506
34507
34508 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34509 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34510 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34511 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34512 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34513 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34514 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34515 envelope along with the message.
34516
34517 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34518 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34519 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34520 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34521 can be used to specify it.
34522
34523 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34524 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34525 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34526 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34527 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34528
34529 .vindex "&$host$&"
34530 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34531 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34532 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34533 router:
34534 .code
34535 begin routers
34536 route_append:
34537 driver = manualroute
34538 transport = smtp_appendfile
34539 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34540
34541 begin transports
34542 smtp_appendfile:
34543 driver = appendfile
34544 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34545 batch_max = 1000
34546 use_bsmtp
34547 user = exim
34548 .endd
34549 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34550 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34551 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34552
34553
34554
34555 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34556 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34557 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34558 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34559 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34560 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34561 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34562 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34563 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34564 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34565
34566 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34567 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34568
34569 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34570 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34571 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34572 make some use of automatically, for example:
34573 .code
34574 554 Unexpected end of file
34575 Transaction started in line 10
34576 Error detected in line 14
34577 .endd
34578 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34579 file, for example:
34580 .code
34581 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34582 The error message was:
34583
34584 501 '>' missing at end of address
34585
34586 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34587 The error was detected in line 12.
34588 The SMTP command at fault was:
34589
34590 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34591
34592 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34593 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34594 .endd
34595 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34596 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34597 accepted.
34598 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34599 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34600
34601
34602
34603 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34604 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34605
34606 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34607 "Customizing messages"
34608 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34609 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34610 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34611 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34612 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34613
34614 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34615 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34616 option. Exim also adds the line
34617 .code
34618 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34619 .endd
34620 to all warning and bounce messages,
34621
34622
34623 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34624 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34625 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34626 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34627 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34628 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34629 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34630
34631 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34632 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34633 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34634 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34635 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34636 item.
34637
34638 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34639 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34640 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34641 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34642 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34643 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34644 option, rounded to a whole number.
34645
34646 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34647
34648 .ilist
34649 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34650 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34651 .next
34652 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34653 failing addresses with their error messages.
34654 .next
34655 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34656 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34657 .next
34658 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34659 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34660 .endlist
34661
34662 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34663 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34664 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34665 .code
34666 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34667 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34668 {: returning message to sender}}
34669 ****
34670 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34671
34672 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34673 {that you sent }{sent by
34674
34675 <$sender_address>
34676
34677 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34678 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34679 ****
34680 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34681 ****
34682 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34683 ------
34684 ****
34685 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34686 only the first
34687 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34688 ****
34689 .endd
34690 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34691 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34692 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34693 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34694 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34695 text sections:
34696
34697 .ilist
34698 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34699 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34700 .next
34701 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34702 the delayed addresses.
34703 .next
34704 The third item then ends the message.
34705 .endlist
34706
34707 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34708 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34709 .code
34710 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34711 $warn_message_delay
34712 ****
34713 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34714
34715 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34716 {that you sent }{sent by
34717
34718 <$sender_address>
34719
34720 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34721 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34722
34723 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34724 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34725 The date of the message is: $h_date
34726
34727 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34728 ****
34729 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34730 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34731 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34732 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34733 the message will be returned to you.
34734 .endd
34735 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34736 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34737 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34738 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34739 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34740 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34741 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34742 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34743 handled them.
34744
34745
34746
34747
34748 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34749 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34750
34751 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34752 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34753 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34754
34755
34756
34757 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34758 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34759 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34760 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34761 routing explicitly:
34762 .code
34763 send_to_smart_host:
34764 driver = manualroute
34765 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34766 transport = remote_smtp
34767 .endd
34768 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34769 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34770 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34771 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34772 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34773
34774
34775
34776
34777 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34778 .cindex "mailing lists"
34779 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34780 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34781 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34782
34783 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34784 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34785 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34786 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34787 .code
34788 lists:
34789 driver = redirect
34790 domains = lists.example
34791 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34792 forbid_pipe
34793 forbid_file
34794 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34795 no_more
34796 .endd
34797 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34798 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34799 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34800 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34801
34802 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34803 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34804 a mailing list.
34805
34806 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34807 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34808 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34809 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34810 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34811
34812 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34813 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34814 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34815 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34816 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34817 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34818 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34819 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34820 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34821
34822
34823
34824 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34825 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34826 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34827 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34828 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34829 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34830 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34831
34832 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34833 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34834 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34835 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34836 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34837
34838
34839
34840 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34841 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34842 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34843 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34844 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34845 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34846 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34847 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34848 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34849 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34850
34851 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34852 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34853 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34854 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34855 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34856 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34857 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34858 pre-existing messages.
34859
34860 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34861 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34862 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34863 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34864 one level of expansion anyway.
34865
34866
34867
34868 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34869 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34870 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34871 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34872 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34873 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34874
34875 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34876 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34877 .code
34878 lists_request:
34879 driver = redirect
34880 domains = lists.example
34881 local_part_suffix = -request
34882 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34883 no_more
34884
34885 lists_post:
34886 driver = redirect
34887 domains = lists.example
34888 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34889 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34890 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34891 forbid_pipe
34892 forbid_file
34893 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34894 no_more
34895
34896 lists_closed:
34897 driver = redirect
34898 domains = lists.example
34899 allow_fail
34900 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34901 .endd
34902 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34903 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34904 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34905 mailing list.
34906
34907 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34908 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34909 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34910 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34911 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34912 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34913 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34914 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34915 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34916
34917 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34918 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34919 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34920
34921
34922
34923
34924 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34925 .cindex "VERP"
34926 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34927 .cindex "envelope sender"
34928 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34929 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34930 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34931 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34932 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34933 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34934
34935 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34936 .oindex &%return_path%&
34937 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34938 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34939 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34940 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34941 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34942 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34943 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34944 .code
34945 verp_smtp:
34946 driver = smtp
34947 max_rcpt = 1
34948 return_path = \
34949 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34950 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34951 .endd
34952 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34953 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34954 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34955 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34956 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34957 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34958 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34959 rewritten as
34960 .code
34961 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34962 .endd
34963 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34964 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34965 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34966 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34967 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34968 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34969
34970 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34971 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34972 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34973 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34974 .code
34975 dnslookup:
34976 driver = dnslookup
34977 domains = ! +local_domains
34978 transport = \
34979 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34980 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34981 no_more
34982 .endd
34983 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34984 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34985 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34986 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34987 address.
34988
34989 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34990 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34991 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34992 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34993 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34994 .code
34995 verp_dnslookup:
34996 driver = dnslookup
34997 domains = ! +local_domains
34998 transport = remote_smtp
34999 errors_to = \
35000 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35001 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35002 no_more
35003 .endd
35004 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35005 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35006 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35007 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35008 them.
35009
35010 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35011 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35012 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35013 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35014 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35015 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35016 used).
35017
35018
35019
35020
35021
35022
35023 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35024 .cindex "virtual domains"
35025 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35026 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35027 meanings:
35028
35029 .ilist
35030 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35031 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35032 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35033 .next
35034 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35035 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35036 have login accounts on that host.
35037 .endlist
35038
35039 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35040 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35041 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35042 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35043 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35044 to a router of this form:
35045 .code
35046 virtual:
35047 driver = redirect
35048 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35049 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35050 no_more
35051 .endd
35052 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35053 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35054 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35055 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35056 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35057 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35058
35059 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35060 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35061 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35062 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35063
35064 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35065 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35066 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35067 .code
35068 my_domains:
35069 driver = accept
35070 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35071 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35072 transport = my_mailboxes
35073 .endd
35074 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35075 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35076 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35077 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35078 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35079 follows:
35080 .code
35081 my_mailboxes:
35082 driver = appendfile
35083 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35084 user = mail
35085 .endd
35086 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35087 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35088
35089 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35090 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35091 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35092 information about the domains.
35093
35094
35095
35096 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35097 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35098 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35099 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35100 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35101 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35102 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35103 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35104 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35105 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35106 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35107 example, consider this router:
35108 .code
35109 userforward:
35110 driver = redirect
35111 check_local_user
35112 file = $home/.forward
35113 local_part_suffix = -*
35114 local_part_suffix_optional
35115 allow_filter
35116 .endd
35117 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35118 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35119 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35120 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35121 .code
35122 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35123 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35124 endif
35125 .endd
35126 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35127 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35128 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35129 control over which suffixes are valid.
35130
35131 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35132 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35133 another MTA:
35134 .code
35135 userforward:
35136 driver = redirect
35137 check_local_user
35138 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35139 local_part_suffix = -*
35140 local_part_suffix_optional
35141 allow_filter
35142 .endd
35143 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35144 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35145 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35146 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35147 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35148
35149
35150
35151 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35152 .cindex "vacation processing"
35153 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35154 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35155 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35156 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35157 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35158
35159 .ilist
35160 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35161 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35162 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35163 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35164 .code
35165 spqr, vacation-spqr
35166 .endd
35167 .next
35168 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35169 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35170 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35171 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35172 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35173 message.
35174 .endlist
35175
35176 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35177 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35178
35179
35180
35181 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35182 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35183 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35184 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35185 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35186 each day's messages.
35187
35188 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35189 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35190 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35191 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35192
35193
35194
35195 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35196 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35197 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35198 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35199 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35200 permanently connected.
35201
35202 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35203 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35204 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35205
35206
35207 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35208 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35209 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35210 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35211 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35212 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35213 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35214 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35215
35216 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35217 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35218 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35219 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35220 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35221 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35222 if required.
35223
35224 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35225 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35226 intermittent host. For example:
35227 .code
35228 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35229 .endd
35230 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35231 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35232 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35233 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35234 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35235 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35236 immediately.
35237
35238 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35239 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35240 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35241 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35242 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35243 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35244 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35245
35246
35247
35248 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35249 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35250 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35251 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35252 delivered immediately.
35253
35254 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35255 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35256 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35257 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35258 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35259 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35260 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35261 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35262 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35263 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35264 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35265 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35266 single SMTP connection.
35267
35268
35269
35270 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35271 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35272
35273 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35274 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35275 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
35276 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35277 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35278 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35279 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35280 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35281 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35282 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35283 messages this way.
35284
35285 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35286 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35287 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35288 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35289 email is not desirable.
35290
35291 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35292 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35293 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35294 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35295 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35296 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35297 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35298
35299 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35300 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35301 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35302 before sending a message to the smart host.
35303
35304 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35305 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35306 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35307
35308 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35309 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35310 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35311 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35312 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35313 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35314 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35315
35316 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35317 following ways:
35318
35319 .ilist
35320 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35321 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35322 .next
35323 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
35324 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
35325 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
35326 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
35327 successful, a zero return code is given.
35328 .next
35329 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
35330 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
35331 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
35332 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
35333 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
35334 are.
35335 .next
35336 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
35337 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
35338 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
35339 .next
35340 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
35341 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
35342 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
35343 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
35344 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
35345 .next
35346 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
35347 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
35348 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
35349 .next
35350 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
35351 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
35352 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
35353 are ever generated.
35354 .next
35355 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
35356 .next
35357 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
35358 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
35359 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
35360 .endlist
35361
35362 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
35363 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
35364 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
35365 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
35366 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
35367 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35368
35369
35370
35371
35372 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35373 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35374
35375 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35376 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35377 .cindex "log" "types of"
35378 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35379 and the panic log:
35380
35381 .ilist
35382 .cindex "main log"
35383 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35384 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35385 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35386 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35387 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35388 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35389 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35390 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35391 .next
35392 .cindex "reject log"
35393 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35394 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35395 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35396 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35397 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35398 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35399 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35400 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35401 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35402 false.
35403 .next
35404 .cindex "panic log"
35405 .cindex "system log"
35406 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35407 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35408 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35409 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35410 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35411 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35412 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35413 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35414 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35415 .endlist
35416
35417 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35418 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35419 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35420 .code
35421 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35422 by QUIT
35423 .endd
35424 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35425 ways of changing this:
35426
35427 .ilist
35428 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35429 you set
35430 .code
35431 timezone = UTC
35432 .endd
35433 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35434 .next
35435 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35436 example:
35437 .code
35438 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35439 .endd
35440 .endlist
35441
35442 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35443 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35444 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35445 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35446 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35447 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35448
35449
35450
35451
35452 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35453 .cindex "log" "destination"
35454 .cindex "log" "to file"
35455 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35456 .cindex "syslog"
35457 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35458 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35459 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35460 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35461 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35462 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35463 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35464
35465 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35466 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35467 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35468 references to the host name:
35469 .code
35470 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35471 .endd
35472 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35473 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35474 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35475 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35476 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35477 log at all.
35478
35479 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35480 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35481 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35482 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35483 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35484 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35485 implying the use of a default path.
35486
35487 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35488 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35489 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35490 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35491 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35492 equivalent to the setting:
35493 .code
35494 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35495 .endd
35496 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35497 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35498 that is where the logs are written.
35499
35500 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35501 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35502
35503 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35504 .display
35505 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35506 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35507 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35508 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35509 .endd
35510 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35511 error is logged.
35512
35513
35514
35515 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35516 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35517 .cindex "cycling logs"
35518 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35519 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35520 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35521 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35522 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35523 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35524 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35525
35526 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35527 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35528 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35529 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35530 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35531 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35532 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35533 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35534 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35535 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35536 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35537 renamed.
35538
35539
35540
35541 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35542 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35543 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35544 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35545 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35546 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35547 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35548 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35549 .code
35550 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35551 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35552 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35553 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35554 .endd
35555 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35556 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35557 .code
35558 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35559 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35560 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35561 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35562 .endd
35563 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35564 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35565 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35566 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35567
35568 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35569 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35570 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35571 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35572 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35573 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35574 log names:
35575 .code
35576 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35577 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35578 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35579 /var/log/exim/panic
35580 .endd
35581
35582
35583 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35584 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35585 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35586 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35587 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35588 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35589 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35590 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35591 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35592 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35593 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35594 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35595 the time and host name to each line.
35596 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35597
35598 .ilist
35599 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35600 .next
35601 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35602 .next
35603 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35604 .endlist
35605
35606 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35607 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35608 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35609 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35610
35611 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35612 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35613 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35614 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35615 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35616 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35617 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35618 RFC 3164, you should set
35619 .code
35620 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35621 .endd
35622 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35623 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35624
35625 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35626 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35627 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35628 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35629 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35630 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35631 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35632 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35633 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35634 .code
35635 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35636 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35637 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35638 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35639 [5/5] mple>)
35640 .endd
35641 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35642 (LOG_NOTICE):
35643 .code
35644 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35645 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35646 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35647 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35648 [5\18] .example>)
35649 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35650 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35651 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35652 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35653 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35654 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35655 [12\18] F From: <>
35656 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35657 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35658 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35659 [16\18] le>
35660 [17\18] B Bcc:
35661 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35662 .endd
35663 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35664 without modification.
35665
35666 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35667 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35668 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35669 where it is.
35670
35671
35672
35673 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35674 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35675 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35676 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35677 timestamp. The flags are:
35678 .display
35679 &`<=`& message arrival
35680 &`(=`& message fakereject
35681 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35682 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35683 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35684 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35685 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35686 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35687 .endd
35688
35689
35690 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35691 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35692 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35693 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35694 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35695 .code
35696 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35697 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35698 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35699 .endd
35700 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35701 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35702 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35703 .code
35704 R=<message id>
35705 .endd
35706 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35707
35708 .cindex "HELO"
35709 .cindex "EHLO"
35710 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35711 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35712 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35713 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35714 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35715 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35716 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35717 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35718 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35719 name in parentheses.
35720
35721 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35722 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35723 the log containing text like these examples:
35724 .code
35725 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35726 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35727 .endd
35728 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35729 on.
35730
35731 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35732 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35733 of Exim.
35734
35735 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35736 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35737 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35738 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35739 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35740 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35741 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35742 suite that was used.
35743
35744 .cindex log protocol
35745 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35746 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35747 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35748 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35749 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35750 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35751 authenticator name.
35752
35753 .cindex "size" "of message"
35754 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35755 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35756 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35757 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35758 other).
35759
35760 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35761 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35762
35763
35764
35765 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35766 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35767 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35768 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35769 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35770 to fit it on the page:
35771 .code
35772 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35773 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35774 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35775 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35776 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35777 .endd
35778 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35779 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35780 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35781 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35782 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35783
35784 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35785 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35786 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35787 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35788
35789 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35790 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35791 .display
35792 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35793 .endd
35794 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35795 parentheses afterwards.
35796
35797 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35798 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35799 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35800 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35801 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35802 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35803 .new
35804 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
35805 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
35806 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35807 TLS cipher information is still available.
35808 .wen
35809
35810 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35811 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35812 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35813 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35814 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35815
35816 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35817 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35818
35819 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35820 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35821
35822
35823 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35824 .cindex "discarded messages"
35825 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35826 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35827 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35828 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35829 .code
35830 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35831 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35832 .endd
35833 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35834 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35835 .code
35836 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35837 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35838 .endd
35839
35840
35841 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35842 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35843 .code
35844 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35845 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35846 .endd
35847 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35848 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35849 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35850 .code
35851 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35852 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35853 .endd
35854 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35855 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35856 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35857
35858
35859
35860 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35861 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35862 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35863 following form is logged:
35864 .code
35865 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35866 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35867 .endd
35868 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35869 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35870 .code
35871 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35872 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35873 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35874 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35875 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35876 .endd
35877 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35878 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35879 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35880 flagged with &`**`&.
35881
35882
35883
35884 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35885 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35886 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35887 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35888 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35889
35890
35891
35892 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35893 A line of the form
35894 .code
35895 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35896 .endd
35897 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35898 at the end of its processing.
35899
35900
35901
35902
35903 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35904 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35905 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35906 the following table:
35907 .display
35908 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35909 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35910 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35911 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35912 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35913 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35914 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
35915 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35916 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35917 &`H `& host name and IP address
35918 &`I `& local interface used
35919 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
35920 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35921 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
35922 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35923 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35924 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
35925 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
35926 &`Q `& alternate queue name
35927 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35928 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35929 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35930 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35931 &`S `& size of message in bytes
35932 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35933 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35934 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35935 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35936 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35937 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35938 .endd
35939
35940
35941 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35942 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35943 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35944
35945 .ilist
35946 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35947 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35948 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35949 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35950 during the first delivery attempt.
35951 .next
35952 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35953 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35954 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35955 .next
35956 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35957 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35958 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35959 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35960 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35961 doing.
35962 .next
35963 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35964 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35965 message:
35966 .olist
35967 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35968 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35969 .next
35970 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35971 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35972 .next
35973 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35974 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35975 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35976 .code
35977 errors_to = <>
35978 .endd
35979 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35980 .endlist olist
35981 .endlist ilist
35982
35983
35984
35985
35986
35987 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35988 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35989 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35990 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35991 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35992 example:
35993 .code
35994 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35995 .endd
35996 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35997 selection marked by asterisks:
35998 .display
35999 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36000 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36001 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36002 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36003 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36004 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36005 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36006 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36007 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36008 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36009 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36010 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36011 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36012 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36013 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36014 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36015 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36016 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36017 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36018 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36019 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36020 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36021 &` pid `& Exim process id
36022 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36023 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36024 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36025 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36026 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36027 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36028 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36029 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36030 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36031 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36032 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36033 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36034 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36035 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36036 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36037 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36038 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36039 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36040 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36041 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36042 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36043 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36044 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36045
36046 &` all `& all of the above
36047 .endd
36048 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36049 section &<<SECID99>>&
36050
36051 More details on each of these items follows:
36052
36053 .ilist
36054 .cindex "8BITMIME"
36055 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36056 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36057 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36058 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36059 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36060 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36061 .next
36062 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36063 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36064 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36065 this log selector is set.
36066 .next
36067 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36068 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36069 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36070 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36071 such users cannot access the log).
36072 .next
36073 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36074 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36075 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36076 parentheses between them.
36077 .next
36078 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36079 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36080 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36081 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36082 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36083 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36084 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36085 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36086 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36087 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36088 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36089 between the caller and Exim.
36090 .next
36091 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36092 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36093 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36094 .next
36095 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36096 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36097 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36098 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36099 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36100 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36101 .next
36102 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36103 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36104 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36105 .next
36106 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36107 .cindex "size" "of message"
36108 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36109 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36110 .next
36111 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36112 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36113 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36114 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36115 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36116 .next
36117 .cindex log dnssec
36118 .cindex dnssec logging
36119 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36120 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36121 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36122 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36123 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36124 .next
36125 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36126 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36127 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36128 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36129 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36130 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36131 .next
36132 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36133 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36134 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36135 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36136 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36137 .next
36138 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36139 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36140 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36141 client's ident port times out.
36142 .next
36143 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36144 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36145 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36146 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36147 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36148 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36149 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36150 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36151 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36152 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36153 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36154 .next
36155 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36156 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36157 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36158 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36159 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36160 on a proxied connection
36161 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36162 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36163 .next
36164 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36165 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36166 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36167 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36168 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36169 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36170 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36171 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36172 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36173 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36174 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36175 .next
36176 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36177 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36178 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36179 .next
36180 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36181 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36182 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36183 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36184 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36185 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36186 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36187 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36188 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36189 .next
36190 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36191 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
36192 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36193 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36194 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36195 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36196 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36197 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36198 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36199 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36200 .next
36201 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36202 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36203 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36204 immediately after the time and date.
36205 .next
36206 .cindex "log" "queue run"
36207 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36208 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36209 .next
36210 .cindex "log" "queue time"
36211 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36212 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36213 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36214 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36215 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36216 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36217 message has been successfully received.
36218 .next
36219 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36220 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36221 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36222 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36223 .next
36224 .cindex "log" "recipients"
36225 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36226 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36227 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36228 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36229 has taken place.
36230 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36231 in the list.
36232 .next
36233 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
36234 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36235 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36236 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36237 .next
36238 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36239 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36240 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36241 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36242 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36243 .next
36244 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
36245 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36246 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36247 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36248 attempt.
36249 .next
36250 .cindex "log" "return path"
36251 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36252 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36253 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36254 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36255 .next
36256 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36257 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36258 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36259 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36260 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36261 .next
36262 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36263 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36264 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36265 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36266 detail is lost.
36267 .next
36268 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
36269 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36270 it is too big.
36271 .next
36272 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36273 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36274 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36275 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36276 it.
36277 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36278 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
36279 .next
36280 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
36281 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
36282 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
36283 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
36284 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
36285 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
36286 response.
36287 .next
36288 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
36289 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
36290 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
36291 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
36292 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
36293 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
36294 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
36295 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
36296 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
36297 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
36298
36299 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
36300 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
36301 reset if the daemon is restarted.
36302 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
36303 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
36304 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
36305 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
36306 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
36307 .next
36308 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
36309 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
36310 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
36311 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
36312 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
36313 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
36314 .next
36315 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
36316 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
36317 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
36318 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
36319 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
36320 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
36321 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
36322 already have their own log lines.
36323
36324 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
36325 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
36326 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
36327 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
36328 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
36329 the same logging options.
36330
36331 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
36332 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
36333 .code
36334 C=EHLO,QUIT
36335 .endd
36336 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
36337 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
36338 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
36339 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
36340 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
36341 .next
36342 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
36343 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
36344 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
36345 was accepted or used.
36346 .next
36347 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
36348 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
36349 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
36350 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
36351 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
36352 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
36353 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
36354 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
36355 .next
36356 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
36357 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
36358 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
36359 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
36360 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
36361 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
36362 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
36363 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
36364 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
36365 .next
36366 .cindex "log" "subject"
36367 .cindex "subject, logging"
36368 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
36369 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
36370 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
36371 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
36372 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
36373 .next
36374 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
36375 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
36376 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36377 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
36378 .next
36379 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36380 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36381 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36382 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36383 .next
36384 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36385 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36386 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36387 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36388 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36389 .next
36390 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36391 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36392 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36393 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36394 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36395 .next
36396 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36397 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36398 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36399 .endlist
36400
36401
36402 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36403 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36404 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36405 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36406 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36407 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36408 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36409 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36410 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36411 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36412 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36413 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36414 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36415
36416 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36417 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36418 &%message_logs%& option false.
36419 .ecindex IIDloggen
36420
36421
36422
36423
36424 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36425 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36426
36427 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36428 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36429 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36430 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36431 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36432
36433 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36434 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36435 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36436 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36437 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36438 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36439 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36440 various criteria"
36441 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36442 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36443 "extract statistics from the log"
36444 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36445 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36446 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36447 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36448 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36449 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36450 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36451 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36452 .endtable
36453
36454 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36455 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36456 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36457
36458
36459
36460
36461 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36462 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36463 .cindex "process, querying"
36464 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
36465 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36466 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36467 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36468 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36469 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36470 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36471 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36472 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36473
36474 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36475 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36476 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36477
36478
36479 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36480 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36481 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36482 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36483 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36484 options:
36485 .display
36486 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36487 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36488 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36489 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36490 .endd
36491 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36492 .code
36493 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36494 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36495 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36496 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36497 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36498 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36499 .endd
36500 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36501 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36502
36503
36504
36505 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36506 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36507 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36508 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36509 .code
36510 exim -bpu
36511 .endd
36512 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36513 .code
36514 exim -bp
36515 .endd
36516 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36517 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36518
36519 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36520 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36521
36522 .vlist
36523 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36524 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36525 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36526 .code
36527 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
36528 .endd
36529 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36530 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36531 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36532
36533 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36534 Match against the size field.
36535
36536 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36537 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36538
36539 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36540 Match messages that are older than the given time.
36541
36542 .vitem &*-z*&
36543 Match only frozen messages.
36544
36545 .vitem &*-x*&
36546 Match only non-frozen messages.
36547 .endlist
36548
36549 The following options control the format of the output:
36550
36551 .vlist
36552 .vitem &*-c*&
36553 Display only the count of matching messages.
36554
36555 .vitem &*-l*&
36556 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
36557 the default.
36558
36559 .vitem &*-i*&
36560 Display message ids only.
36561
36562 .vitem &*-b*&
36563 Brief format &-- one line per message.
36564
36565 .vitem &*-R*&
36566 Display messages in reverse order.
36567
36568 .vitem &*-a*&
36569 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
36570 .endlist
36571
36572 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
36573
36574
36575
36576 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
36577 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
36578 .cindex "queue" "summary"
36579 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
36580 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
36581 running a command such as
36582 .code
36583 exim -bp | exiqsumm
36584 .endd
36585 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
36586 it, as in the following example:
36587 .code
36588 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36589 .endd
36590 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36591 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36592 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36593 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36594
36595 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36596 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36597 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36598 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36599 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36600 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36601 sender.
36602
36603 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36604 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36605 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36606 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36607 level"& addresses).
36608
36609
36610
36611
36612 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36613 "SECTextspeinf"
36614 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36615 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36616 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36617 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36618 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36619 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36620 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36621 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36622 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36623 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36624 .display
36625 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36626 .endd
36627 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36628
36629 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36630 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36631 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36632
36633 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36634 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36635 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36636 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36637 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36638
36639 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36640 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36641 regular expression.
36642
36643 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36644 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36645
36646 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36647 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36648 normally.
36649
36650 Example of &%-M%&:
36651 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36652 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36653 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36654 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36655 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36656 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36657 search term.
36658
36659 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36660 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36661 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36662 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36663 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36664
36665
36666 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36667 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36668 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36669 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36670 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
36671 the &%--help%& option.
36672
36673
36674 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36675 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36676 .cindex "cycling logs"
36677 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36678 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36679 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36680 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36681 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36682 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36683 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36684 .ilist
36685 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36686 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36687 .next
36688 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36689 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36690 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36691 configuration.
36692 .endlist
36693
36694 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36695 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36696 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36697 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36698 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36699 logs are handled similarly.
36700
36701 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36702 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36703 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36704 any existing log files.
36705
36706 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36707 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36708 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36709 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36710 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36711 .code
36712 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36713 .endd
36714 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36715 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36716
36717
36718
36719 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36720 .cindex "statistics"
36721 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36722 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36723 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36724 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36725 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36726
36727 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36728 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36729 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36730 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36731 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36732 .code
36733 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36734 .endd
36735 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36736 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36737 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36738 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36739 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36740 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36741 also produced per user.
36742
36743 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36744 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36745 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36746 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36747 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36748
36749 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36750 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36751 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36752 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36753 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36754 an entirely separate message.
36755
36756 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36757 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36758 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36759 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36760 least one address that failed.
36761
36762 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36763 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36764 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36765 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36766 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36767 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36768 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36769
36770 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36771 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36772 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36773
36774 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36775 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36776 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36777 .code
36778 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36779 .endd
36780
36781 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36782 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36783 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36784 .cindex "checking access"
36785 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36786 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36787 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36788 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36789 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36790 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36791
36792 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36793 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36794 .code
36795 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36796 .endd
36797 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36798 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36799 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36800 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36801 .code
36802 Rejected:
36803 550 Relay not permitted
36804 .endd
36805 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36806 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36807 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36808 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36809 you can use:
36810 .code
36811 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36812 -f himself@there.example
36813 .endd
36814 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36815 mandatory arguments.
36816
36817 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36818 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36819 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36820
36821
36822
36823 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36824 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36825 .cindex "building DBM files"
36826 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36827 .cindex "lower casing"
36828 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36829 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36830 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36831 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36832 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36833 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36834
36835 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36836 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36837 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36838 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36839 files.
36840
36841 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36842 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36843 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36844 well.
36845
36846 .cindex "USE_DB"
36847 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36848 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36849 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36850 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36851 .code
36852 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36853 .endd
36854 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36855 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36856
36857 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36858 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36859 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36860 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36861 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36862 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36863
36864 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36865 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36866 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36867 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36868 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36869 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36870 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36871 return code is 2.
36872
36873
36874
36875
36876 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36877 .cindex "retry" "times"
36878 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36879 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36880 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36881 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36882 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36883 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36884 output. For example:
36885 .code
36886 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36887 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36888 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36889 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36890 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36891 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36892 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36893 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36894 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36895 past final cutoff time
36896 .endd
36897 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36898 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36899 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36900 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36901 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36902 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36903 run very often.
36904
36905 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36906 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36907 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36908 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36909 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36910 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36911
36912
36913
36914 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36915 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36916 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36917 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36918 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36919 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36920 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36921
36922 .ilist
36923 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36924 .next
36925 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36926 for remote hosts
36927 .next
36928 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36929 .next
36930 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36931 .next
36932 &'misc'&: other hints data
36933 .endlist
36934
36935 The &'misc'& database is used for
36936
36937 .ilist
36938 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36939 .next
36940 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36941 &(smtp)& transport)
36942 .next
36943 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36944 in a transport)
36945 .endlist
36946
36947
36948
36949 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36950 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36951 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36952 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36953 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36954 .code
36955 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36956 .endd
36957 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36958 .code
36959 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36960 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36961 .endd
36962 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36963 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36964 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36965 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36966 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36967 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36968 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36969 and a textual description of the error.
36970
36971 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36972 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36973 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36974 exceeded.
36975
36976 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36977 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36978 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36979 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36980 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36981 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36982 cross-references.
36983
36984
36985
36986 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36987 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36988 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36989 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36990 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36991 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36992 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36993 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36994 updated sufficiently often.
36995
36996 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36997 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36998 the retry database:
36999 .code
37000 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37001 .endd
37002 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37003 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37004 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37005 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37006 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37007 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37008 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37009 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37010 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37011 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37012 whenever it removes information from the database.
37013
37014 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37015 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37016 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37017 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37018 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37019
37020 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37021 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37022 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37023 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37024 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37025 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37026 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37027 tidied.
37028
37029 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37030 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37031
37032
37033
37034
37035 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37036 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37037 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37038 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37039 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37040 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37041 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37042 displayed.
37043
37044 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37045 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37046 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37047 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37048 by new data, for example:
37049 .code
37050 > 4 951102:1000
37051 .endd
37052 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37053 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37054 used as optional separators.
37055
37056
37057
37058
37059 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37060 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37061 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37062 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37063 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37064 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37065 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37066 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37067 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37068 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37069 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37070 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37071 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37072
37073 .vlist
37074 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
37075 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37076
37077 .vitem &%-flock%&
37078 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37079 supports it.
37080
37081 .vitem &%-interval%&
37082 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37083 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37084
37085 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37086 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37087
37088 .vitem &%-mbx%&
37089 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37090
37091 .vitem &%-q%&
37092 Suppress verification output.
37093
37094 .vitem &%-retries%&
37095 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37096 the lock (default 10).
37097
37098 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37099 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37100 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37101 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37102 subsequently sees.
37103
37104 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37105 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37106 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37107 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37108
37109 .vitem &%-v%&
37110 Generate verbose output.
37111 .endlist
37112
37113 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37114 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37115 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37116 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37117 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37118 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37119 more than 30 minutes old.
37120
37121 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37122 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37123 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37124 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37125 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37126 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37127
37128 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37129 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37130 suppresses all output except error messages.
37131
37132 A command such as
37133 .code
37134 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37135 .endd
37136 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37137 .display
37138 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37139 <&'some commands'&>
37140 &`End`&
37141 .endd
37142 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37143 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37144 such as
37145 .code
37146 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37147 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37148 .endd
37149 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37150 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37151 .ecindex IIDutils
37152
37153
37154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37155 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37156
37157 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37158 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37159 .cindex "X-windows"
37160 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37161 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37162 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37163 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37164 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37165 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37166 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37167 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37168
37169
37170
37171 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37172 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37173 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37174 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37175 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37176 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37177 parameters are for.
37178
37179 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37180 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37181 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37182 .code
37183 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37184 .endd
37185 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37186 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37187 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37188 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37189 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37190
37191 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37192 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37193 .code
37194 Eximon*background: gray94
37195 .endd
37196 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37197 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37198 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37199 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37200 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37201 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37202 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37203 .code
37204 xrdb -merge <<End
37205 Eximon*highlight: gray
37206 End
37207 .endd
37208 .cindex "admin user"
37209 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37210 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37211
37212 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37213 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37214 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37215 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37216 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37217
37218 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37219 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37220 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37221 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37222 different parts of the display.
37223
37224
37225
37226
37227 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37228 .cindex "stripchart"
37229 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37230 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37231 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37232 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37233 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37234 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37235 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37236 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37237 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37238
37239 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37240 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37241 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37242 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37243
37244 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37245 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37246 to a single partition.
37247
37248 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37249 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37250 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37251 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37252 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37253 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37254 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37255
37256
37257
37258
37259 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37260 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37261 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37262 .cindex "window size"
37263 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37264 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37265 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37266 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37267 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37268 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37269
37270 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37271 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37272 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37273 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
37274
37275 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
37276 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
37277 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
37278 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
37279 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
37280 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37281
37282 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
37283 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
37284 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37285
37286
37287
37288 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
37289 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
37290 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
37291 the main log is maintained.
37292 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
37293 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
37294 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
37295 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
37296 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
37297
37298 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
37299 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
37300 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
37301 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
37302 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
37303 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
37304 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
37305 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
37306 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
37307 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
37308 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
37309
37310 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
37311 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
37312 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
37313 It cannot go further back up the log.
37314
37315 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
37316 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
37317 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
37318 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
37319 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
37320 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
37321
37322 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
37323 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
37324 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
37325 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
37326 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
37327 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
37328
37329 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
37330 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
37331 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
37332 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
37333 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
37334 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
37335 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
37336 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
37337 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
37338 window.
37339
37340
37341
37342 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
37343 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
37344 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
37345 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
37346 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
37347 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
37348 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
37349 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
37350 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
37351 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
37352
37353 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
37354 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
37355 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
37356 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
37357 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
37358 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
37359 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
37360
37361 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
37362 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
37363 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
37364 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
37365 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
37366 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
37367 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
37368
37369 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
37370 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
37371 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
37372 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
37373
37374 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
37375 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37376 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37377 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37378 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37379 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37380 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37381 not shown.
37382
37383 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37384 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37385
37386 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37387 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37388 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37389 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37390 display is updated.
37391
37392
37393
37394 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37395 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37396 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37397 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37398 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37399 any selected text.
37400
37401 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37402 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37403 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37404 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37405 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37406 .code
37407 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37408 .endd
37409 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37410 follows:
37411
37412 .ilist
37413 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37414 in a new text window.
37415 .next
37416 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37417 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37418 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37419 .next
37420 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37421 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37422 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37423 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37424 .next
37425 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37426 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37427 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37428 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37429 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37430 .next
37431 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37432 that the message be frozen.
37433 .next
37434 .cindex "thawing messages"
37435 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37436 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37437 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37438 that the message be thawed.
37439 .next
37440 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37441 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37442 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37443 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37444 .next
37445 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37446 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37447 message.
37448 .next
37449 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37450 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37451 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37452 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37453 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37454 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37455 which case no action is taken.
37456 .next
37457 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37458 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37459 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37460 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37461 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37462 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37463 case no action is taken.
37464 .next
37465 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37466 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37467 .next
37468 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37469 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37470 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37471 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37472 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37473 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37474 the address is qualified with that domain.
37475 .endlist
37476
37477 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37478 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37479 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37480 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37481 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37482 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37483 if no output is generated.
37484
37485 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37486 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37487 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37488 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37489
37490 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37491 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37492 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37493 .ecindex IIDeximon
37494
37495
37496
37497
37498
37499 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37500 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37501
37502 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37503 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37504 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37505 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37506
37507 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37508 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37509 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37510 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37511 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37512 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37513
37514 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37515 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37516 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37517 as soon as possible.
37518
37519
37520 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37521 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
37522 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37523 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37524 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37525 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37526
37527 .ilist
37528 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37529 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37530 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37531 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37532 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37533 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37534
37535 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37536 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37537 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37538 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37539 .next
37540
37541 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37542 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37543 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37544 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37545 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37546 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37547 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37548 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37549 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
37550 separate commands.
37551
37552 .next
37553 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
37554 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
37555 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
37556 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
37557 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
37558 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
37559 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
37560 .next
37561 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
37562 is disabled.
37563 .next
37564 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
37565 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
37566 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
37567 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
37568 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
37569 .endlist
37570
37571
37572
37573 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
37574 .cindex "setuid"
37575 .cindex "root privilege"
37576 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
37577 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
37578 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
37579 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
37580 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
37581 is required for two things:
37582
37583 .ilist
37584 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
37585 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
37586 not required.
37587 .next
37588 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37589 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37590 configuration.
37591 .endlist
37592
37593 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37594 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37595 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37596 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37597 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37598 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37599 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37600 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37601
37602 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37603 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37604 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37605
37606 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37607 uid and gid in the following cases:
37608
37609 .ilist
37610 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37611 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37612 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37613 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37614 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37615 the calling process.
37616 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37617 option may not be used at all.
37618 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37619 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37620 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37621 .next
37622 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37623 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37624 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37625 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37626 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37627 calling process.
37628 .next
37629 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37630 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37631 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37632 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37633 testing address verification
37634 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37635 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37636 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37637 option).
37638 .next
37639 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37640 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37641 .endlist
37642
37643 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37644
37645 .ilist
37646 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37647 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37648 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37649 will be used during message reception.
37650 .next
37651 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37652 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37653 .next
37654 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37655 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37656 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37657 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37658 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37659 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37660 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37661 generating bounce and warning messages.
37662
37663 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37664 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37665 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37666 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37667 .next
37668 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37669 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37670 .endlist
37671
37672
37673
37674
37675 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37676 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37677 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37678 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37679 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37680 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37681 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37682 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37683 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37684 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37685 to any other uid.
37686
37687 .cindex SIGHUP
37688 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37689 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37690 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37691 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37692
37693 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37694 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37695 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37696 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37697 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37698
37699 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37700 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37701 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37702 effect.
37703
37704 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37705 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37706 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37707
37708 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37709 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37710 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37711 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37712 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37713 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37714 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37715 address this problem at this time.
37716
37717 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37718 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37719 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37720 be used in the most straightforward way.
37721
37722 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37723 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37724
37725 .ilist
37726 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37727 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37728 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37729 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37730 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37731 .next
37732 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37733 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37734 .next
37735 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37736 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37737 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37738 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37739 .next
37740 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37741 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37742
37743 .olist
37744 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37745 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37746 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37747 .next
37748 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37749 owned by the Exim user.
37750 .next
37751 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37752 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37753 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37754 .endlist olist
37755 .endlist ilist
37756
37757
37758 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37759 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37760 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37761 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37762
37763 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37764 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37765
37766
37767
37768
37769 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37770 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37771 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37772
37773
37774
37775 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37776 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37777 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37778 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37779 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37780 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37781 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37782
37783 .ilist
37784 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37785 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37786 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37787 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37788 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37789 .next
37790 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37791 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37792 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37793 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37794 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37795 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37796 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37797 .next
37798 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37799 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37800 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37801 .next
37802 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37803 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37804 .next
37805 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37806 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37807 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37808 .next
37809 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37810 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37811 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37812 of opaque strings.
37813 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37814 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37815 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37816 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37817 .endlist
37818
37819
37820
37821
37822 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37823 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37824 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37825 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37826 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37827 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37828 are some issues to be aware of:
37829
37830 .ilist
37831 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37832 .next
37833 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37834 .next
37835 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37836 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37837 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37838 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37839 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37840 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37841 data.
37842 .next
37843 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37844 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37845 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37846 .next
37847 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37848 expected to yield one result.
37849 .endlist
37850
37851
37852
37853
37854 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37855 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37856 .cindex "IP source routing"
37857 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37858 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37859 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37860 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37861
37862
37863
37864 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37865 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37866 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37867
37868
37869
37870
37871 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37872 .cindex "trusted users"
37873 .cindex "admin user"
37874 .cindex "privileged user"
37875 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37876 .cindex "user" "admin"
37877 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37878 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37879 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37880 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37881 permit a remote host to be specified.
37882
37883 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37884 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37885 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37886 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37887 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37888 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37889 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37890
37891 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37892 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37893 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37894 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37895 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37896
37897 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37898 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37899 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37900 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37901 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37902
37903 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37904 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37905 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37906 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37907 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37908 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37909 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37910 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37911
37912 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37913 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37914 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37915 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37916 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37917 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37918 files.
37919
37920
37921
37922 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37923 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37924 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37925 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37926 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37927 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37928
37929
37930
37931 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37932 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37933 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37934 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37935 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37936 this.
37937
37938
37939
37940 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37941 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37942 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37943 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37944 converted output.
37945
37946
37947
37948 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37949 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37950 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37951 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37952 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37953
37954
37955
37956 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37957 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37958 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37959 loading it.
37960
37961
37962 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37963 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37964 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37965 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37966 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37967 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37968 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37969
37970 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37971 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37972 string.
37973
37974
37975
37976 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37977 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37978 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37979 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37980
37981
37982
37983 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37984 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37985 enough to hold the result.
37986 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37987
37988
37989
37990
37991 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37992 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37993
37994 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37995 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37996 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37997 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37998 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37999 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38000 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38001 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38002 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38003 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38004 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38005 themselves are recoverable.
38006
38007 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38008 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38009 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38010
38011 .ilist
38012 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38013 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38014 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38015 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38016 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38017 .next
38018 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38019 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38020 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38021 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38022 .next
38023 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38024 .next
38025 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38026 signature.
38027 .endlist
38028 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38029
38030 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38031 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38032 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38033 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38034 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38035 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38036 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38037 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38038 attempt.
38039
38040 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38041 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38042 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38043 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38044 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38045 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38046 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38047 normally the Exim user.
38048
38049 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38050 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38051 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38052 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38053 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38054 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38055 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38056 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38057
38058 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38059 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38060 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38061 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38062
38063 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38064 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38065
38066 .vlist
38067 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38068 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38069 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38070 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38071 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38072 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38073 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38074 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38075 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38076 newlines.
38077
38078 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38079 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38080 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38081 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38082 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38083 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38084
38085 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38086 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38087 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38088 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38089 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38090 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38091
38092 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38093 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38094 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38095
38096 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38097 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38098 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38099 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38100 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38101
38102 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38103 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38104 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38105 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38106 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38107
38108 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38109 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38110 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38111
38112 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38113 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38114 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38115
38116 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38117 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38118 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38119
38120 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38121 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38122 present if the number is greater than zero.
38123
38124 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38125 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38126 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38127
38128 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38129 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38130 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38131
38132 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38133 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38134 command.
38135
38136 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38137 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38138 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38139 messages.
38140
38141 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38142 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38143 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38144 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38145
38146 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38147 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38148 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38149
38150 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38151 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38152 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38153 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38154 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38155 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38156
38157 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38158 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38159 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38160 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38161 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38162
38163 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38164 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38165 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38166 generated messages.
38167
38168 .vitem &%-local%&
38169 The message is from a local sender.
38170
38171 .vitem &%-localerror%&
38172 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38173
38174 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38175 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38176 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38177 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38178
38179 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38180 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38181 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38182
38183 .vitem &%-N%&
38184 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38185 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38186 &%-N%& is assumed.
38187
38188 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38189 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38190 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38191
38192 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38193 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38194 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38195
38196 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38197 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38198 of &$spam_score_int$&.
38199
38200 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38201 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38202 rather than Unix-format.
38203 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38204 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38205
38206 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38207 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38208 certificate was verified by the server.
38209
38210 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38211 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38212 name of the cipher suite that was used.
38213
38214 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38215 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38216 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38217 certificate.
38218 .endlist
38219
38220 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38221 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38222 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38223 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38224 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38225 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38226 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38227 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38228 addresses are complete.
38229
38230 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38231 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38232 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38233 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38234 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38235 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38236 .code
38237 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38238 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38239 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38240 .endd
38241 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38242 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38243 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38244 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38245 example:
38246 .code
38247 4
38248 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38249 darcy@austen.fict.example
38250 rdo@foundation
38251 alice@wonderland.fict.example
38252 .endd
38253 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38254 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38255 line is of the following form:
38256 .display
38257 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
38258 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
38259 .endd
38260 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
38261 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
38262 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
38263 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
38264 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
38265 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
38266 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
38267 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
38268
38269
38270 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
38271 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
38272 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
38273 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
38274 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
38275 following:
38276
38277 .table2 50pt
38278 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
38279 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
38280 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
38281 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
38282 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
38283 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
38284 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
38285 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
38286 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
38287 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
38288 .endtable
38289
38290 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
38291 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
38292 typical set of headers:
38293 .code
38294 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
38295 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38296 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
38297 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
38298 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
38299 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
38300 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
38301 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38302 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
38303 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38304 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
38305 .endd
38306 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
38307 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
38308 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
38309 .ecindex IIDforspo1
38310 .ecindex IIDforspo2
38311 .ecindex IIDforspo3
38312
38313 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38314 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38315
38316 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
38317 "DKIM Support"
38318 .cindex "DKIM"
38319
38320 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
38321 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
38322 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
38323 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
38324
38325 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
38326 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38327
38328 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
38329 .olist
38330 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
38331 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
38332 (including transport filters)
38333 except cutthrough delivery.
38334 .next
38335 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
38336 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
38337 different signature contexts.
38338 .endlist
38339
38340 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
38341 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
38342 Exim's standard controls.
38343
38344 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
38345 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
38346 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
38347 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
38348 .code
38349 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
38350 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
38351 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
38352 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
38353 .endd
38354 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
38355 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
38356 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
38357 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
38358 senders).
38359
38360
38361 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
38362 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
38363
38364 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
38365 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
38366
38367 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
38368 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
38369 .new
38370 After expansion, this can be a list.
38371 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
38372 while expanding the remaining signing options.
38373 .wen
38374 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done.
38375
38376 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
38377 This sets the key selector string.
38378 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable to look up a matching selector.
38379 The result is put in the expansion
38380 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
38381 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
38382 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done.
38383
38384 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38385 This sets the private key to use.
38386 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38387 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38388 The result can either
38389 .ilist
38390 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
38391 .next
38392 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38393 the private key.
38394 .next
38395 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38396 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38397 is set.
38398 .endlist
38399 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done.
38400
38401 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38402 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38403 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38404 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38405 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38406
38407 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38408 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38409 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38410 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38411 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38412 variables here.
38413
38414 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
38415 If set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
38416 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
38417 signature.
38418 When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be used.
38419
38420
38421 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
38422 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38423
38424 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is implemented via the
38425 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38426 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38427 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38428 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38429 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
38430 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38431
38432 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38433 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
38434 runtime of the ACL.
38435
38436 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
38437 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
38438 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
38439 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
38440
38441 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
38442 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
38443 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
38444 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
38445 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
38446 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
38447 it defaults as:
38448 .code
38449 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
38450 .endd
38451 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
38452 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
38453 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
38454 .code
38455 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
38456 .endd
38457 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
38458 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
38459 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
38460 .code
38461 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
38462 .endd
38463
38464 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
38465 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
38466
38467
38468 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
38469 available (from most to least important):
38470
38471
38472 .vlist
38473 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
38474 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
38475 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
38476 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
38477
38478 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
38479 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
38480 .ilist
38481 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
38482 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38483 .next
38484 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
38485 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38486 .next
38487 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
38488 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38489 .next
38490 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
38491 .endlist
38492
38493 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
38494 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
38495 "fail" or "invalid". One of
38496 .ilist
38497 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
38498 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
38499 .next
38500 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
38501 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
38502 .next
38503 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
38504 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
38505 means that the message body was modified in transit.
38506 .next
38507 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
38508 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
38509 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
38510 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
38511 .endlist
38512
38513 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
38514 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
38515 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
38516 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38517
38518 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
38519 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
38520 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
38521 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38522
38523 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
38524 The key record selector string.
38525
38526 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
38527 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
38528
38529 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
38530 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38531
38532 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
38533 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38534
38535 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
38536 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
38537 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
38538 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
38539 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
38540 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
38541
38542 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
38543 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
38544 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
38545 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
38546
38547 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
38548 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
38549 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
38550
38551 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
38552 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
38553 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
38554 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
38555 integer size comparisons against this value.
38556
38557 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
38558 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
38559
38560 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
38561 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
38562
38563 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
38564 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
38565
38566 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
38567 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38568 in the key record.
38569
38570 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
38571 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38572 in the key record.
38573
38574 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
38575 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
38576
38577 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
38578 Number of bits in the key.
38579 .endlist
38580
38581 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
38582
38583 .vlist
38584 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
38585 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
38586 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
38587 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
38588 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
38589
38590 .code
38591 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
38592 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
38593 sender_domains = gmail.com
38594 dkim_signers = gmail.com
38595 dkim_status = none
38596 .endd
38597
38598 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
38599 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
38600
38601 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
38602 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
38603 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
38604 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
38605
38606 .code
38607 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
38608 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
38609 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
38610 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
38611 .endd
38612
38613 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
38614 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
38615 for more information of what they mean.
38616 .endlist
38617
38618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38620
38621 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
38622 "Proxy support"
38623 .cindex "proxy support"
38624 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
38625
38626 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
38627 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
38628
38629
38630 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
38631 .cindex proxy inbound
38632 .cindex proxy "server side"
38633 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
38634 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
38635
38636 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
38637 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
38638 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
38639 in Local/Makefile.
38640
38641 It was built on specifications from:
38642 (&url(http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt)).
38643 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
38644 (&url(http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e)).
38645
38646 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
38647 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
38648 to distribute load.
38649 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
38650 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
38651 There is no logging if a host passes or
38652 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
38653 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
38654
38655 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
38656 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
38657 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
38658 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
38659 automatically determines which version is in use.
38660
38661 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
38662 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
38663 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
38664 Exim and the proxy server.
38665
38666 The following expansion variables are usable
38667 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
38668 of the proxy):
38669 .display
38670 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
38671 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
38672 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
38673 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
38674 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
38675 .endd
38676 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
38677 there was a protocol error.
38678
38679 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
38680 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
38681 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
38682 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
38683 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
38684 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
38685 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
38686 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
38687 A possible solution is:
38688 .display
38689 # Set max number of connections per host
38690 LIMIT = 5
38691 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
38692 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
38693
38694 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
38695 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
38696 .endd
38697
38698
38699
38700 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
38701 .cindex proxy outbound
38702 .cindex proxy "client side"
38703 .cindex proxy SOCKS
38704 .cindex SOCKS proxy
38705 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
38706 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
38707 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
38708 Local/Makefile.
38709
38710 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
38711 on an smtp transport.
38712 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
38713 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
38714 Each proxy specifier is a list
38715 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
38716 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
38717
38718 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
38719 The list of options is in the following table:
38720 .display
38721 &'auth '& authentication method
38722 &'name '& authentication username
38723 &'pass '& authentication password
38724 &'port '& tcp port
38725 &'tmo '& connection timeout
38726 &'pri '& priority
38727 &'weight '& selection bias
38728 .endd
38729
38730 More details on each of these options follows:
38731
38732 .ilist
38733 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
38734 .cindex proxy authentication
38735 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
38736 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
38737 for access to the proxy.
38738 Default is &"none"&.
38739 .next
38740 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
38741 Default is empty.
38742 .next
38743 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
38744 Default is empty.
38745 .next
38746 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
38747 Default is 1080.
38748 .next
38749 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
38750 Default is 5.
38751 .next
38752 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
38753 higher values being tried first.
38754 The default priority is 1.
38755 .next
38756 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
38757 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
38758 weighted by this value.
38759 The default value for selection bias is 1.
38760 .endlist
38761
38762 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
38763 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
38764 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
38765
38766 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
38767 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
38768 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
38769 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
38770
38771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38773
38774 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
38775 "Internationalisation""
38776 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
38777 .cindex EAI
38778 .cindex i18n
38779 .cindex UTF-8 "mail name handling"
38780
38781 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
38782 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
38783 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
38784
38785 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
38786 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
38787 requirement, upon libidn2.
38788
38789 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
38790 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
38791 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
38792 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
38793 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
38794 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
38795
38796 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
38797 international handling for the message is enabled and
38798 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
38799
38800 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
38801 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
38802 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
38803 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
38804
38805 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
38806 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
38807 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
38808 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
38809
38810 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
38811 components expanded to a-label form,
38812 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
38813 form of the name.
38814
38815 .cindex log protocol
38816 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
38817 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
38818 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
38819
38820 The following expansion operators can be used:
38821 .code
38822 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
38823 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
38824 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
38825 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
38826 .endd
38827
38828 ACLs may use the following modifier:
38829 .display
38830 control = utf8_downconvert
38831 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
38832 .endd
38833 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
38834 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
38835 Message Submission Agent context.
38836 If a value is appended it may be:
38837 .display
38838 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
38839 &`0 `& no downconversion
38840 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
38841 .endd
38842
38843 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
38844 is initially set to -1.
38845
38846
38847 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
38848 Configurations supporting these should inspect
38849 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
38850
38851 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
38852 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
38853 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
38854
38855 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
38856 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
38857
38858
38859
38860 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
38861 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
38862 the following expansion operator can be used:
38863 .code
38864 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
38865 .endd
38866
38867 The string is converted from the charset specified by
38868 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
38869 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
38870 to the
38871 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
38872 with the following exception: All occurences of <sep>
38873 (which has to be a single character)
38874 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
38875 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
38876
38877 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
38878 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
38879
38880 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
38881 by many other IMAP servers.
38882
38883 Examples:
38884 .display
38885 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
38886 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
38887 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
38888 .endd
38889
38890 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
38891 must be representable in UTF-16.
38892
38893
38894 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38896
38897 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
38898 "Events"
38899 .cindex events
38900
38901 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
38902 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
38903 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
38904 processing actions.
38905
38906 Most installations will never need to use Events.
38907 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
38908 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38909
38910 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
38911 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
38912 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
38913
38914 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
38915 An example might look like:
38916 .cindex logging custom
38917 .code
38918 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
38919 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
38920 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
38921 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
38922 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
38923 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
38924 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
38925 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
38926 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
38927 } {}}
38928 .endd
38929
38930 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
38931 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
38932 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
38933
38934 The current list of events is:
38935 .display
38936 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
38937 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
38938 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
38939 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
38940 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
38941 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
38942 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
38943 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
38944 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
38945 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
38946 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
38947 .endd
38948 New event types may be added in future.
38949
38950 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
38951 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
38952 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
38953
38954 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
38955 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
38956 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
38957
38958 .new
38959 The third column in the table above says what section of the configumration
38960 should define the event action.
38961 .wen
38962
38963 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
38964 with the event type:
38965 .display
38966 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
38967 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
38968 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
38969 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
38970 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
38971 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
38972 .endd
38973
38974 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
38975
38976 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
38977 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
38978 the course of its processing:
38979 .ilist
38980 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
38981 transport call
38982 .next
38983 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
38984 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
38985 .endlist
38986 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
38987 a useful way of writing to the main log.
38988
38989 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
38990 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
38991 following will be forced:
38992 .display
38993 &`msg:delivery `& (ignored)
38994 &`msg:host:defer `& (ignored)
38995 &`msg:fail:delivery`& (ignored)
38996 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
38997 &`tcp:close `& (ignored)
38998 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
38999 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
39000 .endd
39001 No other use is made of the result string.
39002
39003 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
39004 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
39005 the target system.
39006
39007 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
39008 chain element received on the connection.
39009 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
39010 loaded locally.
39011
39012 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39013 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39014
39015 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
39016 "Adding drivers or lookups"
39017 .cindex "adding drivers"
39018 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
39019 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
39020 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
39021 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
39022
39023 .olist
39024 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
39025 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
39026 .next
39027 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
39028 .display
39029 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
39030 .endd
39031 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
39032 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
39033 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
39034 .next
39035 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
39036 .code
39037 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
39038 .endd
39039 .next
39040 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
39041 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
39042 .next
39043 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
39044 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
39045 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
39046 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
39047 simple form that most lookups have.
39048 .next
39049 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
39050 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
39051 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
39052 .next
39053 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
39054 &_src_&.
39055 .next
39056 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
39057 as for other drivers and lookups.
39058 .endlist
39059
39060 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
39061 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
39062 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
39063 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
39064 searched using a binary chop procedure.
39065
39066 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
39067 the interface that is expected.
39068
39069
39070
39071
39072 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39073 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39074
39075 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39076 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
39077 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
39078 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
39079 . processors.
39080 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39081
39082 .literal xml
39083 <?sdop
39084 format="newpage"
39085 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
39086 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
39087 ?>
39088 .literal off
39089
39090 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
39091 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
39092 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
39093
39094
39095 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39096 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////